responsibility center budgeting and responsibility center ... · responsibility center budgeting...
TRANSCRIPT
Responsibility Center Budgeting and Responsibility Center Management: Implications
for internal structure and strategic management of North American universities
By
Darren Deering
A thesis submitted in conformity with the requirements for the degree of Doctor of Philosophy, Graduate Department of Leadership, Higher and Adult Education, in the
University of Toronto
© Copyright by Darren Deering (2015)
ii
Responsibility Center Budgeting and Responsibility Center Management: Implications for internal structure and strategic management of North American universities
Doctor of Philosophy, 2015
Darren Deering
Department of Leadership, Higher and Adult Education
University of Toronto
ABSTRACT
Responsibility center budgeting and responsibility center management [RCB/M]
are tools that have been applied within the higher education context for four decades.
The research focussed on RCB/M to date has been predominantly descriptive and
normative in nature. This study presents a three-factor model of internal structure and
applies the concept of management control systems, through diagnostic and interactive
control forms of governance, to provide a theoretical model that is used to further
investigate the institutional outcomes of RCB/M use in four public universities.
Grounded organizational design, accounting, RCB/M, higher education and
management control systems literatures this study focuses on the levels of coordination
and cooperation between units, and between units and the central administration of
higher education institutions. By examining the governance control form employed at
four sample universities this study considers how RCB/M structures affect vertical and
lateral coordination and consequently, institutional mission and goal achievement.
Findings suggest that predominately interactive governance control forms encourage
iii
high levels of vertical and lateral coordination while allowing for high levels of unit
autonomy. Through the use of interactive governance control forms it was found that
the central administration is able to guide and direct unit-level decision making towards
the achievement of both unit- and institution-level goals.
Methodologically, this study employs qualitative research techniques that
included comprehensive document analysis and 55 semi-structured interviews with
senior academic and administrative leaders at four public universities, two in the United
States, and two in Canada. The data collected provides a detailed portrait of the
relationship between units, and between units and the central administration at these
institutions. This study is significant because it presents a new model of internal
structure that is applicable to a broad organizational set. Additionally, through the
application of management control systems, it provides an innovative approach to the
study and understanding of budgeting and management of modern universities. When
this model is applied in conjunction with governance control forms it may provide
significant value for institutions deliberating the implementation of RCB/M structures.
Additionally, this model is useful for institutions undergoing a review of an existing
RCB/M structure.
iv
DEDICATION
To my loving wife Rachel. Without your support this would not have been possible.
v
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS
I would like to acknowledge the four institutions and fifty-five individuals who were
gracious enough to participate in this study.
I wish to thank my committee chair and advisor Dr. Creso Sá for his expertise, guidance,
and support. I am grateful to my other committee members Drs. Dan Lang and Glen Jones
whose advice and direction was essential in the completion of this study. In addition, I want to
express my gratitude to Drs. Leesa Wheelahan and Jim Hearn who have provided valuable
comments and critiques that have helped me craft a better dissertation.
I would also like the thank Dr. Robert Basso. Without his guidance this journey would
not have taken place.
To Nathan Halaney, your help and guidance were invaluable. I can’t thank you enough.
Finally, I want to thank my wife, my parents, and EBM for their love and support.
Although I have dedicated this study to you, it is a small repayment for all that you have given
me.
vi
TABLE OF CONTENTS
DEDICATION .................................................................................................................... iv
ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS .................................................................................................... v
LIST OF TABLES ............................................................................................................... xii
LIST OF FIGURES ............................................................................................................ xiii
LIST OF APPENDICES ...................................................................................................... xiv
LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS ................................................................................................. xv
CHAPTER ONE .................................................................................................................. 1
FRAMING THE ISSUE ........................................................................................................ 1
SECTION 1.1 – INTRODUCTION .......................................................................................................... 1
SECTION 1.2 – OVERVIEW OF THE PROBLEM ..................................................................................... 3
SECTION 1.3 - RESEARCH CONTRIBUTIONS ...................................................................................... 11
CHAPTER TWO ............................................................................................................... 13
LITERATURE REVIEW ..................................................................................................... 13
SECTION 2.1 - INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 13
SECTION 2.1.1 – BUDGETING IN HIGHER EDUCATION INSTITUTIONS ......................................... 14
SECTION 2.1.2 - CONVENTIONAL FORMS OF UNIVERSITY BUDGETING ....................................... 15
SECTION 2.2 - RCB/M: AN INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................... 19
SECTION 2.2.1 - RCB/M IN INDUSTRY ........................................................................................... 22
SECTION 2.2.2 - RCB/M IN HIGHER EDUCATION .......................................................................... 24
SECTION 2.2.3 - FORCES THAT COMPEL THE USE OF RCB/M BY HIGHER EDUCATION
INSTITUTIONS ............................................................................................................................... 27
SECTION 2.2.4 - CRITICISMS OF RCB/M ........................................................................................ 32
SECTION 2.3 - GOVERNANCE IN DECENTRALIZED HIGHER EDUCATION INSTITUTIONS .................. 37
SECTION 2.3.1 - MANAGEMENT CONTROL SYSTEMS ................................................................... 39
SECTION 2.3.2 - LEVERS OF CONTROL .......................................................................................... 44
SECTION 2.3.3 - TRENDS IN HEI GOVERNANCE: DIAGNOSTIC AND INTERACTIVE CONTROL ....... 48
SECTION 2.3.4 - DIAGNOSTIC AND INTERACTIVE APPROACHES TO GOVERNANCE IN RCB/M
INSTITUTIONS ............................................................................................................................... 52
SECTION 2.4 - THE CONCEPT OF ORGANIZATIONAL INTERNAL STRUCTURE ................................... 56
2.4.1 - THE IMPACT OF INTERNAL STRUCTURE ON INSTITUTIONAL CONTROL MECHANISMS .... 60
vii
SECTION 2.5 - MEASURING INSTITUTIONAL GOAL AND MISSION ACHIEVEMENT .......................... 63
SECTION 2.6 - SUMMARY ................................................................................................................. 65
CHAPTER THREE ............................................................................................................ 66
THEORETICAL CONSIDERATIONS AND RESEARCH QUESTIONS .................................... 66
SECTION 3.1 - INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 66
SECTION 3.2 - THREE-FACTOR MODEL OF INTERNAL STRUCTURE ................................................... 66
SECTION 3.3 - PRIMARY RESEARCH QUESTION ................................................................................ 68
SECTION 3.4 - OPERATIONALIZED RESEARCH QUESTIONS AND CORRESPONDING PROPOSITIONS 69
3.4.1 - RESEARCH QUESTIONS REGARDING LATERAL AND VERTICAL COORDINATION ............... 69
3.3.2 - RESEARCH QUESTIONS REGARDING UNIT AUTONOMY .................................................... 72
3.3.3 - RESEARCH QUESTIONS REGARDING DIAGNOSTIC AND INTERACTIVE CONTROL FORMS OF
GOVERNANCE ............................................................................................................................... 74
CHAPTER FOUR .............................................................................................................. 76
METHODS AND METHODOLOGY ................................................................................... 76
SECTION 4.1 - INTRODUCTION ......................................................................................................... 76
SECTION 4.2 - THE CASE STUDY DESIGN ........................................................................................... 76
SECTION 4.3 – METHODOLOGY ........................................................................................................ 80
SECTION 4.3.1 - DOCUMENT ANALYSIS ........................................................................................ 81
SECTION 4.3.2 - INTERVIEWS ........................................................................................................ 83
SECTION 4.3.3 – CASES ................................................................................................................. 85
4.3.3.1 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY .............................................................................. 85
4.3.3.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY .................................................................................. 89
4.3.3.3 - EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY .......................................................................................... 94
4.3.3.4 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY ............................................................................. 96
SECTION 4.4 - INFORMANTS ........................................................................................................... 100
SECTION 4.5 - INTERVIEW PROTOCOL ............................................................................................ 104
SECTION 4.6 - DATA ANALYSIS........................................................................................................ 105
SECTION 4.7 - VALIDITY AND RELIABILITY AND THEIR RELATION TO THIS STUDY ......................... 106
SECTION 4.8 - LIMITATIONS OF THIS STUDY .................................................................................. 110
CHAPTER FIVE .............................................................................................................. 112
FRAMING VERTICAL COORDINATION .......................................................................... 112
viii
SECTION 5.1 – INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................... 112
SECTION 5.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY ............................................................................... 113
5.2.1 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION ............................................................... 114
5.2.2 - THE IMPACT OF CENTRALLY HELD FINANCIAL RESOURCES ............................................ 114
5.2.3 - FORMAL AND INFORMAL PROCESSES THAT ENCOURAGE VERTICAL COORDINATION .. 117
5.2.4 - CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION ACTING AS A RESOURCE .................................................... 120
5.2.5 - HYBRID GOVERNANCE AND OVERSIGHT ......................................................................... 122
5.2.6 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 124
SECTION 5.3 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY ........................................................................... 126
5.3.1 - THE IMPACT OF CENTRALLY HELD FINANCIAL RESOURCES ............................................ 127
5.3.2 - FORMAL AND INFORMAL PROCESSES THAT ENCOURAGE VERTICAL COORDINATION .. 128
5.3.3 - CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION ACTING AS A RESOURCE .................................................... 130
5.3.4 - THE BUDGET REVIEW PROCESS ....................................................................................... 132
5.3.5 - EVOLVING OVERSIGHT AND MANAGEMENT .................................................................. 133
5.3.6 - HYBRID OVERSIGHT AND MANAGEMENT ....................................................................... 134
5.3.7 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 135
SECTION 5.4 - EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY ....................................................................................... 136
5.4.1 - A STATE OF OVER DECENTRALIZATION ........................................................................... 137
5.4.2 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION: A TRADITION OF DIAGNOSTIC CONTROL
.................................................................................................................................................... 139
5.4.3 - A NEW BEGINNING? ........................................................................................................ 142
5.4.4 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 145
SECTION 5.5 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY .......................................................................... 146
5.5.1 - OVER-DECENTRALIZATION AND DIAGNOSTIC CONTROL ................................................ 147
5.5.2 - THE ABSENCE OF TRANSPARENCY AND VERTICAL COMMUNICATION ........................... 149
5.5.3 - THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION AS A RESOURCE FOR UNITS ........................................ 153
5.5.4 - A LACK OF BUDGET OVERSIGHT ...................................................................................... 154
5.5.5 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 155
SECTION 5.6 - PROPOSITIONS ON VERTICAL COORDINATION ....................................................... 156
5.6.1 – PROPOSITION ONE ......................................................................................................... 157
5.6.2 – PROPOSITION THREE ...................................................................................................... 159
5.6.3 – PROPOSITION FIVE .......................................................................................................... 161
ix
5.6.4 – PROPOSITION TEN .......................................................................................................... 162
CHAPTER SIX ................................................................................................................ 164
LATERAL COORDINATION ............................................................................................ 164
SECTION 6.1 - INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................... 164
SECTION 6.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY ............................................................................... 165
6.2.1 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION ............................................................... 165
6.2.2 - INTERDISCIPLINARY PROGRAMS AND RESEARCH INITIATIVES ....................................... 168
6.2.3 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M ................................................................................................... 170
6.2.4 - INTER-UNIT COMMUNICATION ....................................................................................... 173
6.2.5 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 174
SECTION 6.3 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY ........................................................................... 174
6.3.1 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION ............................................................... 174
6.3.2 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M ................................................................................................... 177
6.3.3 - INTER-UNIT COMMUNICATION ....................................................................................... 178
6.3.4 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 180
SECTION 6.4 - EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY ....................................................................................... 181
6.4.1 - PROCESSES THAT ENCOURAGE COORDINATION ............................................................ 181
6.4.2 - INTER-UNIT PROGRAMS .................................................................................................. 185
6.4.3 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M ................................................................................................... 186
6.4.4 - THE AUSTERITY NARRATIVE ............................................................................................ 188
6.4.5 - A NEW PATH FORWARD .................................................................................................. 190
6.4.6 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 190
SECTION 6.5 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY .......................................................................... 192
6.5.1 - INTER-UNIT PROGRAMS .................................................................................................. 192
6.5.2 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M ................................................................................................... 194
6.5.3 - TRANSPARENCY, FAIRNESS AND TRUST .......................................................................... 197
6.5.4 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 200
SECTION 6.6 – PROPOSITIONS ON LATERAL COORDINATION ........................................................ 201
6.6.1 – PROPOSITION TWO......................................................................................................... 201
6.6.2 – PROPOSITION FOUR ....................................................................................................... 203
6.6.3 – PROPOSITION FIVE .......................................................................................................... 207
x
CHAPTER SEVEN .......................................................................................................... 209
UNIT AUTONOMY ........................................................................................................ 209
SECTION 7.1 - INTRODUCTION ....................................................................................................... 209
SECTION 7.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY ............................................................................... 210
7.2.1 - TREND OF CENTRALIZATION ........................................................................................... 210
7.2.2 - THE FINANCIAL POSITION OF UNITS ............................................................................... 212
7.2.3 - DEAN CENTRIC MODEL .................................................................................................... 213
7.2.4 - THE UNIVERSITY’S FINANCIAL POSITION ......................................................................... 213
7.2.5 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 214
SECTION 7.3 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY ........................................................................... 214
7.3.1 - TREND OF CENTRALIZATION ........................................................................................... 215
7.3.2 - DEAN CENTRIC MODEL .................................................................................................... 216
7.3.3 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 217
SECTION 7.4 – EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY ...................................................................................... 217
7.4.1 – RADICAL DECENTRALIZATION ......................................................................................... 217
7.4.2 – FISCAL CONSTRAINTS ..................................................................................................... 218
7.4.3 – TREND OF CENTRALIZATION ........................................................................................... 219
7.4.4 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 221
SECTION 7.5 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY .......................................................................... 221
7.5.1 – REVENUE AND ENROLLMENT GROWTH ......................................................................... 222
7.5.2 – TREND OF CENTRALIZATION ........................................................................................... 223
7.5.3 – CAMPUS ALBERTA .......................................................................................................... 224
7.5.4 - SUMMARY ....................................................................................................................... 225
SECTION 7.6 - PROPOSITIONS REGARDING UNIT AUTONOMY ...................................................... 225
7.6.1 – PROPOSITION SEVEN ...................................................................................................... 226
7.6.2 – PROPOSITION EIGHT ....................................................................................................... 227
7.6.3 – PROPOSITION ELEVEN .................................................................................................... 228
CHAPTER 8 ................................................................................................................... 229
CONCLUSION ............................................................................................................... 229
SECTION 8.1 – INTRODUCTION ...................................................................................................... 229
SECTION 8.2 - SUMMARY OF MAIN FINDINGS ............................................................................... 230
xi
SECTION 8.3 – IMPLICATIONS FOR THEORY ................................................................................... 233
SECTION 8.4 – IMPLICATIONS FOR FUTURE RESEARCH ................................................................. 236
SECTION 8.5 – IMPLICATIONS FOR PRACTICE ................................................................................ 238
SECTION 8.6 – SUMMARY CONCLUSIONS ...................................................................................... 241
REFERENCES ................................................................................................................ 243
APPENDIX 1: Budget Typology Table .......................................................................... 267
APPENDIX 2: Public Higher Education Institutions in the Times Higher Education North
American Rankings and Corresponding Budgeting and Management System .......... 269
APPENDIX 3: Walter et al.’s Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness ..... 270
APPENDIX 4: Lateral Coordination and Governance Control Form Matrix ................ 271
APPENDIX 5: Vertical Coordination and Governance Control Form Matrix ............... 272
APPENDIX 6: Method-Process Graphic ....................................................................... 273
APPENDIX 7: Steps and Phases of Study ..................................................................... 274
APPENDIX 8: Interview Protocol ................................................................................. 276
APPENDIX 9: Contact Letter to Potential Participants ................................................ 278
APPENDIX 10: Ethics Approval Letter .......................................................................... 280
APPENDIX 11: Interviewee Consent Form .................................................................. 281
APPENDIX 12: Informed Consent Letter ..................................................................... 282
APPENDIX 13: Matrix for Case Comparisons............................................................... 285
APPENDIX 14: Coding Scheme Start List ..................................................................... 287
APPENDIX 15: Triangulation Matrix for Research Questions ...................................... 288
APPENDIX 16: Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness for Midwestern U.S.
University .................................................................................................................... 289
APPENDIX 17: Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness for Central Canadian
University .................................................................................................................... 290
xii
LIST OF TABLES
Table 1: Management Control Systems Package
Table 2: A Comparison of Diagnostic and Interactive Control Form Use
Table 3: Weber’s Six Steps of Document Analysis
Table 4: Yin’s Tactics for Case Study Design
Table 5: Governance Control Form and Corresponding Levels of Vertical Coordination
Table 6: Oversight and Influence of Decision-making and Governance Control Form
Table 7: Levels of Vertical Coordination and Organizational Goal Achievement
Table 8: Vertical Coordination, and Cost and Revenue Incentives
Table 9: Governance Control Forms and Levels of Lateral Coordination
Table 10: Levels of Lateral Coordination and Institutional Goal Achievement
Table 11: Unit Autonomy and Diagnostic Governance Control Form’s Relationship to
Vertical Coordination
Table 12: Unit Autonomy and Diagnostic Governance Control Form’s Relationship to
Lateral Coordination
Table 13: Unit Autonomy and Hybrid Governance Control Form’s Relationship to Vertical
Coordination
Table 14: Unit Autonomy and Hybrid Governance Control Form’s Relationship to Lateral
Coordination
Table 15: Governance Control Forms and Unit Autonomy
xiii
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1: Study Model
Figure 2: Example of a Centralized Budgeting and Decision-making Structure
Figure 3: Example of an RCB/M Decision-making Structure
xiv
LIST OF APPENDICES
Appendix 1: Budget Typology Table
Appendix 2: Public Higher Education Institutions in the Times Higher Education North
America Top 50 Rankings and Corresponding Budgeting and Management System
Appendix 3: Walter et al.’s Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness
Appendix 4: Lateral Coordination and Governance Control Form Matrix
Appendix 5: Vertical Coordination and Governance Control Form Matrix
Appendix 6: Method-Process Graphic
Appendix 7: Steps and Phases of Study
Appendix 8: Interview Protocol
Appendix 9: Contact Letter to Potential Participants
Appendix 10: Ethics Approval Letter
Appendix 11: Interviewee Consent Form
Appendix 12: Informed Consent Letter
Appendix 13: Matrix for Case Comparison
Appendix 14: Coding Scheme Start List
Appendix 15: Triangulation Matrix for Research Questions
Appendix 16: Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness for Midwestern U.S.
University
Appendix 17: Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness for Central Canadian
University
xv
LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS
HEI: Higher Education Institution
MCS: Management Control System
ISE: Institute for Studies in Education
RCB: Responsibility Center Budgeting
RCB/M: Responsibility Center Budgeting and Responsibility Center Management
RCM: Responsibility Center Management
SUNY: State University of New York
UBM: University Budget Model and System (Midwestern U.S. University)
US: University System
VCM: Value Center Management (Midwestern U.S. University)
DuPont: E.I. DuPont de Nemours and Company
M-Form: Multi-divisional Organization
1
CHAPTER ONE
FRAMING THE ISSUE
SECTION 1.1 – INTRODUCTION
Budgeting and management have long been of interest to higher education
scholars (Birnbaum, 2000; Birnbaum & Edelson, 1989; Blau, 1973; Burgess & Pratt, 1970;
Clark, 1960, 1972, 1986; Hawley, Boland & Boland, 1965; Keller, 1983; Lang, 1999a;
Lang, 1999b; Massy, 1996; Millet, 1962; Whalen, 1991). Recently, there has been an
increased interest in and study of various forms of decentralized budgeting and
corresponding management structures within higher education (Cekic, 2010; Ehrenberg,
2012; Lepori, Usher & Montauti, 2013; Zeirdt, 2009). Budgeting and governance are
management control systems that organizational leaders utilize to direct organizational
outcomes. Within higher education, budgeting has traditionally been a centralized fund
accounting process (Hearn, Lewis, Kallsen, Holdsworth, & Jones, 2006); decentralized
budgeting and management structures represent a fundamental strategic shift in the
higher education context (Fuchsberg, 1989; Stocum & Rooney, 1997; Whalen, 1991).
Decentralized budgeting and management within higher education institutions [HEIs]
has been drawn from private industry, where it has been in use since the early
twentieth century (Deering & Sá, 2014; Drucker, 1946). The interest in decentralized
budgeting and management structures shown by HEIs can be largely attributed to
increasing organizational complexity, rising costs, and enduring constraints on revenue
streams. The fluid and challenging higher education environment has encouraged a
number of large and research intensive HEIs to adopt decentralized budgeting and
2
management systems such as Responsibility Center Budgeting and Responsibility Center
Management [RCB/M] (Hearn et al., 2006; Lepori et al. 2013).
RCB/M is a managerial framework that encompasses the internal budgeting,
financial reporting, and decision-making of the university with a focus on operational
decentralization. RCB/M consists of policies and procedures that underlie the financial
planning, decision-making, and management of the university. It divides the university
into units, each responsible for its own revenue and costs in such a way that budgeting
authority is aligned with responsibility. This decentralized approach to budget allocation
assigns greater control over resource decisions to unit leadership. In doing so, it
provides units with specific and measurable incentives to “exercise their considerable
authority responsibly for the benefit of themselves, their students, their organizational
units, and the institution as a whole” (Strauss & Curry, 2002, p.1). The underlying
premise of RCB/M is that its decentralized nature entrusts unit leaders with more
control of financial resources, leading to more informed decision-making and better
outcomes for the university as a whole.
The term unit denotes a budgeting entity at a university. The RCB/M model
divides the university into a number of units, each of which is responsible for its own
budget. Units can be classified according to function, usually being designated as either
academic [e.g. teaching departments, research units, libraries etc.] or service and
auxiliary [e.g. financial operations, admissions, residence halls etc.]. They can also be
classified according to whether they generate activity-based revenues. Activity-based
3
units are those that receive a significant portion of their revenue as a function of what
they do [e.g. enrolling students]. Non activity-based units are those that do not directly
generate sufficient revenues to cover an appreciable portion of their operations [e.g.
libraries, central financial operations etc.]. Each university varies in its creation of units,
but most often academic units represent individual faculties and colleges.
The adoption of RCB/M effects all parts of a university and changes the power
structure and, as a result, the internal structure of an HEI (Lang, 1999a). Because
decision-making and resource allocation are both integral to institutional success, and
because their format has the potential to fundamentally alter an HEI’s structure and
internal operations, it is important to investigate how they are interrelated.
Additionally, it is worthwhile to consider what impact these relationships have on the
units and institution’s ability to meet their goals. This study investigates four publicly
funded universities employing RCB/M by examining internal structure, the selection and
use of governance models, and the impact on unit-level decision-making.
SECTION 1.2 – OVERVIEW OF THE PROBLEM
The higher education environment is influenced by a variety of factors, both
external and internal to HEIs, which have been examined extensively in the extant
literature. The external factors that help shape HEI decisions include: 1. decreasing
government funding; 2. increasing competition for students, faculty and staff; and 3.
increasing societal expectations (Berdahl, Altbach & Gumport, 2011; Fisher, Rubenson,
4
Jones, & Shanahan, 2009; Metcalfe, Fisher, Gingras, Jones, Rubenson, & Snee, 2011).
The conflict between controlling costs and increasing access and capacity provides a
challenging operational context for institutions (Kirp, 2003; Toutkoushian, 2009). In the
face of these external challenges, HEIs are expected to meet societal obligations
through direct and indirect benefits to the communities in which they operate (Altbach,
1999; Anderson, 1988; Berdahl et al., 2011; Inman, Schütze, & Adam, 2010; Small, 1994;
Thelin, 2004). The conflicting institutional objectives of balancing budgets while
benefiting stakeholders lead to increasing organizational complexity through the
establishment of additional decision-making constraints. The complexity presented by
the external marketplace increases the ambiguity surrounding the three-part
institutional mission of research, teaching, and service, and the institutional necessities
of revenue development and cost control (Inman et al., 2010; Kirp, 2003; Toutkoushian,
2009); these conflicting institutional objectives [i.e. balancing budgets while benefiting
various constituent groups] results in an increasing demand for innovative resource
allocation decisions.
In addition to these external factors, HEIs today encounter a variety of internal
environmental factors that influence organizational decisions. These factors include: 1.
increasing organizational complexity caused by an increase in the breadth and
specialization of offerings; 2. the emerging prominence of managerialism and its impact
on the collegial model; 3. the challenge of cost containment; and 4. the increasing need
for new revenue streams (Deem and Brehony, 2005; Inman et al., 2010; Lang, 1999a;
Marginson & Considine, 2000; Metcalfe et al., 2011; Slaughter & Rhoades, 2004; Trow &
5
Clark, 1994). Of particular interest to this research are publicly funded comprehensive
research intensive HEIs, which are inherently complex due to the heterogeneity of
faculties and programs (Vancil, 1980). The outcome of complexity for the modern
university is described by Kerr, Gade and Kawaoka (1994) as growing to the point that
presidents, trustees, and governing boards have difficulty keeping abreast of the
activities, decisions, and finances that they are responsible for overseeing.
RCB/M has been adopted by an increasing number of HEIs in an attempt to more
efficiently allocate resources and manage organizational outcomes while concurrently
addressing the internal and external environmental factors described above (Cekic,
2010; Deering & Sá, 2014; Hearn et al., 2006; Priest, Becker, Hosler, & St. John, 2002;
Zierdt, 2009). The decentralized structure of RCB/M maps well onto the organizational
structure of the modern university, or, as Kerr (1982) termed it, the ‘multiversity,’ and
allows HEIs to manage the various and increasingly complex challenges that they face
(Kerr, 2001; Lepori et al., 2013). Contrary to the homogeneous and centralized
organizational structure implied by the term university, current HEIs are subdivided into
numerous disciplinary, sub-disciplinary, and interdisciplinary units. Under an RCB/M
structure, decision-making responsibilities are assigned to the department or faculty
level; this local decision-making offers institutions the opportunity to increase the
efficiency of resource allocation and to improve decision-making capabilities (Hearn et
al., 2006; Jarvie, 2002; Lang, 1999b; Whalen, 1991). To these ends, RCB/M is expected
to encourage both rationality and decision-making that optimizes resource allocation
throughout the budget process (Chaffee, 1983).
6
The decentralized nature of the modern HEI presents challenges to traditional
centralized governance structures, which may become limited in their ability to
influence unit-level decision-making. The implementation of RCB/M exacerbates these
challenges through the formal decentralization of budgeting and management. The
decentralization process introduces a high degree of unit-level autonomy in decision-
making and resource allocation and is intended to encourage self-interested behaviour
by units. Due to the relatively decentralized nature of the modern university and the
decentralizing influence of RCB/M, the relationship between the governance model and
the internal structure of the institution should be considered. However, scant attention
has been paid to this relationship in the extant literature (Otley, 1994).
For this research, I use the term governance1 to denote the oversight provided to
decisions on policy and strategy made by the institutional and unit leadership (Kaplan,
2004). Moreover, governance consists of those processes and procedures that allocate
authority and responsibility for decision-making (Benjamin, Carroll, Gray, Krop, & Shires,
1993; Hirsch & Weber, 2001). That is, for this study the term governance is used to
describe the management and oversight provided by the central administration and by
leadership at the unit-level. As noted above, governance is a management control
system. As such, it can be applied either diagnostically [prescriptively] or interactively
[consultatively]. The application of governance at RCB/M institutions, either
1 It should be noted that in the higher education literature the term governance is often understood as meaning boards, senates, and university/government interfaces. However a broader conceptualization of this term, taken from the management control systems and organizational management literature, is used in this study.
7
interactively or diagnostically, is an important area of inquiry within this research. The
application of governance will be discussed at length throughout this study.
Increasingly, the criticisms present in the RCB/M literature identify outcomes
that may be the result of increased unit autonomy and a misalignment between
governance, management, and oversight structures (e.g. Adams, 1997; Cantor &
Courant, 1997; Erakovic & Overall, 2010; Jarvie, 2002; Kissler, 1997; Newberry & Jacobs,
2007). Birnbaum (1991) and Kennedy (1993) contend that institutions employing a
decentralized decision-making system without dismantling the old governance
structures, which are appropriate for use with traditional centralized decision-making
systems, are prone to experience a misalignment of process and oversight. Kirp (2003)
presents evidence of this type of misalignment at the University of Southern California
[USC]. After the implementation of RCB/M at USC, a number of unintended outcomes
became apparent; one example is that some schools of the university “went so far as to
alter their mission in order to generate revenues” (p.119); other schools changed their
hiring practices by bringing on professors that had “little sense of the profession but
could give bravura lectures that appealed to undergraduates” (p.119) resulting in
increased subscriptions to their courses and a subsequent increase in unit revenue.
These unintended outcomes resulted from a lack of oversight or control by the
university’s centralized governance structure. The result of this misalignment between
oversight and unit-level decision-making was a gaming of the system by some of the
schools at USC for their own myopic and self-interested ends. Kirp’s findings are
reaffirmed by Mallon (2004), who argued that disjointed governance in HEIs may result
8
in decisions that influence the whole being made without alignment with any cohesive
plan.
Organizational challenges resulting from low levels of alignment between
governance and decision-making structures should come as no surprise. An
organization’s internal structure affects institutional choices (Chandler, 1962) and the
flow and exchange of information, including formal reporting (Weigelt & Miller, 2013),
and influences decisions regarding institutional governance (Fiss, 2008; Scott, 1999).
This is especially true in organizations that rely upon knowledge-intensive tasks and the
creation and dissemination of knowledge, such as higher education institutions (Alchian
& Demsetz, 1972; Milgrom & Roberts, 1990, 1992; Weigelt & Miller, 2013; Williamson,
1991). Many HEIs that have adopted RCB/M have faced challenges related to resource
allocation, decision-making, and the alignment between governance structures. By
design, this resource allocation and management model fundamentally changes the
organization’s internal structure, reporting, decision-making, and control mechanisms.
In light of these issues, the internal structure of an HEI is an important factor
when evaluating the relationship between RCB/M and governance structure. The intent
of this research is to analyze the relationship between decentralized decision-making
and governance structures in HEIs. By applying the concept of internal structure to the
relationship between RCB/M and governance, this study explores the alignment, or
misalignment, between the levels of decision-making and governance structures, and
the resulting organizational outcomes. The goals of this research are to contribute to
theory-building on internal structure, to explore the impact of governance model
9
selection on decision-making in decentralized budgeting and management systems, and
to investigate the level of alignment of unit goals and behavior with the institution’s
mission and strategic goals.
The concept of internal structure and the study of its influence on institutional
governance are rooted in the fields of economics, organizational design, sociology,
accounting, and management (e.g., Kretschmer & Puranam, 2008; Lawrence & Lorsch,
1967; Milgrom & Roberts, 1992; Mintzberg, 1979; Nadler & Tushman, 1997; Vancil,
1979; Williamson, 1991). Internal structure reflects an institution’s assignment of
decision-making responsibilities to units. Furthermore, it comprises the coordination, or
lack thereof, between the units, and between the unit and the institution as a whole
(Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967). Internal structure has a material impact on the ability of the
institution and its units to productively and efficiently allocate resources (Bower, 1986).
Additionally, internal structure affects the incentives for cooperation [or competition]
between units and between units and the institution (Milgrom & Roberts, 1992).
Weigelt and Miller’s (2013) recent study of 107 organizations found that internal
structure has an effect on the governance choices made by organizations. Moreover,
the authors revealed that internal structure affects how units will interact and align
efforts between each other and, potentially, with the institution. This interaction and
the effort to align unit decisions and behaviors with the HEI’s strategic goals and
direction are of interest to the governance research informing this study.
10
The governance structure in organizations employing RCB/M is often separated
into the diagnostic governance control form and the interactive governance control
form. Diagnostic governance control form specifies the rights and responsibilities of
each of the institution’s units and provides the structure through which institutional
strategy and direction is set, while concurrently attempting to ensure the alignment of
behaviors and outcomes between the unit level and the institution. Interactive
governance control form focuses on the way that decision-making authority is delegated
and oversees how units make decisions. Most importantly, interactive governance
control form is the process through which power is managed. Hence, the choice of
budgeting and management system has a material influence on the balance of power at
an institution and dictates the balance between diagnostic and interactive governance
control forms.
In a traditional centralized budgeting and management structure, central
administration through a diagnostic governance control form holds the majority of
power; this power is exerted through: 1. the setting of strategic goals; 2. the allocation
of budgets; and 3. oversight of the limited decision-making authority of the
organization’s sub-units. Additionally, the diagnostic governance control form often has
a large degree of input into unit-level decision-making in a centralized system (Simons,
2005). By contrast, in a decentralized budgeting and management structure the balance
of power shifts in favour of interactive governance control form structures, with power
being pushed downward to the organizational unit level.
11
To fully explore these relationships I have focused on four publicly funded
universities that have implemented and utilized RCB/M for a period of at least five
years. This five-year time period has been selected because it should have allowed for
the documentation of outcomes resulting from the implementation of RCB/M and its
relationships with internal structure and governance models. The target institutions
have been divided into two categories: 1. institutions that have implemented RCB/M
and have governance structures in place that provide for the oversight of and the power
to influence unit-level decision-making; and 2. institutions that have implemented
RCB/M and have governance structures in place that do not encourage comprehensive
oversight of and influence over unit-level decision-making.
In order to capture the nuances of HEIs as complex systems, this study utilized a
comparative case design (Denzin, 1970; Denzin & Lincoln, 2005). The data collection
methods [see Chapter Five] included document analysis and semi-structured interviews.
SECTION 1.3 - RESEARCH CONTRIBUTIONS
This research is significant because it explores the relationship between
decentralized budgeting and management structures and levels of vertical and lateral
coordination, unit autonomy and the effect of governance control forms on these
relationships [Figure 1]. In doing so, it examines the resource allocation decisions of and
the relationships between the institutional units and the central institutional
administration, and measures the resulting institutional outcomes.
12
Figure 1: Study Model
This research fills a gap in the literature by identifying the crucial question of
whether RCB/M will have a material effect on institutional governance structures and
institutional outcomes. Also, it presents to the higher education literature a new
approach to the conceptualization of governance. Finally, it presents a testable
theoretical model that is intended to advance the literature surrounding RCB/M, which
has been, for the most part, normative and descriptive in nature.
Management Control System
Vertical
Coordination
Lateral
Coordination
Unit
Autonomy
Inte
ract
ive
Go
vern
ance
Co
ntr
ol
Form
Hyb
rid
Go
vern
ance
Co
ntr
ol
Form
Dia
gno
stic
Go
vern
ance
Co
ntr
ol
Form
RCB/M
13
CHAPTER TWO
LITERATURE REVIEW
SECTION 2.1 - INTRODUCTION
This chapter provides a review and discussion of the concepts and bodies of
literature that form the basis of this study. Additionally, it builds a conceptual
foundation for Chapter Three, where the theoretical considerations and three-factor
model of internal structure are presented. This chapter begins with a general discussion
of budgeting in HEIs and of the conventional forms of university budgeting. An overview
of the attributes and outcomes of traditional centralized budgeting is then presented,
leading to the introduction of RCB/M, the history of its use in for-profit industry and its
subsequent adoption as a budgeting and management system in higher education. An
examination of the forces that compel the use of RCB/M in higher education is
presented, as well as critiques of RCB/M from the extant literature. Governance
structures, as used in decentralized HEIs, are reviewed, highlighting institutional
approaches to governance. The concept of management control systems [which include
budgeting, governance, and organizational structure] and the concepts of diagnostic and
interactive control forms are presented, with specific attention paid to their applicability
in RCB/M institutions. Following this discussion, a review of organizational internal
structure and its relationship with institutional control mechanisms is presented. Finally,
this chapter closes with a short discussion of the measurement of higher education
mission and goal attainment. As the focus of this study is on the budgeting, governance,
14
and internal structure of universities, the literature reviews will explore concepts,
models, and studies with direct ties to these focal subjects.
SECTION 2.1.1 – BUDGETING IN HIGHER EDUCATION INSTITUTIONS
Budgeting occupies a key role within strategic and operational planning in HEIs
(Lasher & Greene, 2001) and has become a way of dealing with “present and future
problems in an organized fashion” (Meisinger & Dubeck, 1984, p.6). Budgeting is the
continuous process used to allocate finite resources to meet the needs and realize the
goals of the institution (Goldstein, 2005; Zierdt, 2009) and can be considered a set of
organizational objectives with price tags attached (Wildavsky, 1964). Budgeting provides
“a framework for rational, efficient and predictable allocation of resources” and acts as
“an incentive system to guide the decisions and activities of administrators and faculty”
(Carnaghi, 1992, p.1). It has become a tool for translating financial resources into
actionable objectives. Simply stated, budgeting is the set of tools used by institutions to
control, direct, and constrain spending decisions.
The purpose of the budgeting model is to support policy implementation, but it
should not be considered a substitute for policymaking (Courant & Knepp, 2002). The
budget model incorporates only the actual budget tools and process, whereas the
budget system includes policy-making, decision-making, and the authority and values of
those participating in the budget system.
The concept of budgetary constraint is based on concepts defined in the
microtheory of the household (Kornai, 1986) and describes a situation in which the
15
rational planning process of decision-makers is constrained by the finite resources
available to them. The decision-makers, in this case HEIs and their units, must consider
existing financial obligations and limit expenditures to fit within available resources. The
process of budgeting requires an understanding of the current fiscal constraints and a
simultaneous consideration of the future position of the institution, when the actual
expenditures and incomes will be realized (Clower, 1965; Clower & Howitt, 1978;
Kornai, 1986).
Budgeting is a vital planning process for HEIs and is increasingly significant due to
the complex environment they operate in (Jones, 1984; Keitiline & Eugenio, 2010; Lepori
et al., 2013; Teichler, 2006). The complexity of the higher education context is due in
part to its wide scope and diversity of operations; the budgeting process is used to help
mitigate this complexity through improved decision-making. Improvement in decision-
making is achieved by delegating spending authority, providing accountability, and
assisting the institution in designing and then achieving its mission, goals, and
objectives. The budgeting process, then, facilitates the management of institutional
progress by tracking and evaluating resource allocation decisions.
SECTION 2.1.2 - CONVENTIONAL FORMS OF UNIVERSITY BUDGETING
Various approaches and methodologies have been used by universities to
prepare and deploy budgets [Appendix 1]. Lasher and Greene (1993, 2001) provide a
16
comprehensive review of the subject2, noting four distinct budget typologies in their
analysis. The first kind of budget typology is a centralized control approach termed
executive budgeting. This approach is often a response to the perception of waste and
inefficiency present in universities. The second approach, which is termed performance-
based budgeting, seeks to use work measures and cost accounting in an attempt to
accurately attribute costs and outcomes to the various units of the university. The third
approach to university budgeting is known as a programming, planning, and budgeting
system. This approach is intended to link dollars to objectives and highlight the role of
planning in the budgeting process. The final approach, incentive based budgeting
systems, is a combination of performance-based budgeting and strategic planning. It is
this approach that is of primary interest to this study.
Traditionally, HEIs have employed a centralized structure for budgeting and
decision-making (Massy, 1996). This centralized or “top-down” approach to budgeting
and decision-making places the responsibility for budget development for the entire
institution with senior administrators [Figure 2]. This process requires senior
administrators to use their knowledge and experience to estimate future expenses.
Based on past data and planned initiatives, budgetary goals for revenue, expenses, and
expansion are set. These budgetary goals and constraints are then communicated to the
faculty level for implementation. This process results in units possessing limited
autonomy in allocating or reallocating resources. Centralized budget planning has been
2 Also see Rodas’ 2001 Resource Allocation in Private Research Universities for a detailed discussion of budgeting and resource allocation models used in private universities. It should be noted that many of these structures are also employed at public universities.
17
used successfully in a variety of institutions. Gibson (2009) has identified several
advantages of the centralized budgeting approach. First, centralized budget planning
tends to consider the needs of the entire organization and reflects the institutional
leadership’s larger strategic objectives. Second, it tends to consolidate and standardize
information across the institution. Finally, it centralizes controls and procedures, helping
to ensure consistent offerings throughout the institution.
Figure 2: Example of a Centralized Budgeting and Decision-making Structure
Centralized budget planning is not without challenges. Namely, it is dependent
on having senior administrators with significant experience in managing the needs of
the various diverse faculties and functional area groups of the institution (Meisinger,
1994). In order for centralized budget planning to be successful, senior administrators
and leadership must understand the complex reality of each unit to avoid setting
Central Administration
Unit Unit Unit
Downward flow of budgets,
goals and decision-making
Upward flow of decision and budgetary outcomes
18
inappropriate or unattainable budget levels and expectations (Lasher & Green, 2001).
Due to the increasing complexity of the higher education environment, the centralized
budgeting process is extremely difficult to implement with predictable success. As a
consequence, centralized budgeting and planning often results in disenfranchisement at
the unit-level, as the centralized budget fails to attend to the unique needs of the
various functional units; this disenfranchisement results in unit administrators
frequently ignoring or modifying the budgetary objectives delivered by the central
administration, creating a disconnect between plan and execution. Simply, the
centralized budgeting approach suffers from information asymmetries that are
reinforced by the relatively non-hierarchical command structures present in universities.
While centralized budgeting is the most commonly used approach in universities,
it is the least suited for examining and adjusting previous allocations to operating units
(Varlotta, Jones, & Schuh, 2010). It does not prompt unit-level leadership to consider
the outcomes of decisions made nor to re-examine issues when resources shrink. It
becomes an automatic process with little long-term strategic planning.
Centralized budgeting has also been found to negatively correlate with
cooperation and coordination (Goodwin & Gouw, 1997). Conversely, increased budget
autonomy at the unit-level has been found to increase cooperation and coordination. To
achieve increased cooperation and coordination, there must be high levels of budget
participation and decision-making power such that unit leadership is actively involved in
the setting of budget goals and influencing outcomes (Hassel, 1993). This increased unit-
19
level involvement in the budgetary planning process does not align well with a
centralized budgeting model.
In response to the deficiencies identified in the centralized budgeting process,
and as a result of the increasing complexity and heterogeneity of faculties and programs
of large research-intensive institutions (Vancil, 1980), a decrease in funding (Bok, 2003;
Deering & Sá, 2014; Kirp, 2003; McConaghy, 1997; Toutkoushian, 2009), increasing
operational costs (Lasher & Green, 1993; Paulsen & Smart, 2001), and the need for
quicker responses to societal demands (Lang, 1999b; Massy, 1996), some HEIs have
decentralized their budgeting and management systems. This move towards
decentralization is often undertaken in an effort to make more effective resource
allocation decisions (Govindarajan, 1986).
SECTION 2.2 - RCB/M: AN INTRODUCTION
Budgeting and management processes are often decentralized with the intent of
providing the operating units of the university more autonomy in their decision-making
than they experienced in a traditional centralized budgeting system. Under RCB/M, the
expected result of providing unit autonomy is that the individual units can, and will, act
in self-interest and make decisions that encourage efficiency, cost control, and revenue
generation (Holian & Ross, 2010; Lang, 1999b; Tolbert, 1985; Whalen, 1991). The
individual units are allowed to make decisions based upon their preferences and
expectations, but they bear the consequences through the carry-forward of deficits and
surpluses in future budget cycles. For this reason, it is expected that the units will act
20
under a strong incentive to make decisions aligned with their own well-being while
simultaneously demonstrating increased institutional flexibility (Hearn, 2006; Hearn et
al., 2006). The expected result is an increase in the efficiency of operations.
RCB and RCM are two terms that are often used interchangeably (Lang, 1999a).
However, they are different from one another and describe two independent but often
related processes. RCB is the management of information that is collected and used to
inform decision-makers about the total costs and total revenue attributable to a
university unit, either academic, support, or administrative in function (Lang, 1999a).
This information identifies only those aspects of institutional performance that result in
the display of total revenue and total expense reports. Thus, RCB provides the unit with
only cost and revenue attributions and omits most contextual information. Conversely,
RCM provides the unit with management control. The result is managers who possess
the contextual information needed making decisions. By instituting appropriate
management and budget structures, the unit takes control of the income it generates
and responsibility for the expenses it incurs while delivering its programs (Lang, 1999a;
Whalen, 1991). Together, RCB and RCM form the attribution process of costs and
revenue, and the control and management processes used to direct the implementation
of strategic and operational goals. The process created by the combination of RCB and
RCM [RCB/M] is expected to increase revenues and decrease costs through the
encouragement of market-like behaviour by the academic units of the institution.
Through this market-like behaviour, it is expected that these processes will enhance the
fit between educational supply and demand (Lang, 1999a).
21
RCB/M divides a university into a number of academic, support and
executive/central administrative units [Figure 3], with each unit being responsible for
generating its own income and managing its own expenses (Lang, 2001; Whalen, 1991).
Academic units carry out the threefold mission of education, research, and public
service. These units produce income through tuition, fees, state appropriates, grants,
contracts, endowments, and contributions. The academic units are also known as
income-producing units. Support and executive units charge the income-producing units
for services provided to them. These services include back office processes, facilities
management, and institutional management. The executive/central administrative units
are responsible for the definition of the overall mission and strategic direction of the
institution.
Figure 3: Example of an RCB/M Decision-making Structure
Central Administration
Unit Unit Unit
General budget allocations
and organizational strategy
made at the organizational
level
Resource allocation
decisions made at the unit
level
Downward flow of general
strategic goals, mission, and
budget amounts
Upward flow of budget line
reporting, and decisions and
budgetary outcomes
22
SECTION 2.2.1 - RCB/M IN INDUSTRY
RCB/M is consistent with the concept of decentralization used in for-profit
industry, as described by Drucker (1946), Becker and Gordon (1966), and Ford and
Slocum (1977). With its roots in the ‘DuPont System,’ first used by E.I. DuPont de
Nemours and Company [DuPont] in the years preceding 1920 and further developed by
Donaldson Brown and Alfred Sloan at General Motors in the 1920s, RCB/M has become
the dominant budgeting and management structure in the for-profit sector today.
Decentralized budgeting and management systems began to gain popularity
throughout the mid-20th century as a result of Peter Drucker’s documentation of the
experiences of decentralization at General Motors in his seminal work, “Concept of the
Corporation” (1946). The new organizational structure described by Drucker required a
new budgeting and management approach to enable efficient operations and the rapid
reaction needed in the increasingly complex and dynamic operating environment of the
1940s. Since the 1940s, decentralized budgeting and management structures have
become the dominant form of organizational design in for-profit industry. Following the
adage “let managers manage,” decentralized budgeting and management systems were
a good fit for the increasingly complex and diversified companies operating in the early
twentieth century.
During Alfred Sloan’s tenure as president and chairman at General Motors, a
small head office unit, responsible for the overall direction of the firm, oversaw a vast
and growing organization that was divided into a variety of units. Each unit was
23
responsible for budgeting, cost control, and revenue generation. Reporting consisted of
budgetary reports, based on statements of profit and loss, to the head office. This
corporate budgeting structure served as the basis of Drucker’s (1946) conceptualization
of a multi-divisional organizational design [M-form], as laid out in The Concept of the
Corporation.
The M-form structure of organizational design was pioneered by DuPont and
General Motors after the First World War. With the need to diversify operations in
order to produce growth for the company and profits for shareholders, DuPont and later
General Motors sought out new products, services, and industries in which to operate.
This diversification increased the complexity of the organizations and rendered obsolete
the traditional unitary form of organizational structure and its corresponding budgeting,
management, and governance systems. The result was the creation of the M-form
structure, which allowed increased diversification, unit differentiation, and growth. It
allowed for the economies of scale that are present in a large corporation while
permitting operational flexibility and nimble local decision-making at the unit level. The
use of the M-form structure and decentralized budgeting and management systems by
General Motors resulted in substantial increases in profit and growth; the results
experienced by General Motors created a strong incentive for the mass adoption of
these two systems across a variety of industries and countries.
In 1962, Chandler stated that “the multi-divisional form, which hardly existed in
1920, had, by 1960, become the accepted form of management of the most complex
24
and diverse of American industrial enterprises” (p. 48-49). Mintzberg (1983) identifies
this M-form structure as the most efficient organizational arrangement for large,
complex, and diversified organizations. Led by a central head office unit that oversees
strategy creation in the form of general direction, goals and expectations [e.g. return on
investment, leverage levels, growth etc.], decentralized units have almost complete
authority over strategy implementation.
Beginning in the 1960s and continuing through the 1980s, it became clear that
RCB/M systems produce the most efficient outcomes when they are part of a holistic
framework of structural, procedural, governance, and oversight processes; these
processes have come to be known as management control systems in both the
accounting and management literatures. RCB/M must be part of a broader framework
of relationships to be effective and should not be arbitrarily used without consideration
of organizational structure, design, governance, and oversight processes. RCB/M and
variations of the M-form Corporation are today in widespread use in government (e.g.
Lapsley, 1994; Thompson, 1998; Thompson & Jones, 1986) and higher education (e.g.
Deering & Sá, 2014; Hearn et al., 2006; Lang, 1999a; Whalen, 1991).
SECTION 2.2.2 - RCB/M IN HIGHER EDUCATION
As outlined above, RCB/M has been used in for-profit organizations for most of
the twentieth century (Merchant, 1989). However, this structure only came to the
higher education context in the early 1970s. In 1974, RCB/M was fully adopted, for the
first time in higher education, at the University of Pennsylvania. This implementation
25
came as a response to the severe decreases in revenue, negative demographic trends,
and increasing costs experienced throughout the higher education context of the early
1970s, termed the depression of higher education (Cheit, 1971, 1973). The use of
RCB/M in higher education spread during the 1970s, with a form of RCB/M
implemented at Harvard University on the premise “every tub on its own bottom”
(Whalen, 1991). By the 1980s, decentralization was evident at the University of
Southern California, the University of Michigan, and the University of Indiana, among
others (Hearn et al., 2006; Lasher & Green, 1993; Rodas, 2001). More recent examples
of RCB/M adoption can be seen at the University of Toronto, the University of New
Hampshire, Kent State University, the University of Illinois Urbana Champaign, and the
University of Iowa, to name but a few. In the United States, the University of Arizona
and the University of Washington, among others, are in the process of implementing
RCB/M systems (Hart 2012; Koch, Reynolds, & Rimai, 2012); in Canada the trend is
similar, with the University of Saskatchewan, McMaster University, Queen’s University,
Okanagan College, and the University of Windsor all at various stages of the evaluation
and implementation process (Deering & Sá, 2014). With the increasing number of
institutions having implemented RCB/M processes, it is clear that such budgeting
systems are here to stay and cannot be considered a passing trend in higher education
management (Birnbaum, 2000).
As noted above, an increasing number of North American universities have
adopted RCB/M since the 1970s. It is noteworthy that, in general, public universities
implemented this system later than private universities (Brinkman & Morgan, 1997). By
26
the early 1990s, only a few public universities had adopted RCB/M (Whalen, 1996).
However, this situation has rapidly changed; currently, more than half of the North
American public universities in the top 50 of the Times Higher Education Ranking having
adopted a form of RCB/M [Appendix 2]. This trend should come as no surprise as RCB/M
has been promoted as a set of tools and processes that will encourage the increase of
efficiencies and revenues for HEIs (Lang, 1999b; Whalen, 1991). This approach to
budgeting and management leads the central administration to delegate the locus of
decision-making authority to the Dean of the faculty, or even to the departmental level,
in an effort to drive organizational efficiencies and revenue-seeking behavior.
In the field of higher education, RCB/M has grown in both popularity and rate of
implementation since the University of Pennsylvania first adopted the model in 1974. Its
popularity stems from the financial constraints and contextual challenges faced by HEIs
within the increasingly globalized higher education marketplace. Strauss and Curry
(2002) have identified four major objectives of RCB/M: 1. clarifying and discriminating
the roles and responsibilities of local and central units, 2. linking cause and effect
through revenue and cost allocations, 3. placing local academic planning and decision-
making in a cost/benefit context, and 4. unleashing entrepreneurship. These objectives
reflect the changing higher education context and can be linked to the increasing
interest in RCB/M by HEIs today.
27
SECTION 2.2.3 - FORCES THAT COMPEL THE USE OF RCB/M BY HIGHER EDUCATION INSTITUTIONS
Over the past two decades, HEIs have increasingly embraced the implementation
of RCB/M in response to increasing operational costs, (Ehrenberg & Rizzo, 2004; Priest,
Jacobs, & Boon, 2006; Toutkoushian, 2009), a globalizing marketplace, and pronounced
constraints on public funding (Anderson, 1988; Berdahl et al., 1999; Bok, 2003; Kirp,
2003). Additionally, higher education is becoming a more competitive marketplace;
within this changing educational landscape, institutions seeking improved organizational
efficiency are moving toward decentralization in order to remain competitive and, in
some cases, financially viable.
The case for RCB/M begins with the premise that information about costs and
revenues should be transparent and managed. As Lang (1999a, 1999b) notes,
transparency is achieved by systematically allocating direct and overhead costs, and by
entering all costs and incomes into the budget so that they can be known. As discussed
above, RCB is the collection and use of the total costs and revenues attributable to an
academic unit, and is intended to guide decision-makers (Lang, 1999a; Strauss & Curry,
2002; Whalen, 1991). Conversely, RCM provides the academic unit with management
processes that facilitate autonomy, responsibility, and control. The structure resulting
from the combination of RCB and RCM is expected to promote a number of positive
outcomes for the university, including: 1. decreasing costs and increasing revenues
through the encouragement of market-like behaviour by academic units; 2.
enhancement of the fit between educational supply and demand; and 3. the promotion
28
of management structures that support academic units taking control of the income
that they generate and responsibility for the expenses that they incur while delivering
their programs (Hearn et al., 2006; Lang, 1999b; Priest et al., 2002; Whalen, 2002).
The decentralized nature of RCB/M is arguably congruent with the university as
an organization. The university is, by its very nature, decentralized; this decentralized
organizational structure occurs because the required understanding of teaching and
research programs and of the professional requirements of faculty, staff, and students
can only be achieved locally at the departmental level. For this reason, and because the
natural state of the university is to push away from central control, Cyert (1981) argued
that authority and power should rest at the departmental level. Thus, the structure of
RCB/M maps well onto the organizational structure of the research university and
allows academic leaders to manage locally the various and complex challenges that they
face (Vaira, 2004). The localness encouraged by decentralization allows for
responsiveness not available through a centralized management and power structure.
RCB/M provides more authority to the level where there is the greatest recognition of
the needs and direction of academic disciplines and fields. It is in this local approach
that universities may find the most efficient resource allocations and the most effective
associated governance structures.
RCB/M represents a fundamental strategic shift in higher education budgeting
and management away from central decision-making towards more local control
(Fuchsberg, 1989; Jarvie, 2002; Lang, 1999a; Stocum & Rooney, 1997; Whalen, 1991). In
29
the face of increasing operating costs (Ehrenberg & Rizzo, 2004; Priest et al., 2006;
Toutkoushian, 2009) and constraints on public funding (Anderson, 1988; Berdahl et al.,
1999; Bok, 2003; Kirp, 2003), many HEIs have reconsidered their budgeting and
management processes with a focus on adopting more efficient and institutionally
effective budgetary systems (Jarvie, 2002; Lang, 1999b; Whalen, 1991); many higher
education institutions have considered RCB/M to be a tool to help overcome the
environmental challenges that they face.
For large HEIs, internal organizational complexity has necessitated an increase in
the effectiveness of resource allocation decisions. Increasing organizational complexity
has been shown to result in oversight challenges and reduced transparency in decision-
making, presenting a formidable challenge for institutional leaders (Elsas, Hackethal, &
Holzhäuser, 2010; Klein & Saidenberg, 2008). More distally, organizational complexity
may result in: 1. bureaucratic rigidity; 2. the intensification of agency problems between
divisions of the institution; 3. increased systemic risk due to negative externalities and
growing interdependencies; 4. mounting levels of moral hazard; and 5. increasing
oversight costs arising from the need for multiple supervision efforts.
Universities and colleges also face goal complexity. HEI goals are inherently
complex and at times conflicting (Birnbaum 1988; Bok 2003; Kirp 2003); Alexander
(1998) has found a link between the contextual complexities experienced by HEIs and
the increasing goal complexity that often results in disagreements and conflicts over
institutional goals. These disagreements encourage failure in the attainment of stated
30
strategic goals and institutional missions. Birnbaum (1988) identified contextual
complexity as an antecedent to increasing financial constraints as institutions endeavour
to respond to external demands beyond those that are linked to institutional mission or
strategic goals. Thus, these conflicting goals can increase financial constraints faced by
institutions.
The external context that these institutions operate in is equally complex. In this
multifaceted market, institutional goals include increasing knowledge production,
discretionary funds, revenue, and the control of costs (Kirp, 2003; Toutkoushian, 2009).
In addition to overcoming the challenges posed by the competitiveness of the market,
these institutions must fulfill their obligation to provide direct and indirect benefits to all
those in society (Anderson, 1988; Berdahl et al., 1999; Thelin, 2004; Toutkoushian,
2009). The conflicting institutional objectives of balancing budgets while benefiting
stakeholders and the public at large result in increasing operational costs and growing
decision-making constraints.
Government funding, an important source of revenue for many North American
HEIs, continues to decline (Anderson, 1988; Berdahl et al., 1999; Bok, 2003; Deering &
Sá, 2014) while societal and economic factors reduce the ability of many students to
finance a higher education (Birnbaum, 1988; Priest et al., 2006). This revenue pressure
has created an environment that demands the most efficient use of finite resources and
the identification and fostering of additional revenue streams.
31
In addition to the competition for revenue, there is also increasing competition
in attracting and retaining students (Bok, 2003; Kirp, 2003). Increasing domestic and
international competition (Fisher et al., 2009; Marginson, 2003; Metcalfe, 2010),
including online offerings (Allen & Seaman, 2008), has had a significant impact on the
revenues and costs of providing education services. The new reality for HEIs is that they
operate in an increasingly competitive market (Birnbaum, 1988; Fisher et al., 2009; Kirp,
2003), with few institutions able to increase tuition as a primary source of increased
revenue.
The final category of challenges that has compelled the use of RCB/M by higher
education institutions is increasing internal costs. The literature offers a number of
explanations for internal cost increases. These include but are not limited to: 1. the
expanding of academic program opportunities; 2. personnel costs and faculty salary
growth; 3. the need to meet competitive employment offers from private industry and
other HEIs; 4. new technology needed to avoid obsolescence; 5. rising utility costs; 6.
plant maintenance expenses; 7. federal regulations and mandated programs; and 8.
decreasing federal and state or provincial aid (Carnes, 1987; Deering & Sá, 2014; Lasher
& Green, 1993; Massy, 1989; Meisinger & Dubeck, 1984; Paulsen & Smart, 2001; St.
John, 1994).
32
SECTION 2.2.4 - CRITICISMS OF RCB/M
There have been a number of vocal critics of RCB/M from within the academy.
What follows is not intended to provide a comprehensive account of the critiques but
rather to demonstrate the general areas of concern that numerous scholars share.
The information that underlies RCM/B identifies only those aspects of
institutional performance that result in the display of total revenue and total expense
reports. Thus, it provides the academic division with only cost and revenue attributions
and omits most contextual information. This may encourage the elimination of
programs that are institutionally or socially important but under-subscribed (Adams,
1997; Cantor & Courant, 1997). It may also lead to a focus on revenue through
enrollment-driven initiatives and encourage the perspective of the student as a
“customer” to be served rather than as an individual to be developed (Gros Louis &
Thompson, 2002). A number of studies have argued that the focus on increasing
revenue may encourage the commercialization or marketization of higher education
(e.g. Adams, 1997; Cantor & Courant, 1997; Courant & Knepp, 2002; Gros Louis &
Thompson, 2002; Slaughter & Rhoades, 2004).
As each academic unit becomes more autonomous, internal competition may
ensue at the expense of campus-wide goals and collaborative programs; this type of
conflict between units and the institution has been well documented in the literature
(Kirp & Roberts, 2002; Lasher & Greene, 2001; Gros Louis and Thompson, 2002;
Whalen, 2002). For example, conflicts over “service teaching,” which might lead to the
duplication of courses and resulting inefficiencies, could have a profound effect on the
33
institution (Adams, 1997). Faculties may be encouraged to limit the number of courses
that their students take at other faculties on campus for financial reasons, as the home
faculty of the student will be charged by the teaching faculty for those courses.
Although it might make academic sense for students to take the course at a different
faculty, this would result in increased costs to the students’ home faculty and thus may
be discouraged. This financial relationship between academic units creates the incentive
for faculties to limit the number of courses students are allowed to take at other
faculties through modification of degree program requirements or through academic
advising that promotes courses within the home faculty. Additionally, this may
encourage the creation and delivery of courses by one faculty that have traditionally
been provided, in the form of service teaching, by another faculty. For example, an
engineering faculty experiencing excess teaching capacity might create a first year
calculus course that, until then, was offered by the school’s faculty of arts and sciences.
Besides the duplication of courses and resulting organizational inefficiencies, the
revenue and cost attribution mechanism may discourage interdisciplinary programs and
cross-departmental collaboration for similar reasons (Cantor & Courant, 1997).
The focus placed on increasing revenue by institutions operating in an RCB/M
model may lead to rising costs. Many have hypothesized that universities do not make
decisions to minimize costs (Brinkman, 1989; Clotfelter, Ehrenberg, Getz, & Siegfried,
1991; Ehrenberg, 2000; Martin, 2005). Bowen’s (1980) Revenue Theory of Cost provides
one explanation for why the focus on new revenue streams and increasing revenue will
only result in increased expenditures for the university. The fundamental premise of
34
Bowen’s theory is that universities will spend all revenue that they raise in pursuit of
their mission and institutional prestige. If revenue increases so too will costs, creating
what Bowen refers to as a revenue-cost spiral.
With an intense focus on revenue, decisions may be made that decrease the
quality of education. Rhoades and Slaughter (2004) identified a trend in universities of
expanding revenue-producing courses and programs while increasing the number of
contingent instructors in order to keep the cost of delivering these courses as low as
possible. The authors suggest that this is a method of revenue generation and cost
efficiency that may decrease the quality of education provided. Bettinger and Long
(2004, 2006) found similar outcomes at the public universities they investigated, where
adjunct professors and graduate students were utilized as instructors in an attempt to
constrain costs. Consequently, the focus on revenue, especially in public research
universities, may threaten the quality of education provided.
Vandament (1989) and later Kissler (1997) questioned whether RCB/M would
remove the protection of high quality programs that could not support themselves
without funding from a central source. That is, the programs would not generate
enough revenue to meet or exceeded their costs. The University of Michigan is one
institution that has implemented an RCB/M structure while concurrently recognizing the
need to protect such programs. The solution developed at the University of Michigan is
an explicitly stated process that provides support for financially vulnerable programs
with revenues collected from the various units in the institution.
35
Adams (1997) suggested that the RCB/M structure might provide incentives that
result in the subversion of education policy and decision-making, thus weakening the
corrective cultural criticisms that the author argues should flow from HEIs. He argues
that, by following the economic rationality of RCB/M, higher education will become
more corporatized and will not fulfill its primary responsibility of promoting the cultural,
moral, civic, and academic enterprises. Rather, only the economic enterprise will remain
as Deans become managers and increasingly become subject to the “rationality of the
self-interested maximizer” (pg. 61).
Jarvie (2002) argues that RCB/M may fractionalize the university. However, it
may be more accurate to suggest that RCB/M exacerbates the inherently factionalized
nature the university. Instead of the collegial model that the academy has enjoyed for
centuries, RCB/M may allow [through competitive behaviour] predatory practices by
‘revenue centres’ against each other. The author argues that this behaviour will detract
from the real purpose of the university. However, it should be noted that contrary to
the homogeneous and centralized organizational structure implied by the term
university and by Jarvie’s critique, Kerr (2001) and Clark (1998, 2001) have argued that
current HEIs, or “multiversities” (Kerr, 2001), are subdivided into numerous disciplinary,
sub-disciplinary, and interdisciplinary units. Further, there are service units, consulting
units, ancillary units, for-profit units, laboratories, and incubators, to name but a few.
Jarvie’s concern about RCB/M fractionalizing HEIs may be without foundation because it
may merely be a reassertion of the description of organizational fragmentation that Kerr
first presented over three decades ago.
36
Ben-Ruwin (2010) states that RCB/M is anti-intellectual and is an attempt to
corporatize the university. Additionally, the author advances the concern that such
corporatization may “pose a dangerous threat to the way academic institutions have
been managed effectively and successfully” (pg. 2). Further, the author suggests that the
foundational concepts of academic freedom, shared vision, and mutual trust may be at
risk in institutions that employ a decentralized budgeting and management structure.
Finally, during an address at the Oregon Conference of the American Association
of University Professors, Buck (2002) provided a summary of the concerns about the
implementation of RCB/M, the potential result of economic rationality, and the
subsequent corporatization of higher education:
A vital college or university is supported by three equally critical pillars, academic
freedom, an equitable system of tenure, and a governance structure in which
faculty participate as full partners and officers of the institution. In my view,
there are two major threats to the continued viability of higher education in the
United States: the corporatization of the academy, especially at the level of the
governing board, and the overuse and abuse of contingent faculty. Both of these
trends have a profoundly negative impact on shared governance, academic
freedom, and the quality of the education we provide our students. (p.9)
Unfettered RCB/M, like laissez-faire capitalism, is prone to excesses (Lang,
1999a) and has the power to fundamentally change academe. Although the issues
37
presented above are valid threats, they may be the result of governance structures that
are incompatible with RCB/M. Lang (1999a) identified the need for new regulatory
arrangements that could control the economic rationality encouraged by RCB/M. This
study argues that new governance mechanisms, aligned with the decentralization
present in RCB/M institutions, may ensure that the results of RCB/M do not run contrary
to the mission and goals of the institution.
SECTION 2.3 - GOVERNANCE IN DECENTRALIZED HIGHER EDUCATION INSTITUTIONS
Many of the challenges faced by institutions implementing RCB/M are identified
in the Association of Governing Boards of Universities and Colleges Statement on Board
Responsibility for Institutional Governance (2010) document, including: 1. more diverse
student groups; 2. the highly competitive marketplace of higher education; 3. the cost
and commitment of faculty; 4. increasing operational costs in the face of insufficient
resources; 5. the challenge of accountability and scrutiny regarding student outcomes
and escalating tuition and fees; 6. the question of effective institutional governance in
the face of conflicting and competing goals; 7. the increasing focus on jobs and the
economy; and 8. the pace of change in society and the changing demands on the
institution.
A systematic review of the governance documents from various institutions has
revealed that some of them have moved forward with implementation without regard
to the impact on governance. At a number of these institutions, the information that
flows from the decentralized units to the governing boards is merely budgetary line
38
items, which lack the fidelity that promotes contextual understanding. The RCB/M
literature argues that if units have decision-making authority, or unit-level autonomy,
they will make self-interested decisions (Behn, 2003; Lang, 1999a; Whalen, 1991;
Zimmerman, 1995). This is problematic because these choices are not made in a vacuum
and their outcomes will affect other units or the institution as a whole. Simply, RCB/M
may remove the power of centralized authority to influence unit-level decision-making,
a power that would be present under a centralized, diagnostic form of governance. In
such a situation, there is a misalignment between process and oversight that can result
in serious ramifications for the institution due to an increasing level of moral hazard
(Birnbaum, 1991; Kennedy, 1993; Mallon, 2004)
As Lang (1999a) suggested, there need to be boundaries to the decisions made
by units under an RCB/M system. In its unfettered form, RCB/M is incompatible with
good governance. As previously stated, there is a lack of transparency in reporting that
limits the ability of senior administration and governance structures to direct units to
fulfill the goals, mission, and strategy of the institution. Further, unbounded RCB/M may
cause competition and conflict between units and campuses and, consequently, a
fragmentation of the collegial model.
Chandler (1962) proposed that the structure of an organization must follow its
strategy. Because the strategic approach to budgeting and management changes
materially when moving from a centralized to a decentralized state, the structure of the
organization should also change. To help ensure that appropriate decisions are being
made at the unit level, governance structures should be modified from a functional and
39
centralized structure to one that supports the decentralized resource allocation and
decision-making of RCB/M. Therefore, governance processes must be applied to the
levels of the institution where decision-making occurs.
Governance is a form of management control that operates within an institution
to bound decision-making and guide organizational outcomes. Governance as a control
form in HEIs encompasses both accounting-based and behaviorally-based controls
(Puxty, 1989). Accounting-based controls are those rules, regulations, processes, and
procedures put in place to bound decision-making; more recently, accounting-based
controls have become known as diagnostic control forms. Behaviorally-based or
interactive governance control forms are those controls constructed through
partnership, interaction, communication, and cooperation (Simons, 1995). In a
decentralized environment, behaviorally-based controls are thought to work best
(Simons, 2005). The following section provides a review of the management control
systems that are used to facilitate appropriate HEI governance structures that are
aligned with the decentralized decision-making present under RCB/M.
SECTION 2.3.1 - MANAGEMENT CONTROL SYSTEMS
The concept of management control was first defined by Robert Anthony in
1965. Anthony (1965) defined management control as the process managers use to
ensure that resources are obtained and employed effectively and efficiently in the
accomplishment of the organization’s objectives. Anthony’s definition was intentionally
not industry-specific; this was to promote basic research that was not hindered by
40
industry specific realities and to enable future theoretical investigation. This lack of
specificity resulted in early management control research that was focused on
investigating the upper management ranks of larger, hierarchical organizations, similar
to the modern university in terms of breadth of unit differentiation and complexity of
environment (Otley 1994). Although Anthony prescribed that research into
management control systems [MCS] should be rooted in the behavioural sciences, the
majority of research to date has focused on accounting-based organizational controls
(Puxty 1989).
Building upon Anthony’s conceptualization, Lowe (1971) provided an updated
definition of MCS as:
A system of organizational information seeking and gathering, accountability
and feedback designed to ensure that the enterprise adapts to changes in its
substantive environment and that the work behaviour of its employees is
measured by reference to a set of operational sub-goals (which conform with
overall objectives) so that the discrepancy between the two can be reconciled
and corrected for (p.5).
When considering contemporary management control systems, it is important to
recognize that organizations, including HEIs, experience substantial environmental
uncertainty and continuously evolving operational goals and strategies. The definitions
of MCS provided by Anthony and Lowe both assume that the external operating
environment and operational goals are relatively stable (Otley 1994).
41
More recently, Otley, Broadbent and Berry (1995) assert that management
control is designed to ensure that the day-to-day tasks performed by all participants in
the organization come together in a coordinated set of actions, leading to overall goal
specification and attainment. According to this definition, MCS encompasses both
formal control systems and informal personal and social mechanisms of control (Bisbe &
Otley, 2004; Otley, 1980; Ouchi, 1977). Formal control systems comprise intentionally
designed, information-based structures, routines, processes, and procedures that are
used by managers to ensure the achievement of organizational strategy (Merchant,
1998; Simons, 1995). According to Simons (1987), management control systems are
formalized procedures and systems that rely on information to maintain or alter
patterns of organizational activity; these systems include: 1. planning systems; 2.
reporting systems; and 3. monitoring procedures (Henri, 2006).
Malmi and Brown (2008) further refine the definition of management control
systems to include “all the devices and systems managers use to ensure that the
behaviours and decisions of their employees are consistent with the organisation's
objectives and strategies, but exclude pure decision-support systems” (p. 290). An
illustration of the control systems considered by Malmi and Brown (2008) is presented
below [Table 1]; the control systems of interest to this study are circled in red.
42
Table 1: Management Control Systems Package
Cultural Controls
Clans
Values
Symbols
Planning Cybernetic Controls
Reward and Compensation
Long range
planning
Action
planning
Budgets
Financial
Measurement Systems
Non-financial Measurement
Systems
Hybrid
Measurement Systems
Administrative Controls
Governance
Structure
Organization Structure
Policies and Procedures
Source: Malmi, T. & Brown, D. (2008). Management control systems as a package - opportunities,
challenges and research directions. Management Accounting Research, 19(4), 287-300.
Traditionally, management control was located at senior levels within an
organization. However, with the fluid institutional operating environment that many
institutions experience today, responsibility for control and adaptation is being pushed
down to managers at lower organizational levels. This decentralization of responsibility
for organizational control and adaptation is especially salient in an RCB/M setting.
While the term management control still describes important managerial functions and
is an important area for scholarly investigation, it can no longer be applied to a specific
managerial level. In this context, the objective of management control becomes the
encouragement of various working units, across all levels of the organization, to take
control and responsibility for maintaining the viability of their parts of the organization
(Malmi & Brown, 2008).
43
The current body of management control literature is narrow and is focused on
accounting control mechanisms. Additional investigation into other management
control systems, such as performance measurement and appraisal and the selection of
development practices for personnel, management, and the organization, is needed
(Malmi & Brown, 2008).
The management control systems of interest to this study include: 1. budgeting
(e.g. Bunce, Fraser, Woodcock, 1995; Hansen, Otley, Van der Stede, 2003); 2.
governance structures (e.g. Abernethy & Chua, 1996); and 3. organizational structure
(e.g. Abernethy & Chua, 1996; Alvesson & Karreman, 2004; Emmanuel, Otley, Merchant,
1990; Otley & Berry, 1980). Budgeting is a central and foundational management
control system (Bunce et al., 1995) due to its "ability to weave together all the disparate
threads of an organisation into a comprehensive plan that serves many different
purposes, particularly performance planning and ex post evaluation of actual
performance vis a vis the plan" (Hansen et al., 2003; p. 96). Budgets have various
purposes within organizations, including the integration of processes and the allocation
of resources. However, as a control mechanism, budgeting is focused on planning
acceptable levels of behaviour and evaluating the resulting performance levels;
responsibility [often for specific financial measures] is often used as a control form
alongside budgeting (Malmi & Brown, 2008).
As a management control system, governance includes the formal avenues of
authority and accountability within an organization (Abernethy & Chua, 1996).
Additionally, governance control systems ensure that structures are in place whereby
44
representatives of the various organizational units meet to discuss and co-ordinate their
activities both vertically and laterally. Malmi and Brown (2008) note that governance
structures can be designed in a variety of ways and researchers should not group them
together; instead, governance should be studied in regard to how it interacts with other
control forms.
Organizational design can be a critical management control tool. By modifying
internal structure and organization, an institution can encourage certain types of
contact and relationships within its membership (Abernethy & Chua, 1996; Alvesson &
Karreman, 2004; Emmanuel et al., 1990). As a control form, organizational structure acts
to reduce variability in behaviour and increase predictability through the functional
specialization of individuals and units (Flamholtz, 1983). Malmi and Brown (2008)
consider organizational structure to be an important management control system and
not a contextual variable because it can be modified by managers to impact
organizational outcomes.
SECTION 2.3.2 - LEVERS OF CONTROL
Levers of Control is a management control framework developed by Robert
Simons (1995). Simons defines four levers, or methods of control that are used by
managers to direct organizational outcomes. The four levers that compose Simons’
framework are: 1. Belief Systems; 2. Boundary Conditions; 3. Diagnostic Control
Systems; and 4. Interactive Control Systems (Simons 1995). In Simons’ framework, belief
systems refer to organizational values and are manifested in mission or vision
45
statements, while boundary conditions describe organizational constraints on employee
behaviour; these elements are critical in Simons’ model, but they are not of primary
concern to this study. Diagnostic and interactive control systems are applicable to any
management control system [e.g. budgeting, governance and organization structure],
and as such are salient to this research. A comparison of diagnostic and interactive
control system uses is provided in Table 2.
Diagnostic control systems have been described in the literature as a
constraining force because they focus on negative variances, create constraints for
decision-making and resource allocation, and work to ensure compliance with
institutional policies and procedures through the identification of mistakes (Kapu
Arachchilage & Smith, 2013; Henri, 2006; Simons, 1995).
Table 2: A Comparison of Diagnostic and Interactive Control Form Use
Diagnostic Use of Controls
Interactive Use of Controls
Purpose Provide motivation and direction to achieve
Stimulate dialogue and organizational learning
Goal Prevent surprises Creative search
Analytic Reasoning Deductive Inductive
System Complexity Simple Complex
Time Frame Past and present Present and future
Targets Fixed Constantly re-estimated
Source: Thoren K. & Brown T. (2004). Development of Management Control Systems in Fast Growing
Small Firms. 13th Nordic Conference on Small Business Research. P. 3.
Diagnostic control systems are used to help in the achievement of organizational
strategies by focusing on correcting deviations from pre-set performance standards and
organizational objectives (Gond, Grubnic, Herzig & Moon, 2012; Henri, 2006). However,
46
due to their constraining nature, diagnostic controls may foster conservatism and could
stifle creativity (Otley, 2004). Diagnostic control systems may lead HEIs in an
organizational direction contrary to the rationale behind RCB/M implementation [i.e.
the need to identify innovative approaches to revenue growth and cost containment].
While diagnostic control systems act in a corrective manner through the
utilization of constraints and negative variance identification, interactive control
systems function more organically. Interactive controls utilize cooperation and
communication to create an open flow of information across the institution (Burns &
Stalker, 1961; Henri, 2006). Interactive control systems are tools that focus attention on
continuously changing information that is considered to be of strategic importance to
the organization. They rely heavily on the involvement of senior management, and this
involvement signals other members of the organization to give credence to the issues
addressed by the interactive management control system (Bisbe & Otley, 2004; Henri,
2006). The interactive use of management control systems is particularly well suited to
the higher education environment, where a strong tradition of collegial governance and
faculty involvement in decision-making is present. This fit increases in HEIs using an
RCB/M system because interactive control systems allow for participation, innovation,
and inter-unit cooperation and encourage the required levels of responsiveness.
Interactive control systems “facilitate a forum and an agenda for organizational
members to engage in the regular, face to face dialogue and debate that is required for
dealing with the non-routine, under-identified multi-disciplinary problems” present in
HEIs today (Bisbe & Otley, 2004). As Simons (2005) argues, senior managers can use
47
interactive controls to create internal incentives to break out of routines, stimulate
opportunity-seeking behaviour, and encourage the development of new strategic
initiatives (Gond et al., 2012); these characteristics align with the promises of RCB/M.
Although much of the extant literature speaks to the benefits of interactive
control systems, there is also extensive discussion of the necessary balance between
interactive and diagnostic control system use. Diagnostic and interactive control
systems should not be viewed as mutually exclusive; instead, they represent two
complementary methods of applying management control systems (Henri, 2006).
Thoren and Brown (2004) note that the difference between diagnostic and interactive
control systems is not their technical design, but rather the way they are employed
within organizations. The balance between diagnostic and interactive control systems
creates organizational tension, termed ‘dynamic tension’ in the literature. The essence
of any management control system is to balance the inherent tension between creative
innovation [interactive control] and predictable goal achievement [diagnostic control]
(Henri, 2006). In HEIs, as in all organizations, crucial organizational capabilities need to
be stimulated to allow for the achievement of organizational goals (Bourgeois &
Eisenhardt, 1988; Ghemawat & Costa, 1993). Dynamic tension can act as the trigger to
improve these organizational capabilities, thus increasing organizational performance
(Henri, 2006).
Improved organizational performance is one of the reasons often cited by HEIs
for implementing an RCB/M system. Management literature has long postulated that
innovation is one of the primary determinants of long-term organizational performance
48
(Bisbe & Otley, 2004; Clark & Fujimoto, 1991; Drucker, 1994; Kanter, 2001; Schumpeter,
1934; Walsh, Roy, Bruce, & Potter, 1992). Additionally, dynamic tension appears to have
a positive effect on organizations that are facing a high degree of environmental
uncertainty, such as modern universities (Henri, 2006). In a context of high
environmental uncertainty and intense competition, organizations must rely on
innovation and creativity to be successful (Miller, 1988; Miller, Droge & Toulouse, 1988);
environmental uncertainty has been identified as a primary factor in the move to an
RCB/M system by many HEIs that have decentralized. Simons’ Levers of Control
framework posits that in order for innovation to act as a driver of organizational
performance, some formal control systems must be used interactively while using other
systems diagnostically (Simons, 1995).
SECTION 2.3.3 - TRENDS IN HEI GOVERNANCE: DIAGNOSTIC AND INTERACTIVE CONTROL
As stated in Chapter One, this research defines the term governance as the
decisions on policy and strategy made by institutional and unit leadership (Kaplan,
2004). Moreover, the system of governance consists of those processes and procedures
that allocate authority and responsibility for decision-making (Benjamin, Carroll, Gray,
Krop, & Shires, 1993; Hirsch & Weber, 2001). That is, for this study the term governance
is used to describe the management and oversight provided by the central
administration and by leadership at the unit-level over processes, procedures and
decision-making.
49
Traditionally, in HEIs governance has taken the form of a collegial or
collaborative process, whereby faculty are responsible for participation in institutional
decision-making and oversight processes. Collegial or collaborative governance is highly
aligned with the consultative nature of interactive control systems (Simons, 2005); as
discussed above, interactive control represents the use of formal and informal
management control systems in a cooperative process. Interactive control systems
involve dialogue between individuals across institutional levels that helps to focus
attention on institutional mission and strategic goals and stimulate organizational
learning (Gond et al., 2012). The traditional collegial governance model present in HEIs
acts interactively to stimulate the development of new initiatives and guides the
development of organizational strategy in a bottom-up fashion
However, the trend in higher education governance has been moving away from
the traditional collegial and collaborative processes (Metcalfe et al., 2011). Due to the
influence of governments, for-profit firms, professional administrators in the university,
and other stakeholders, shared and collaborative forms of governance have given way
to corporate-style governance approaches (Kezar & Eckel, 2004; Lapworth, 2004;
Middlehurst, 2004). RCB/M, as used in for-profit firms, may promote a change in
governance model through its language of business (Cantor & Courant, 1997) and focus
on rational profit-seeking and cost-minimization behaviour (Lang, 1999a). Over the past
two decades, corporate-style governance has increasingly become a more dominant
approach in tertiary education (Lapworth, 2004). This rise of corporate governance has
resulted in the decline of academic participation, and the growing trend toward what is
50
termed ‘managerialism’ in the literature: the corporatization of HEIs and the move
toward professional managers (Lapworth, 2004; Metcalfe et al., 2011; Rhoades &
Slaughter, 1997; Slaughter & Leslie, 2001; Trow & Clark, 1994). The emphasis of
institutional governance in tertiary education has increasingly been on short-term and
incremental decisions that have been made in a less collegial mode. Consequently, the
notion of participative governance has been devalued, due in part to the increasing
demands for quicker decision-making (Kezar & Eckel, 2004).
Governance structures in higher education can be considered diagnostic when
they move away from the norms of participation and collaboration and become more
prescriptive or managerial in nature. Diagnostic control comprises two important
components: 1. tight control of operations and decision-making; and 2. highly
structured communication channels and restricted information flow (Henri, 2006).
Diagnostic control contributes to organizational performance by monitoring goal
achievement, limiting risk behaviours, setting boundary conditions for departmental
actions, and monitoring the effectiveness of organizational outcomes (Henri, 2006).
Even as HEIs are becoming more corporately inclined, interactive control may
provide a structure and process for re-establishing the collegial and collaborative model
of governance. Interactive forms of governance allow for the consultation, integrated
problem-solving, and collaboration necessary to improve organizational performance,
particularly for those HEIs that have implemented RCB/M. The interactive control model
may also support the alignment of HEI governance models with the American
Association of University Professors’ (American Association of University Professors,
51
1996) conceptualization of HEI governance, which emphasizes a collegial and
democratic approach.
Another trend in HEI governance structures is the increase of administrative
work and the need for specialized and professional management; this growth has
resulted in an increase in the number and importance of non-academic administrative
workers (Bok, 2003; Clark, 1972; Hawley, Boland, & Boland, 1965). HEIs have
experienced a demand for specialized administrative skills throughout their operations
(McMaster, 2007). This is especially true for those institutions that use RCB/M
structures, as they demand specialized training and knowledge in budgeting, finance,
and management at each of the individual operating units (Lang, 1999a). McMaster
(2007) noted that such changes may create additional tensions between collegial styles
of governance and corporate models of management. Again, through an interactive,
help the manager manage, open dialogue approach to management, such tensions can
be mitigated. This collaborative approach is strongly supported in the extant literature
(e.g. Coaldrake, Stedman, & Little, 2003; Dearlove, 1997; Lapworth, 2004; McMaster,
2007).
These trends in HEI governance have unsurprisingly had an effect on the
structure and organization of the HEI itself. Form is influenced by strategy (Chandler,
1962) and strategy is influenced by form (Hall & Saias, 1980). The relationship between
the interactive and diagnostic control forms of governance and their resulting
effectiveness will influence and be influenced by the internal structure of the HEI. That
is, this is a relationship with concomitant effects, and has subsequently come to be
52
viewed as a balanced approach of interrelatedness (Mintzberg, 1990). Thus, the
changing professional landscape, with increased numbers of administrative and support
staff, escalating specialization of employment roles, and intensifying organizational
complexity, has had an impact on the choice and effectiveness of governance structures
and has influenced the internal structure of HEIs.
SECTION 2.3.4 - DIAGNOSTIC AND INTERACTIVE APPROACHES TO GOVERNANCE IN RCB/M INSTITUTIONS
Simons’ Levers of Control framework has been influential for scholars examining
how managers maintain organizational control and guide units to achieve strategic
organizational goals. Simons’ framework (1990, 1991, 1995, 2005) established the
foundation upon which management scholars have examined management control
systems and their deployment, either diagnostically or interactively, within
organizations. Diagnostic control can be considered control by the numbers, while the
hallmark of interactive control is debate and dialogue across institutional levels (Simons,
1995).
Budgeting, governance, and organizational structure are all considered to be
management control systems in the extant literature. Of particular interest to this study,
governance models, both interactive and diagnostic in nature, are examined with regard
to their degree of alignment first with RCB/M and then with organizational
performance. Simons’ framework allows for an examination of the relationship, within
RCB/M institutions, between the central governance structure’s need for input and
53
control [to assure the achievement of the institution’s mission] and the organizational
units’ need for autonomous decision-making [to pursue change, growth, and efficiency].
Simons reported that both diagnostic and interactive control forms are
applicable in a decentralized organization (Simons, 2005). However, decentralization is
only possible in an environment of diagnostic control when management refrains from
daily involvement in unit operations. This may seem counterintuitive as diagnostic
control often is manifested in tight organizational control; however, Simons (2005)
notes that the best-managed decentralized organizations place less emphasis on
meeting financial targets and instead focus on bottom-up goal setting. In a
decentralized system, this manifests itself in unit managers that fully understand the
business operations of the unit they are responsible for while also being cognizant of
institutional level strategic plans.
There have been two general approaches to governance structures in HEIs that
have implemented RCB/M. One approach is a modification of the traditional centralized
structure that attempts to align with the decentralized budgeting and management
structure of RCB/M; this tends to manifest as interactive control. In contrast, other HEIs
maintain more traditional centralized governance structures, which tend to manifest as
diagnostic control. In for-profit industry, organizations that use an RCB/M structure
often utilize diagnostic governance. In practice, this means that top management,
usually a relatively small centralized ‘head office’ unit, will use financial targets and a
small set of key performance indicators to exercise control (Simons, 1995). Diagnostic
control structures severely limit the upward flow of operating and decision-making
54
information within the organization, thus following closely the M-form organizational
design and oversight processes promoted by the likes of Donaldson Brown, Alfred Sloan,
Peter Drucker, and Henry Mintzberg, among others.
When RCB/M and diagnostic governance are viewed outside of a for-profit lens,
as in higher education, several practical issues become evident. Behn (2003) identifies
two salient issues: 1. a lack of fidelity in reporting; and 2. the need for unit decisions to
be congruent with institutional level objectives and strategy. Fidelity in reporting is
important because it ensures that the central governance system is able to accurately
track the effect of unit-level decisions on the institution as a whole. When unit-level
reporting lacks fidelity, the central governance system is only able to see the short-term
financial effects of the decisions made by units; Longer-term outcomes are rarely
discussed, and the impact of unit decisions on other units or on the institution is seldom
considered.
The need for decision-making that is aligned with institutional goals and that
does not act as a detriment to other operational units is paramount in a decentralized
system. Behn (2003) suggests that “managers don’t necessarily know what to
do…maybe we also need a help-the-manager-manage strategy” (pg. 2). That is, in a
decentralized system, the unit-level managers may not understand how to make
decisions that meet the needs of their units while also being congruent with the mission
and direction of the organization as a whole. Under a diagnostic governance system,
information flows are expected to be constrained; this constraint has significant
55
negative ramifications for organizational learning and institutionally aligned decision-
making at the unit-level.
In consideration of the need for aligned decision-making within a decentralized
system such as RCB/M, ongoing dialogue between central administration and units is
critical. Interactive control forms of governance provide for this open information flow
by focusing permanent, regular attention on institutional level strategic initiatives;
because of this constant focus and communication, interactive control systems are well-
suited to uncertain organizational environments (Bisbe & Otley, 2004). Interactive
governance is well paired with RCB/M in HEIs; bounded by the institutional mission and
strategic goals, interactive governance fosters a learning process of interactive debate
between the unit and the central administration. Through the debate process, both the
central administration and unit-level managers gain a better understanding of the
consequences of decisions and are able to improve decision-making in the future (Behn,
2003; Simons 1995).
Beginning with Simons’ (1995) foundational work, the literature on the
interactive and diagnostic uses of management control systems is extensive. Much work
to date has focused on accounting controls and has not considered budgeting,
governance, or organizational structure. This study examines these management control
systems, applying them to a decentralized organizational environment. The present
author believes that budgeting, governance, and organizational structure are important
management control systems that have received scant attention in the management
control systems literature to date. To examine the organizational outcomes experienced
56
by HEIs employing an RCB/M system, the application of diagnostic and interactive forms
of governance will be considered.
SECTION 2.4 - THE CONCEPT OF ORGANIZATIONAL INTERNAL STRUCTURE
The internal structure of an organization has a material impact on organizational
efficiency, the selection of governance structure, and the ability to meet organizational
level strategic goals (Milgrom & Roberts, 1992; Teece, 1996; Vancil, 1979; Weigelt &
Miller, 2013). The concept of internal structure was developed by Lawrence and Lorsch
(1967), who employed the term integration to denote the unit’s level of orientation and
alignment with its peers and with regard to the achievement of the central
administration’s strategic goals. More recently, Weigelt and Miller (2013) have
presented a two-factor model of internal structure that uses the term coordination to
denote the level of cooperation between organizational units. The author’s two factors
include unit autonomy and lateral coordination. However, I propose that this two-factor
model does not include some important aspects of Lawrence and Lorsch’s original
integration conceptualization.
Lawrence and Lorsch’s (1967) foundational work employed an ecological and
open-systems perspective of organizations and their environments. An organization was
defined as a system of interrelated behaviors of people who are performing a task that
has been differentiated into several distinct subsystems, with each subsystem
performing a section of the task, and with the efforts of each being integrated to
achieve effective performance of the system. However, as the number and complexity
57
of distinct subsystems increase, so does the opportunity for misalignment and conflict.
Thus, the authors investigated the intra-organizational alignment of organizational units.
The challenges of integration posed by increasing unit differentiation were of focal
interest to Lawrence and Lorsch. As different parts of the same organization adapt
differently and at different rates, the levels of differentiation between units increase;
mechanisms are then required to ensure coordination of activities between units.
This perspective has resulted in the identification of two main functions of
organizational design and structure: 1. the division of tasks; and 2. the coordination of
tasks (Galbraith, 1973, 1977, 2002; Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967; March & Simon, 1958;
Mintzberg, 1983). From this starting point, organizations must first define their main
tasks and then divide them into a number of sub-tasks that various units will be
responsible for completing. This delineation of tasks and responsibilities can be
observed in the university context through the compartmentalization of the institution
into faculties and the sub-division of faculties into departments and area groups that
share an increasingly specialized research area focus.
The division of tasks into sub-tasks and the allocation of responsibilities for the
completion of those sub-tasks will not, in and of itself, lead to effective coordination or
organizational integration (Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967). That is, the division of tasks
cannot do away with the interdependencies between units, and between units and the
institution. Rather, activities need to be coordinated with one another (Galbraith, 1970).
The failure to coordinate or achieve organizational integration may manifest itself in a
lack of cooperation, internal competition, communication problems, and, potentially,
58
the pursuit of unit-specific goals at the expense of other unit or institutional level goals
(March & Simon, 1958). Within universities using RCB/M, coordination failures have
been observed; these challenges present as both the duplication of course and program
offerings and conflicts surrounding service teaching and the development and
deployment of interdisciplinary programs. These problems related to unit competition
and communication reinforce the need for organizations to deploy a well-thought-out
division of tasks while concurrently ensuring that effective coordination and integration
strategies, in the form of governance and oversight activities, are in place.
The conceptualization of internal structure focuses on two key components:
differentiation and integration. Differentiation, as defined by Lawrence and Lorsch
(1967), is “the state of segmentation of the organizational systems into subsystems,
each of which tends to develop particular attributes in relation to the requirements
posed by its relevant external environment” (p.3-4). That is, differentiation refers to the
differences between units in terms of goal orientation, time orientation, formality of
structures, and interpersonal orientation. Integration is defined as “the process of
achieving unity of effort among the various subsystems in accomplishment of the
organization’s task” (p.4) and is achieved between independent units through
coordination devices such as centralized influence, reporting, oversight, and governance
structures.
In the university environment, basic subsystems include, as an example,
campuses, colleges, faculties, departments, and support units. These subsystems will
continue to develop independently of one another and will become increasingly
59
differentiated, in a manner dependent on a contingency approach, in reaction to their
operating environments. For instance, as researchers become more focused on
increasingly specialized areas of research, individuals from the same department may be
viewed as increasingly differentiated. As a consequence of the differentiation and
complexity of the university environment, institutions are faced with difficult-to-assign
activities that frequently result in “issues such as cooperation, coordination, conflict and
struggles for power” (McCann & Galbraith, 1981, p.60). For this reason, integration
between units and between units and the institution becomes increasingly important, as
a necessary means of encouraging cooperation, alignment with strategic goals, and joint
problem-solving (Galbraith, 1994).
In highly differentiated organizations, the development and use of integrative
mechanisms, such as governance and oversight, is necessary to ensure the effective
coordination and cooperation of units. Lawrence and Lorsch’s (1967) study found that
coordination is improved when a centralized influence on units is present. Without
integrative mechanisms and centralized influence, inter-departmental conflict arises
(Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967). It should be noted that the degree of integration
[coordination and cooperation] “must not necessarily be high, rather it must be
consistent with the requirements of the environment” (Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967, p.11).
That is, full integration is not necessarily needed, only enough to ensure the
achievement of institutional and unit goals.
60
2.4.1 - THE IMPACT OF INTERNAL STRUCTURE ON INSTITUTIONAL CONTROL MECHANISMS
An organization’s internal structure defines its hierarchy of people and
departments and establishes how and when information is distributed. Internal
structure determines the physical structure of the organization; how tasks and
responsibilities are formally divided, grouped, and coordinated; who has the authority
to makes decisions and allocate resources (Bower, 1970, 1986; Fredrickson, 1986); what
effect these decisions will have on organization-wide measures of performance
(DeCanio, Dibble, & Amir-Atefi, 2000); and the resulting consequences for the units that
compose the organization.
In their seminal works, Lawrence and Lorsch (1967), and Milgrom and Roberts
(1992), define internal structure as the allocation of decision rights to units, the
coordination between units, and the coordination between the units and the
organization. Internal structure thus determines the flow of information and knowledge
through the organization (Grant, 1996) and provides incentives for units to cooperate
and share knowledge (Grant, 1996; Milgrom & Roberts, 1992).
The extant literature is teeming with discussions on the internal structures of
organizations, their impact on strategy (Bobbitt & Ford, 1980; Bower, 1970; Duncan,
Brunner, & Fiske, 1979; Hedberg, Bystrom, & Starbuck, 1976), and strategy’s impact on
structure (Chandler, 1962; Hall & Saias, 1980; Mintzberg, 1990). March and Simon
(1958) identified the importance of internal structure and its role in imposing
boundaries of rationality by delimiting responsibilities and communication channels for
those operating in an organization. Other work has focused on the dynamic nature of
61
internal structure as a process of adjustment that acts to maintain an effective
alignment within an organization’s environment while managing internal
interdependencies (Miles, Snow, Meyer, & Coleman, 1978).
It has also been argued that internal structure and organizational
decentralization are determining factors of the degree of latitude that individual units
possess in terms of their ability to develop and implement local strategies (Alexander
1991). The degree of latitude afforded to units has a profound impact on strategy and
strategic decision-making within an organization (Bourgeois & Astley, 1979; Burgelman,
1983; Fahey, 1981). Unit autonomy is a fundamental component of this research that
examines the effects of decentralized budgeting and management structures in HEIs on
governance process and organizational outcomes.
The internal structure of an organization can have a tremendous effect on its
operations and outcomes and has a material effect on its knowledge flows, oversight,
management, decision-making structures, and resulting governance structures (Weigelt
& Miller 2013). Internal structure reflects the level of resource allocation, decision-
making, and responsibility for management and outcomes that the organization
allocates to its units (Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967; Milgrom & Roberts 1992). In the context
of higher education, those HEIs that have implemented an RCB/M structure
demonstrate a configuration whereby budgeting, resource allocation, decision-making,
and management responsibility have been allocated to the organization’s units. This
decentralized internal structure is employed in an effort to increase the efficient use of
62
finite resources and to encourage revenue-seeking behavior (Lang, 1999a; Whalen,
1991).
The organizational design literature (e.g. Kretchmer & Puranam, 2008; Lawrence
& Lorsch 1967; Mintzberg 1979, 1983; Nadler & Tushman, 1997) provides two major
factors that compose the concept of internal structure: differentiation and integration.
Differentiation, as discussed in Chapter One, is defined as the segmentation of the
organization into a series of subsystems or units, whereas integration is the level of
unity among the units’ goals and efforts and the alignment of the units’ efforts with
organizational level goals and initiatives. Simply, integration is the alignment of the
unit’s efforts with the organization’s mission, and the organization’s ability to control
the alignment of unit-level efforts.
Recently, Weigelt and Miller (2013) proposed a modified conceptualization of
internal structure. These authors present a model composed of two factors: unit
autonomy and lateral coordination. Unit autonomy is constructed using two criteria.
The first is the provision of resource-allocation decision-making powers and task-
funding authority to units. The second factor is that units are held responsible, for
decisions made and the resulting outcomes.
Lateral coordination is defined as the ability of autonomous units to interact
cooperatively with one another. Although in their work Weigelt and Miller (2013) cite
the work of Camerer and Knez (1996) in order to underscore the importance of aligning
unit efforts with organizational goals and missions, their discussion and application of
lateral coordination speaks to coordination among units and not the relationship
63
between the organization and its units; the mere use of the term lateral speaks to this
point. Specifically, citing Lawrence and Lorsch (1967), the authors suggest that lateral
coordination is the alignment of actions across units, and, citing Milgrom and Roberts
(1992), Thompson (1967), and Weick (1996) that such coordination allows each unit to
tie into other unit’s actions. Although I agree that the concept of integration is
composed partially of lateral coordination, I believe that it must also include vertical
coordination in order to be complete.
SECTION 2.5 - MEASURING INSTITUTIONAL GOAL AND MISSION ACHIEVEMENT
The particular vision, or raison d’etre, of an organization is captured by its
mission and the strategic goals employed to help achieve that mission (Barnard, 1968;
Bryson, 2011; Moore, 2000; Walter, Kellermans, Floyd, Veiga & Matherne, 2013). In
HEIs it is especially difficult to measure the achievement of strategic goals, and as a
result to measure the achievement of an HEI’s mission. Unlike a for-profit firm, where
the overarching mission is to increase shareholder wealth, HEIs are socially embedded
and are responsible for the multi-dimensional mission of service, teaching, and research,
all of which are difficult to evaluate (Gumport, 2008; Moore, 2000). Additionally, HEIs
are tasked with attending to the preferences of those numerous constituencies that
supply them with the resources needed for survival.
As a social institution, the mission of an HEI defines its value to society and
results in its purpose (Gumport, 2000). Thus, mission achievement becomes the metric
that is used to evaluate performance (Cameron, 1981; Moore, 2000; Walter et al. 2013).
64
For socially embedded institutions, like HEIs, it has been noted that missions are set out
in substantive rather than financial terms (Moore, 2000); for this reason, researchers
have had to find a proxy for the measurement of mission and goal achievement.
In his seminal work Measuring Organizational Effectiveness in Institutions of
Higher Education, Cameron (1978) laid the foundation for the measurement of mission
and strategic goal achievement through the measurement of organizational
effectiveness. Noting that the specification of measurable goals and outcomes for HEIs
is difficult due to their complexity, ambiguity, and changeability, he argued that a
battery of criteria needs to be constructed and tested to adequately measure
effectiveness. To this end, Cameron (1978) initially presented and tested a nine-factor
model. Of those, seven factors were shown to possess validity and reliability in the
measurement of HEI organizational effectiveness. Subsequently, Goodman, Atkin, and
Schoorman (1983) identified problems with the general approach to the evaluation of
organizational effectiveness and called for a moratorium on its study. Consequently,
work in the area of organizational effectiveness has been focused on the refinement of
measurement tools to include relationships among multiple indicators, ensure that
models are not under-specified, account for the time-frame of the criterion variable,
and ensure that the over-generalization of findings is limited (e.g. Bass & Avolio, 1994;
Cameron, 1986; Cameron & Whetton, 1983; Cameron, Mora, Leutscher & Calarco, 2011;
Jones, 2010; Walter et al. 2013).
To assess the level of organizational effectiveness and, by extension, the
achievement of strategic goals and mission, Walter et al. (2013) - extending and refining
65
Cameron’s (1978) seven-factor model - presented a three-factor model [Appendix 3].
This model is especially salient to this research as it was built using the North American
higher education context. Through the measurement of strategic consensus,
organizational commitment, and organizational performance in HEIs, Walter et al.
(2013) have developed a measurement tool that allows the assessment of the
institutional mission and goal achievement of HEIs.
SECTION 2.6 - SUMMARY
This chapter has provided a review and discussion of a number of different
literatures. The concepts, models, theories, and findings of the work presented above
form the foundation of the theoretical considerations presented in Chapter Three and
the three-factor model presented and tested in this study. Upon the foundation laid by
the organizational design and RCB/M literatures, and by the diagnostic and interactive
control systems of governance, this study builds a three-factor model of internal
structure presented in Chapter Three.
66
CHAPTER THREE
THEORETICAL CONSIDERATIONS AND RESEARCH QUESTIONS
“There is no one best way to organize.” (Galbraith, 1973, p.2)
SECTION 3.1 - INTRODUCTION
This research empirically examines the outcomes of the alignment, or
misalignment, between governance control forms and decision-making in four public
universities that employ an RCB/M model, and how this alignment is affected by internal
structure. In this chapter, the three-factor theoretical framework of internal structure is
presented. Additionally, this chapter outlines the research questions and corresponding
propositions that have been developed to guide this study. The primary research
question and subsequent operationalized questions are intended to elucidate the
relationships between governance forms, internal structure, and decision-making in
decentralized budgeting and management environments. The operationalized research
questions and their corresponding propositions were developed based on the
comprehensive literature review presented in Chapter Two. They are intended to
provide a framework in which the outcomes of RCB/M use in the higher education
context can be better understood.
SECTION 3.2 - THREE-FACTOR MODEL OF INTERNAL STRUCTURE
Based on the extant literature, I propose that internal structure is composed of
three factors: 1. unit autonomy; 2. lateral coordination; and 3. vertical coordination.
67
Unit autonomy is defined as the level of financial and decision-making authority
possessed by a unit. It also includes responsibility for the outcomes of past decisions.
This responsibility is ensured by the process of carry-forward, in which both surpluses
and deficits are carried forward to subsequent years (Lang, 1999a). Consequently, the
financial outcomes of a unit’s decision-making directly determine the choices available
to it in the future.
Lateral coordination denotes the level of alignment between units, and is of
interest to this study because of the profound effect it can have both on units and on
the institution as a whole. In the university environment, cooperation and coordination
can encourage multidisciplinary programs, cross appointments of faculties,
opportunities for new programs at the intersection of traditional knowledge domains,
and the development of programs offered in conjunction between units that provide
increased value for students. Conversely, low levels of lateral coordination can result in
competition between units, causing internal competition for students, lack of
interdisciplinary study opportunities, duplication of courses and programs, and a hostile
internal environment for faculty, staff, and students.
Vertical coordination is similar, but not equivalent, to the concept of integration
as discussed by Lawrence and Lorsch (1967). Vertical coordination denotes the degree
of coordination between the individual unit and the organization’s mission and resulting
strategic goals. That is, it aligns unit-level efforts, goals, and decisions with the
accomplishment of the organization’s mission. Coordination is interactive – the act of
68
working together through two-way dialogue, meetings, reports, emails, and similar
activities. Coordination, then, is an interactive process whose end result is alignment.
The three-factor model of organizational structure builds upon the extant
literature, extending the traditional models presented and providing a more holistic
understanding of organizational complexities and the naturally distributed power
structure of HEIs. This study builds upon Lawrence and Lorsch’s (1967) two-factor model
of differentiation and integration, Williamson’s (1975) model of market or hierarchy,
and Weigelt and Miller’s (2013) two-factor model of lateral coordination and unit
autonomy, and presents a three-factor model that seeks to include the socially
embedded and dynamic nature of the modern university. Consequently, the important
factor of vertical coordination has been included with lateral coordination and unit
autonomy to provide for a greater depth of understanding of the decision-making and
internal structure of the modern university.
SECTION 3.3 - PRIMARY RESEARCH QUESTION
Does the governance control form of any given university employing RCB/M
affect the relationship between RCB/M and internal structure?
This question is intended to incorporate a wide variety of concepts and due to its
complexity is not meant to be answered directly. To address this main research question
the following operationalized questions are presented.
69
SECTION 3.4 - OPERATIONALIZED RESEARCH QUESTIONS AND CORRESPONDING PROPOSITIONS
3.4.1 - RESEARCH QUESTIONS REGARDING LATERAL AND VERTICAL COORDINATION
Governance control forms within universities can range between diagnostic to
interactive. Diagnostic governance control forms act to control institutional agents by
constraining their decisions and actions through a focus on negative variance and
compliance with institutional policies and procedures (Kapu Arachchilage & Smith, 2013;
Henri, 2006; Simons, 1995). Within universities, diagnostic governance control forms are
typically applied in a centralized budgeting and management environment. Unlike a
diagnostic application of governance controls, an interactive application functions
through the promotion of cooperation, communication, and open exchanges of
information across the institution (Burns & Stalker, 1961; Henri, 2006). An interactive
governance control form requires the active involvement of senior leadership. Because
interactive governance does not regulate behaviour in a prescriptive manner, the
involvement and influence of senior university leaders serve as signals for other
institutional members to identify which initiatives are important and deserving of
attention (Bisbe & Otley, 2004; Henri, 2006).
i. Do those HEIs that apply a predominantly interactive governance control
form, which allows for oversight and influence on unit-level decision-making,
experience increased alignment between unit-level goals, resource-allocation
decisions, and behaviour regarding institutional mission and strategic goals?
70
P1: HEIs that employ a governance structure combining both interactive and diagnostic
control forms, allowing for unit autonomy while ensuring central-level oversight and
influence, will experience increased alignment of unit decisions and behavior with their
missions and strategic goals.
ii. Do those HEIs that report high levels of lateral and vertical coordination have
governance structures that allow for oversight and influence of unit-level
decision making?
P2: High levels of lateral and vertical coordination by units will be encouraged by
interactive control forms of governance, while strictly diagnostic control forms of
governance will encourage low levels of lateral and vertical coordination.
Using a pair of 2X2 matrices, this study identifies the level of lateral coordination within
diagnostic and interactive governance structures [Appendix 4] and vertical coordination
within diagnostic and interactive governance structures [Appendix 5]. Based on the
extant literature, I expect that HEIs with a high degree of lateral and vertical
coordination will employ an interactive governance structure.
iii. Is there a relationship between the type/degree of alignment [high vs. low
lateral and vertical coordination] and the achievement of organizational
goals?
71
P3: High levels of vertical coordination will encourage the achievement of the HEIs’
organizational goals.
P4: High lateral coordination will encourage the achievement of the HEIs’ organizational
goals.
The assumption provided by the literature is that high levels of lateral and
vertical coordination will result in a high degree of strategic goal achievement (Crotts,
Dickson, & Ford, 2005; Hides, Davies, & Jackson, 2004; Kretschmer & Puranam, 2008;
Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967; Miles & Snow, 1984; Taylor, 2000). Coordination is expected
to align unit goals and behavior with the organization’s mission and resulting strategic
goals.
iv. Is increasing revenue a stronger, more manageable incentive compared to
cost reduction? If so, does this fact encourage the internal competition
[decreasing lateral coordination] and fragmentation of the institution by
reducing vertical coordination?
P5: If the incentive for revenue-seeking behaviour is stronger than the incentive [or
ability] to reduce costs, units will exhibit lower levels of vertical coordination.
72
RCB/M provides two incentives: 1. to reduce costs; and 2. to increase revenue.
Investigating the relationship between financial incentives and lateral coordination, one
is forced to ask, is RCB/M working as intended? That is, are units working to reduce
costs and engage in revenue-seeking behavior as argued in the RCB/M literature (Lang,
1999a; Strauss & Curry, 2002; Strauss, Curry, & Whalen, 1996; Whalen, 1991)?
v. How does the ratio of indirect to direct costs impact the degree of lateral and
vertical coordination?
P6: As the ratio of indirect costs to direct costs increases, lower levels of vertical and
lateral coordination are expected.
The ratio of indirect costs to overhead costs should determine how HEIs respond
to incentives; this relationship will determine whether revenue incentives are stronger
than cost incentives. Revenue incentives should create an environment that encourages
perverse behaviors and decreases the level of lateral and vertical coordination.
3.3.2 - RESEARCH QUESTIONS REGARDING UNIT AUTONOMY
vi. What is the relationship between levels of unit autonomy [funding authority
and task accountability], and the type of governance structure [interactive
versus diagnostic control systems of governance]?
73
P7: Higher levels of unit autonomy in a diagnostic control form governance structure will
result in lower levels of lateral and vertical coordination.
P8: Higher levels of unit autonomy in an interactive control form structure will result in
higher levels of lateral and vertical coordination.
The assumption in the literature is that units with high task accountability will
demonstrate a higher degree of lateral and vertical coordination. Task accountability
denotes that units are held responsible for the decisions that they make and the
resulting outcomes. This assumed relationship may be moderated by the level of fund
authority, although there is no discussion within the literature on the impact of high
funding authority and high task accountability on degree of coordination. Fund authority
denotes the ability of the unit to deploy financial resources in support of its strategic
goals and tactical decisions. Those units that possess high funding authority and low task
accountability are expected to have lower levels of lateral and vertical coordination
when compared to units possessing low funding authority and task accountability
(Camerer & Knez, 1996; Kretschmer & Puranam, 2008; Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967;
Weigelt & Miller, 2013).
74
3.3.3 - RESEARCH QUESTIONS REGARDING DIAGNOSTIC AND INTERACTIVE CONTROL FORMS OF GOVERNANCE
vii. Will HEIs that use RCB/M and apply an interactive control system of
governance experience higher levels of institutional goal and mission
achievement?
P10: Interactive control systems will encourage institutional goal achievement in HEIs
that use RCB/M.
The value that HEIs produce is not easily measured and often lies in the
achievement of social purposes (Moore, 2000). Unlike for-profit firms, the maximization
of profit and creation of wealth for shareholders are not measures of goal and mission
achievement for HEIs (Cameron, 1978); in consideration of this, measurements of goal
and mission achievement specific to HEIs must be applied. Through the application of
Walter, Kellermanns, Floyd, Veiga, and Matherne’s (2013) three-factor model of
assessing higher education organizational performance, which is based on Cameron’s
(1978) model of higher education organizational effectiveness, I will assess the level of
goal and mission achievement through the evaluation of strategic consensus,
organizational performance, and organizational commitment.
75
viii. Will HEIs that use RCB/M and employ an interactive control system of
governance experience lower levels of decision-making autonomy at the unit
level?
P11: Units will experience lower levels of decision-making autonomy in HEIs that have
implemented RCB/M and employ an interactive control form of governance.
The use of decentralized budgeting and management structures is intended to
allow for unit-level autonomy in decision-making and promote the pursuit of change,
growth, and efficiency (Lang, 1999a; Strauss & Curry, 2002; Whalen, 1991). However,
the extant literature identifies the tension between the need for units’ decisions to be
aligned with the institution’s mission (Cantor & Currant, 1997; Adams, 1997) in order to
assure the achievement of institutional-level goals (Crotts, Dickson, & Ford, 2005; Hides,
Davies, & Jackson 2004; Taylor, 2000) and the need to allow units to make timely and
appropriate unit-level decisions. Through the above set of questions, this study
identifies the differences in outcomes at the institutional level and unit level that result
from an HEI’s use of interactive or diagnostic control forms of governance.
76
CHAPTER FOUR
METHODS AND METHODOLOGY
SECTION 4.1 - INTRODUCTION
This chapter provides the rationale for selecting a qualitative research
methodology involving the application of document analysis and interview techniques
to construct a comparative case study design. Further, the iterative process employed to
collect and analyze the interview data is discussed [Appendix 6]. This chapter closes with
a discussion of the validity and reliability of this study and, finally, with a discussion of
the study’s limitations.
From a research scope perspective, qualitative methods provide the tools
needed to comprehend how participants view and understand the processes and
interactions at their institutions and how they make sense of their experiences within
the institutional environment (Merriam, 2009). The result of utilizing these qualitative
techniques is the creation of a narrative, or descriptive account (Parkinson & Drislane,
2011), of the use of RCB/M in public universities and the relationship between RCB/M,
organizational structure, and governance control forms.
SECTION 4.2 - THE CASE STUDY DESIGN
The case study research design was chosen because it allows for a thorough
investigation into the relationships between RCB/M and governance structures, while
considering the three-factor model of organizational design introduced in Chapter
77
Three. This method was chosen because it allows for an in depth understanding of the
relationships being considered by this study. The case study research design is
particularly appropriate for this study because it provides for a depth and richness of
information not offered by other research methods (Merriam, 1988). Due to the
complexity of the environments investigated, an iterative investigation process was
needed to capture as many variables as possible, as well as allowing the identification
and inclusion of emergent themes and categories.
This research utilizes a multiple case study approach and was developed to fill
theoretical categories, as outlined in the operationalized research questions in Chapter
Three. Additionally, this research was designed to allow for the categorization of
institutions into two distinct subsets: 1. those universities that provide oversight and
influence to unit decision-making [interactive governance control form]; and 2. those
universities that do not, or are unable to, provide oversight and influence to unit
decision-making [diagnostic governance control form]. By breaking the institutions
down into two categories, it was possible to identify organizational outcomes stemming
from differences in the application of governance structures and the resulting levels of
unit autonomy, and lateral and vertical coordination.
Yin (2009) suggests that the case study design will “retain the holistic and
meaningful characteristics of real-life events such as…small group decisions, [and]
organizational and managerial processes” (pg. 9). This is an important concept for this
study as it is the relationship between the governance structure and the internal
structure of universities that will encourage or discourage certain decisions, resource
78
allocations, and communication strategies. The comparative case study design has been
chosen as it allows the testing of proposed relationships between the variables of: 1.
governance structure and organizational outcomes; and 2. internal structure and
organizational outcomes. I have purposely endeavoured to operationalize these
variables to “maximize the variance of the independent variables and to minimize the
variance of the control variables” (Lijphart, 1975 pg. 164). The case study method yields
a concentration of similar and dissimilar details that emerge from varying perspectives
when relying on multiple data sources (Tellis, 1997). The representation of various
perspectives is especially relevant in this research as there may be different, competing,
and potentially conflicting goals and perspectives within universities because of the high
degrees of unit autonomy and differentiation.
Using Eisenhardt’s (1989) Process for Building Theory from Case Study Research I
have outlined the steps and phases of this study in Appendix 7. In an attempt to fully
explore the relationships between RCB/M, internal structure, and governance control
form, this research focuses on publicly funded comprehensive universities that have
implemented and utilized RCB/M for a period of at least five years. This time period has
been selected as it should allow for the documentation of outcomes resulting from the
implementation of RCB/M and from its relationships with internal structure and
governance control form.
Four public North American HEIs were selected through a process of theoretical
sampling. Each of these four universities have used RCB/M as their budgeting and
management model for at least five years. Additionally, two of these universities were
79
identified as employing a predominantly interactive governance control form and the
remaining two employed a predominantly diagnostic governance control form.
Furthermore, these four institutions can be broken down into two separate categories.
The first category is composed of universities whose governance structures are capable
of providing oversight and influence to the unit level and are aligned with the
decentralized resource allocation and decision-making of RCB/M structures. The second
category is populated by those institutions whose governance structures are not
capable of providing oversight and influence at the unit level for resource allocation
decisions. The categories used in this study provide for high levels of divergence that will
allow for replication and contrary replication. This allows contrasting patterns in the
data to be more easily observed and permits clear pattern recognition of the central
constructs, relationships, and logic. The rationale for selecting four HEIs is an attempt to
develop findings that are theoretically generalizable (Mason, 2002; Schofield, 2002; Yin,
2009).
Each university was selected after a thorough review of institutional documents.
This research sample is divided into two theoretical areas of interest. Institutional
names have been disguised to promote confidentiality. The first area of interest consists
of two cases, one Canadian and one American university, where RCB/M has been
implemented and governance control forms allow for multi-level oversight and
reporting expectations through a predominantly interactive approach to governance.
The case studies included in this grouping are Midwestern U. S. University and Central
Canadian University. The second area of interest also includes two cases, one Canadian
80
and one American university, each employing a predominantly diagnostic approach to
governance and each having reported issues with unit decisions, inter-unit conflict, and
vertical conflict between units and the institution. The case studies included in this
grouping are Western Canadian University and Eastern U.S. University. This sample has
been carefully selected to provide both literal and theoretical replication and to provide
compelling and robust confirmation of the propositions of this research (Yin 2009).
Literal replication predicts “similar results” while theoretical replication “predicts
contrasting results but for predictable reasons” (Yin 2009, p. 47).
SECTION 4.3 – METHODOLOGY
The four case studies examine the effects of decentralized budgeting and
management structures on governance, management, and oversight with special
consideration of the resulting organizational outcomes at the institutions. The data
analysis techniques employed in this research have been chosen as they allow for the
determination of categorical themes [open coding], establishment of patterns [axial and
selective coding], and the development of generalizations [through the triangulation of
data and analysis from the two phases of this research] (Creswell, 1998; Miles &
Hubermann, 1994). The analysis of data collected in this research is intended to answer
the primary research question: Does the governance control form of any given
university employing RCB/M affect the relationship between RCB/M and internal
structure?; and sub-questions [see Chapter Three] within the three-factor model of
81
organizational structure, attempting to reveal relationships between themes and
categories.
SECTION 4.3.1 - DOCUMENT ANALYSIS
The analysis of institutional documents and reports was based on the concepts
of qualitative content analysis, and created replicable and valid references
(Krippendorff, 2004; Weber, 1990). Additionally, the document analysis provided insight
into the reporting and decision-making structures of each university, as well as the
degrees of unit autonomy, lateral coordination, and vertical coordination.
Due to the type of research questions being asked, and the need to build an
understanding of how internal structural affects HEI governance structures and
organizational outcomes, an extensive review and analysis of institutional documents
was completed. For each of the four institutions, document analysis, involving a variety
of institutional reports, was completed. Institutional documents, including budget
reports, business plans, budget committee reports, institutional plans, and institutional
fact books, from Central Canadian University, Midwestern U.S. University, Eastern U.S.
University, and Western Canadian University were collected and analyzed. Additional
documents from external debt rating agencies, provincial, state, and federal higher
education finance reports, national faculty association reports, and national university
association reports on finance and budgeting were also collected and analyzed. The
wide breadth of documentation was essential to building an understanding of the
contexts that each of the four universities operate within. These documents also
82
represent a relatively comprehensive snapshot of the organization at a given time, and
can be considered valuable as they meet Krippendorf’s (2004) test of documents in that
they are routine, relational, and coordinative.
Document analysis, in combination with a literature review, has provided
direction for the construction of a framework out of which the interview questions were
developed. Additionally, the information obtained through the document analysis phase
enabled the triangulation of data with the information collected during the interview
phase of this study. Weber’s Six Steps of Document Analysis was used as the primary
protocol when reviewing institutional documents and reports [Table 3].
Although Weber’s steps seem sequential in nature, it is essential that, as new
items emerge, the researcher revisit documents already analysed. In this iterative
process of document analysis each document was considered numerous times. As
emergent themes, words, and/or sentences were identified during the document
analysis phase, and later during the interview phase, each document was reanalyzed.
Reanalysis included rereading the documents, recorded notes, and keyword/key term
searches.
83
Table 3: Weber’s Six Steps of Document Analysis
Step Process
Step 1 Define the unit to code [Word, sentence, paragraph, or whole text]
Step 2 Define the category [determination of the category and its breadth]
Step 3 Per-testing of sample text [determining the accuracy and reliability of coding]
Step 4 Recoding to test and determine reliability
Step 5 Coding for actual content for analysis
Step 6 Determining the achieved reliability, validity and trustworthiness
Source: Weber, R. (1990). Basic content analysis. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
SECTION 4.3.2 - INTERVIEWS
Informed by the literature review, the findings from the document analysis were
used as a foundation from which the interview questions, outlined in the Interview
Protocol [Appendix 8], were developed. These questions were posed to key informants
in the second phase of this research. The interview phase consisted of semi-structured
interviews with various senior administrators and faculty holding administrative
positions at the target universities. Key informants held titles including president, vice
president, provost, vice provost, dean, associate dean, chair, chief administrative officer,
and chief budget officer, among others. All possessed direct and working knowledge of
the decentralized budgeting structure at their respective universities. These interviews
were recorded and transcribed verbatim, allowing for coding and the identification of
salient themes.
84
A semi-structured interview protocol was chosen for this study because it allows
key informants to speak to a wide range of subjects, experiences, and opinions, while at
the same time allowing the researcher to provide structure to the process. It also allows
for follow-up and the introduction of probing questions. This format ensured that the
information collected was appropriate and useful to the study.
Semi-structured in-depth interviews were conducted with senior administrators
[e.g. administrative officers, directors, executive directors, vice presidents, presidents,
provosts and rectors] and senior faculty at each of the four target institutions. These
individuals were chosen due to their involvement with budgeting and management
responsibilities at their respective universities. These interviews were undertaken with
the intention of producing an extended discussion that provides depth and detail about
the research topic (Rubin & Rubin, 2011). As this research is interested in the cultural
aspects of the organization [regular practices, rituals, behaviours, and perspectives]
open-ended questions were used. This approach provided the informants with direction
that encouraged active listening on my part, as opposed to insistent questioning.
The semi-structured interview was also selected because it is helpful in
reconstructing historical events (Rubin & Rubin, 2011) and in constructing a ‘full
description’ that combines many viewpoints and creates a complete picture of events.
The semi-structured interview technique, along with the analysis of institutional
documents and reports, was used collaboratively so that the validity of the interview
85
data could be established through a process of comparison and triangulation (Weiss,
2008).
SECTION 4.3.3 – CASES
4.3.3.1 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
Central Canadian University was founded in the early 1800s and can be
considered a leader in teaching and research both within Canada and internationally.
Central Canadian University is one of Canada’s largest universities, with 18 faculties
offering more than 800 academic programs, at three geographically distinct campuses,
to a student population exceeding 80,000 (Central Canadian University, 2013a). Due in
part to its size and organizational complexity, Central Canadian University began the
formal process of implementing a decentralized resource allocation and management
system in 2004. The initial goal of this transition was to make the “opaque and
unwieldy” budgeting model, which limited the ability of the institution to control costs
and promote entrepreneurial revenue-generating behaviour, more “transparent and
rational” (Central Canadian University, 2011a).
Like many other universities, Central Canadian University historically used a fund
accounting budget process with four segregated funds that included: operating;
ancillary operations; capital; and restricted (Central Canadian University, 2007).
Faculties were funded through a relatively fixed formula resulting in an environment
where academic administrators were not given the ability to access the information
86
needed to assess the financial implications of their units’ academic priorities. As such,
many decisions had to be made on an ad hoc basis (Central Canadian University, 2006).
The result was that a faculty could invest in a project or program with little
understanding of its effect on the bottom line. The expense budget for each operating
unit consisted of two parts: base allocations and one-time-only allocations. The base
allocation was established from a historical value that was intended to match the cost of
delivering the programs and services for which the unit was responsible. One-time-only
allocations were received from the institution and were intended to cover expenses that
were non-recurring. As an example, non-recurring expenses could include the purchase
of laboratory equipment or start-up funds for new faculty members. Each year, the base
budget was adjusted to account for changes due to salary increases, post-tenure review
cost recovery, and special allocations made by the provost [e.g. new positions] (Central
Canadian University, 2006). But the resulting budgets were not based on a detailed
assessment of expenses; the overall budget structure could be viewed as an expense-
based budget that was subject to the constraints of the available resources of the
institution.
Although this fund accounting approach to budgeting allowed for stability
through the historically derived base budget for units, it suffered a number of
disadvantages, including changes in program demand, lack of transparency, lack of
incentives, and ever-increasing complexity (Central Canadian University, 2006). As the
current-year base budget allocations were historical in nature, it was difficult to
determine how the budget of a specific unit had been arrived at. Thus, the amount of
87
the base budget could not be reviewed with regard to its appropriateness for the unit’s
current operations and offerings. This decreased the incentives for unit-level leadership
to either increase revenues or to reduce expenses. Finally, the budget had become
difficult and costly to manage due to the many arrangements for revenue- and cost-
sharing implemented over the years and the increasing size and complexity of the
institution.
Before Central Canadian University moved away from the fund accounting
structure, a number of changes to the budgeting system took place. In the 2002-03 fiscal
year funding for the School of Management was changed to a model based on RCB/M;
however, this new model was only applied to incremental revenue and expenses.
Additionally, the Institute for Studies in Education [ISE] was granted a special ten-year
agreement stemming from its 1995 merger with Central Canadian University. This
agreement meant that ISE was allowed to carry forward any budget surplus and that
shortfalls would be billed to the following budget year. Also included in this agreement
was a transfer grant, beginning in the 1995-1996 fiscal year, in the amount of $785,000;
over the subsequent nine years of the agreement, the transfer grant was reduced in a
linear fashion until it reached $78,500 in 2004-2005 fiscal year (Central Canadian
University, 1994). Of final note, one of Central Canadian University’s satellite campuses
experimented with an RCB/M structure for the fiscal years of 1997/1998 through
2002/2003 before returning to the general university’s accounting process in
2004/2005.
88
Confronted with a large and complex budget process, university leadership
determined that a change in budgeting and management structure was needed. An
RCB/M structure was chosen and labeled the New Budget Model (Central Canadian
University, 2006). The intent was to create a fundamental change in the way that
decisions were made while simultaneously altering the structure and nature of
academic leadership at the university. The transition in organizational form and
structure culminated in the development and implementation of the New Budget Model
in the 2006-07 fiscal year.
The selection and implementation of an RCB/M structure was, in part, a
response to continued financial pressures and the need for increased responsiveness
and institutional efficiency (Deering & Sá, 2014; Garner, 2008; Central Canadian
University, 2012a). The university had experienced financial constraints including
increasing internal costs, provincially regulated tuition, and decreasing government
funding [on an inflation adjusted basis]; these trends were expected to continue
(Central Canadian University, 2003). However, Central Canadian University, which is one
of the largest comprehensive universities in Canada with the largest number of students
receiving financial aid, has a unique experience of financial constraints in Canada due to
its size, location, research focus, and comprehensive nature. In a recent review of the
decentralized budget and management model, the university found that the
transparency of decisions was increased, and units displayed faster response rates and
creativity when faced with financial challenges. It was also detected that the
decentralized budgeting and management structure has allowed the institution and its
89
constituent units to manage resources so that fewer program and service cuts are
necessary (Central Canadian University, 2011a). Examples of improved resource
management include a rationalization of space usage initiated by academic units,
reduction of duplicate services, and active enrollment monitoring (Garner, 2008; Central
Canadian University, 2011a). The Chief Financial Officer has stated that the
decentralized budgeting and management structure is the ‘exactly correct’ structure to
survive the increasing financial pressures and thrive going forward (Central Canadian
University, 2011b).
4.3.3.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
Founded in the early 1800s, Midwestern U.S. University was one of the first
public universities in the Northwest Territories of the United States of America. Today it
boasts three campuses, and employs over 8,500 faculty members. The University serves
a student population of more than 59,000 students across all levels of tertiary
education. It is ranked as a world class research-intensive university by many of the
international ranking systems and in the 2012-13 academic year had 99 graduate
programs ranked in the top ten in the United States (U.S. World News & Report, 2013).
Midwestern U.S. University is the largest public university in the state, with an operating
budget of $6.3 billion US dollars in the 2012-2013 fiscal year and an $8.6 billion US dollar
endowment (Midwestern U.S. University, 2013).
90
Midwestern U.S. University faces many of the same environmental forces that
the other three sample institutions face, including: 1. increasing national and global
competition; 2. decreasing state appropriations; and 3. increasing operating costs
(Midwestern U.S. University, 2013). Additionally, due to the uncertain financial
circumstances within the state, Midwestern U.S. University faces significant future
financial challenges to its academic programs.
The state where Midwestern U.S. University is located has a decentralized
system of institutional governance for its publicly funded universities, referred to as a
planning agency model (McGuinness, 1997). Under this model, each institution has its
own governing board. Midwestern U.S. University has a single Board of Regents that
oversees its three campuses. The board includes eight elected trustees and the
institution’s president, who serves as an ex-officio member. Each of the public
universities in the state has constitutional autonomy that allows the institutional
governing board total control of management and planning.
Midwestern U.S. University should be considered an early adopter of
decentralized budgeting and management practices and is often cited as a model case
by other universities investigating the use of RCB/M. Although the official
implementation of the Value-Centered Management model occurred in the 1995-1996
fiscal year, Midwestern U.S. University had begun decentralizing management
responsibilities in the mid-1980s, ultimately easing the transition to full decentralization
(Elgass, 1995). In 1999, the university modified the Value-Centered Management model
91
and rebranded it as the University Budget Model and System, which is based in an
activity-based budgeting approach (Kohrs, & DeGraff, 2005).
Value Centred Management was a highly decentralized model, in the spirit of the
culture of decentralization that was ingrained at Midwestern U.S. University. However,
unlike a strict RCB/M model, it provided a central fund to ensure that certain valuable
programs and services that would operate at a deficit under RCB/M would be protected.
The university collectively was expected to work together to enable those important
and non-self-supporting activities to continue and flourish (Cantor & Courant, 1997).
The change from the Value Centred Management model to the University
Budget Model and System was not in name only. The new budget model is considered a
more centralized structure allowing for more influence and oversight to be provided by
the central administration. The oversight and communication is made possible by the
sharing of information that happens among the Provost, Deans, Executive Officers and
academic leadership within the budget system. It is also considered an activity-based
model with revenues following the activities that units engage in to generate those
revenues (Courant & Knepp, 2000). The underlying logic of the activity-based approach
is that “the costs and revenues are most clearly seen where the activities are
undertaken – in the schools, colleges and research units” (Courant & Knepp, 2000, p.4).
Such a structure allows the central administration and unit leadership to observe the
threats and opportunities of the budget. As an example, a unit that experiences
92
decreasing enrollment will be brought to the forefront of discussion through the
budgeting model.
Tuition attribution for undergraduate students followed the unit of enrollment
rather than the unit of instruction, and revenues for units were therefore based upon
the number of registered students. This was changed in the 2002-03 fiscal year to a
combination of the unit of enrollment [75%] and unit of instruction [25%] and changed
again in the 2009-10 fiscal year to an even split between the unit of enrollment and unit
of instruction (Hanlon & Schweitzer, 2008). During the 2009-10 fiscal year, the tuition
attribution formula for masters and graduate professional levels also changed to a
combination approach [75% to the unit of enrollment and 25% to the unit of
instruction]. This was done to encourage interdisciplinary study, which is an element of
Midwestern U.S. University’s culture, and is deemed a strength of its offerings.
Further, Courant and Knepp (2000) identified that under this model it is
expected that few units will be financially self-supporting, but will rather need
supplemental support from the central administration. The General Fund Supplement
represents a fund of resources allocated by the Provost to units beyond the revenues
and costs allocated by the model. This allows the Provost leverage and influence in the
decision-making processes of units. Thus, there is not the expectation that each unit will
function as a “tub on its own bottom”.
The University Budget Model and System is used by the Provost to develop the
general fund budgets of the units. Information, including “faculty, quality, salary
93
pressures, national trends in various academic fields, legal requirements, and individual
departments” (Hanover, 2008, p.9), is collected by the Provost’s office to inform budget
allocations. However, these budget determinations made by the Provost are completed
at a high level for each budgeting unit, allowing for autonomy of decision-making by the
deans, vice presidents, and directors of the budgeting units. It has been noted that this
model is not intended to provide a standard template to guide budgeting and decision-
making within the units. As Courant and Knepp (2002) argue, there is no expectation
that the deans will follow the guidelines of the University Budget Model and System
when making decisions regarding resource allocations for the separate departments and
areas within their respective schools.
The University Budget Model and System allows the central administration more
considerable discretion and oversight and encourages a great deal of communication
and interaction between the central administration and units. Through tuition
attribution, interdisciplinary teaching and programs are also encouraged. This approach
is thought to have provided university leadership [both at the central level and unit
level] with a clear understanding of the financial implications of the activities of the
institution and its units. It also encourages a considerable level of flexibility for the units
to adjust to changing trends and fiscal circumstances.
94
4.3.3.3 - EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
Eastern U.S. University is a mid-sized public university located in the
northeastern United States. Founded in the mid-1800s, it provides academic programs
at the undergraduate, graduate, and doctoral levels to over 15,000 students and
employs nearly 1000 full- and part-time faculty members. Composed of eight colleges
and the Graduate School, it offers over 2000 courses in over 100 majors and acts as the
primary state research institution in its state. Eastern U.S. University had a budget of
$538.5 million US dollars in the 2012 fiscal year and held a $216.9 million US dollar
endowment (Eastern U.S. University, 2013).
Before the implementation of RCB/M at Eastern U.S. University, a centralized
budgeting model was used. All revenues, including tuition, state appropriation revenue,
and indirect cost recovery revenue, flowed to the central administration. A university
budget panel then allocated the revenue to departments using an incremental
budgeting model. On July 1, 2001, Eastern U.S. University started to use RCB/M as its
budgeting and management model to improve incentives for sound fiscal management
“and help all levels of University management make informed financial decisions about
activities to support the University’s mission” (Eastern U.S. University, 2000, 2005; p.1).
In 2006, a formal review process of RCB/M was undertaken. The findings suggested that
RCB/M was a work in progress. Key areas of concern were the model’s complexity,
fairness in outcomes, the alignment of behaviour and decision-making with the mission
of the institution, and the need for strong governance mechanisms to provide oversight
to the units. In 2009, another review of RCB/M was undertaken (Eastern U.S. University,
95
2010). Five key findings emerged: the need to 1. align RCM incentives with institutional
goals; 2. identify the source of central strategic funds; 3. simplify RCB/M; 4. develop
greater financial accountability for all units; and 5. implement strong incentives for net
revenue growth.
Eastern U.S. University is overseen by the statewide University System Board
that is comprised of twenty-seven members including the State Governor, eleven
Governor-appointed members, six alumni-elected members, the Commissioner of
Education, the Commissioner of Agriculture, the presidents of the University System’s
four colleges and universities, and the Chancellor, who acts as the chief executive
officer. Six standing committees are responsible for the general oversight and
management of the University System. This board is responsible for meeting the higher
education needs for the State and endeavours to direct the system to assure the
availability of appropriate programming and higher educational opportunities. It
operates at a strategic level for the system as a whole, allowing for high levels of
autonomy for the university Presidents, who are responsible for the strategic planning
of their respective universities.
Eastern U.S. University is located in a state whose political structure tends to be
individualistic and decentralized. Often this state is referred to as possessing a culture of
rugged individualism and personal responsibility. This political and cultural perspective
aligns well with the premise of RCB/M. However, it has also been identified as the
reason for decreasing state appropriations for its universities. In light of the economic
96
crisis in the United States and resulting severe budget cuts from the state, Eastern U.S.
University, which suffered a 49.9% cut in state appropriations in 2011 [it was already the
lowest funding on a per student basis in the United States], has begun a review of
RCB/M’s ability to align budget decisions with its mission and strategic plan
(Huddleston, 2010). As the President of Eastern U.S. University noted, “We are like a
ship with scores of independently operated rudders. We require greater balance if we
are to achieve our strategic purposes” (n/p).
4.3.3.4 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
Founded in the 1960s, Western Canadian University, located in western Canada,
is the smallest of the province’s six universities. Nine of the twelve interviewees from
Western Canadian University commented that the university operates in the shadow of
its two dominant provincial ‘big brothers’. Composed of three campuses that are
geographically disparate, Western Canadian University serves 8,253 full- and part-time
students at the undergraduate and graduate levels (Western Canadian University,
2013a). Its operating budget was $162 million in the 2012-13 fiscal year (Western
Canadian University, 2013b).
Western Canadian University can be considered an early adopter of RCB/M;
although the budget model was formally named the Instructional Fee Allocation Model
[IFAM], it is considered an RCB/M structure and as such it will be referred to as RCB/M
throughout this paper. The impetus for the transition to a decentralized model at
97
Western Canadian University began in the early 1990s, when the provincial government
instituted drastic funding decreases for higher education institutions (Western Canadian
University, 1999; Tavenas, 1993). These cuts severely affected the ability of HEIs across
the province to operate and deliver programs (McConaghy, 1997). As a response to the
fiscal pressures, the university began to explore a decentralized budgeting and
management model (Jarvie, 2002).
Before implementing a decentralized budget model, Western Canadian
University utilized a fund accounting structure. The centralized fund accounting model is
used by many governments, universities, and non-profit organizations. Fund accounting
is a model that tends to emphasize accountability and ease of oversight rather than
profitability and efficiency. It is characterized by a number of segregated funds that are
a set of accounts for specific, predetermined purposes. Generally, these funds fall into
one of two categories: restricted or unrestricted. Restricted funds are those that must
be spent for specified purposes and are often bound by laws and regulations.
Unrestricted funds are those that can be used for any expenditure and are most often
used for the day-to-day operations of the university. The use of fund accounting is
appropriate for those organizations that receive revenues from a variety of sources,
must ensure the resources are used properly and are not comingled, and require unique
identification and reporting on each of the individual funds. Generally speaking, this
budget model directs all revenue streams to the central administration where they are
then redistributed to the various units. Consequently, the various academic and service
98
units are often unaware of the costs and revenues associated with their operations, and
may have no knowledge of the resulting consequences (Hearn et al., 2006).
The decision to change the budgeting and management structure at Western
Canadian University was made in 1992, with implementation taking place in the 1994-95
fiscal year (Western Canadian University, 1994, 2012a). Citing the successes of some
large U.S. private universities [specifically the University of Pennsylvania and the
University of Southern California], Western Canadian University expected that this new
model would allow academic deans more flexibility in dealing with the substantial
decreases in government funding through the increased incentives for cost
containment, efficiency, and revenue maximization (Jarvie, 2002). The consensus in the
early 1990s was that RCB/M was needed to increase efficiency and drive revenue
growth for the institution at the faculty level by allowing the deans to act in an
entrepreneurial fashion and by holding them responsible for their decisions. RCB/M
was selected as a structure that would encourage fiscal responsibility and act as a
continuous improvement mechanism for the Western Canadian University (Western
Canadian University, 2012b).
Although Western Canadian University has realized increased efficiencies from
the decentralization process, there have also been unanticipated hurdles (Western
Canadian University, 2012a). Namely, the decentralized system at Western Canadian
University has been a source of confusion for departmental budget managers who have
noted that there is not a clear relationship between departmental budgets and
99
institutional goals. Additionally, increasing tensions between units has resulted in
challenges to collegial governance. The decentralized system that was implemented at
Western Canadian University is complex and faculty members have noted that it took
several years before they fully understood the process and could contribute in a
meaningful manner.
In 2012, more than a decade after implementation, Western Canadian
University initiated a full review of their budgeting processes, with the goal of improving
their effectiveness and efficiency (Western Canadian University, 2012a). In January
2012, the President’s Task Force on Budget Process was given the responsibility to
review the RCB/M structure at the university and make recommendations to the
President (Western Canadian University, 2012c, 2012d, 2012e). In this review, the Task
Force consulted with a number of the university’s stakeholders, soliciting feedback and
ideas about the budget process with the goal of fostering collaboration across units and
faculties (Western Canadian University, 2012a; Mahon, 2012). Consultations began with
a Senior Leader’s Retreat and continued through meetings with the University Budget
Committee; chairs, program coordinators, and department heads; the Financial Officer’s
Group; three open forums; the Executive Director’s Council; Academic Council; Dean’s
Council; and Faculty of Arts and Science Chairs and Coordinators. The consultations
resulted in the identification of numerous components of the budget process that serve
the University well. However, they also revealed a number of concerns and potential
opportunities for revising the budget process. The recommendations that were
forwarded by the President’s Task Force on Budget Process (2012) included processes
100
for integrating the budgeting fully with the university’s plans and priorities, creating a
budget process that is understandable and transparent, ensuring that the budget
process is consultative, documented, and timely in nature, and ensuring that the budget
process becomes iterative in nature, addressing items and issues as they occur (Western
Canadian University, 2013c).
The state of budgeting at Western Canadian University has dramatically changed
since the interviews for this study took place. After consideration of the findings of the
President’s Task Force, University leadership opted to replace the RCB/M structure. As
of April 1, 2014, the university has adopted a centralized budgeting and management
process as a response to the numerous challenges they faced under RCB/M.
SECTION 4.4 - INFORMANTS
To collect interview data, informants were identified and contacted with a
request to participate in a 60 minute interview [Appendix 9]. Background information
on each of the four institutions had previously been gathered during the document
analysis phase of data collection; this information informed the selection of interview
participants at each institution. The decentralized budgeting and management structure
at each university was mapped out, including the identification of budgeting units and
potential individuals that could become informants. These potential informants were
chosen because their job responsibilities suggested that they would be knowledgeable
about budgeting and management at their university.
101
Informants are those individuals that are able to provide “information through
formal interviews and informal verbal interchanges or conversations” (Miller &
Crabtree, 1992, p. 71). Each of the individuals identified were well-informed about, and
influential in, their budgeting unit or the institution as a whole. Marshall and Rossman
(1999) suggest that informants are those from whom the most can be learned and who
possess special or unique insights into the topics under investigation. The process of
interviewing such people is intended to encourage a representative perspective to
emerge through the information and opinions that the informants relate (Miller &
Crabtree, 1992).
In this study, a total of 200 individuals, selected equally from all four institutions,
were contacted based on their knowledge of the budgeting, management, and
governance structures of their respective universities. Fifty-five total interviews were
conducted, with sixteen from Midwestern U.S. University, fifteen from Eastern U.S.
University, twelve from Western Canadian University and twelve from Central Canadian
University.
Using the Interview Protocol, participants were asked to describe their
experiences with RCB/M, their respective universities’ governance structures, and the
resulting organizational outcomes. Of particular interest were the discussions
surrounding unit-level autonomy, lateral coordination, vertical coordination, and unit
differentiation, and the perceived effect on resource allocation decision-making. The
intent of these interviews was to uncover relationships between the three factors of the
102
internal structure model and organizational outcomes as affected by the use of RCB/M
and employed governance control form.
Each informant’s right to and desire for confidentiality was acknowledge and
honoured throughout the entire research process. During the recording of each
interview, the informant’s name and position was not mentioned. Each digitally
recorded file was given a code to remove information that could identify the informant.
Although the information about the budgeting, management, and governance
structures of the universities was in the public domain, the information regarding the
key informants’ experiences and opinions was at times particularly sensitive and needed
to be treated justly.
In addition to the above-mentioned steps taken to protect the informants’
confidentiality, the following steps were taken to protect them in accordance with the
Humans in Research process as outlined by the Research Ethics Board at the University
of Central Canadian University [Appendix 10]. All informants were contacted individually
via email [Appendix 9] to introduce myself, explain the study, and ask whether they
would be willing to participate as interviewees. If they were willing to participate, a
follow up email was sent that included the Interviewee Consent Form [Appendix 11]. At
this time, an appointment for the interview was made. In the week preceding the
scheduled interview, participants were e-mailed a copy of the Informed Consent Letter
[Appendix 12]. The consent form asked whether the interviewee gave permission to be
confidentially interviewed, and to have the interview digitally recorded. The executed
103
Informed Consent Letter was collected at the beginning of the interview, after its
contents were reviewed with the interviewee, before any interview questions were
asked. All interview participants were left with a copy of the Informed Consent Letter.
All but three of the interviews were conducted in-person, in the key informant’s
office, and with the exception of one interviewee who did not wish to be recorded, all
were digitally recorded and later transcribed. Those interviews not conducted in-person
were conducted via telephone. To facilitate the interview schedule, one eight day trip
was made to Midwestern U.S. University, one six day trip was made to Eastern U.S.
University, one six day trip was made to Western Canadian University, and seven days
were taken to meet with individuals at Central Canadian University. The interviews took
place between February 2014 and April 2014, with interview sessions ranging in length
from 45 minutes to 120 minutes. All interviewees were generous with their time and
forthcoming with their responses, resulting in a generally high quality of interview.
The researcher ensured that notes were taken before the interviews, detailing
the surroundings in an attempt to help build a context to reference during the coding
and analysis of data. Field notes were taken during the interviews to help the researcher
augment the responses provided by the informants and to make observations during
the discussion. After the interview, the researcher took twenty to thirty minutes to
reflect upon the interviews and record any additional thoughts about the discussion.
The researcher believes that theoretical saturation was reached during the
interview process at each institution with regards to this study. The people interviewed
104
provided a rich and thorough representation of the interactions, processes, procedures,
impacts, and outcomes of the budgeting, management, and governance control form of
their university. The semi-structured interview process allowed the key informants to
speak about the areas of decentralization, governance, management, decision-making
oversight, cooperation, and coordination that they felt were most important.
SECTION 4.5 - INTERVIEW PROTOCOL
The interview protocol used in this study [Appendix 8] acted as a tool that
allowed the researcher to help guide and direct the conversations with key informants
without affecting the interviewees’ frames of reference. The protocol provided
structure for the interview and helped the researcher gather the data needed for this
study. As Borg and Gall (1989) suggest, the protocol provided for the “standardization
from all subjects in the sample” (p. 471).
The protocol outlined questions intended to uncover information based upon
the three main areas of interest [lateral coordination, vertical coordination, and unit
autonomy] as they relate to the budgeting, management, and governance structures of
the four universities. A number of questions regarding general topics surrounding the
understanding of decentralized budgeting and management structures, as well as the
general structures and mission of the institution, were asked to help uncover the
informant’s perspectives and frames of reference. However, the protocol was designed
105
to allow for the interviewee’s own perspective to unfold naturally and without
interference (Marshall & Rossman, 1999).
SECTION 4.6 - DATA ANALYSIS
The analysis of interview data was completed in two stages. The first stage
involved an examination of the data for each of the four HEIs selected for this research.
The result of this examination was the development of a detailed case study narrative
for each of the institutions (Eisenhardt, 1989). The institutions were analyzed in an
effort to identify unique themes, patterns, concepts, and categories that aligned with
the theme categories of vertical and lateral coordination, unit autonomy, unit
differentiation, governance and oversight structures, and organizational outcomes
identified in the research questions. The second stage focused on inter-case comparison
and was utilized to identify related themes and unique features in each of the four HEI
case studies. A matrix for intra-case and inter-case comparison was composed for
analysis purposes [Appendix 13].
The process of data analysis [Appendix 6] began with the creation of the coding
scheme [Appendix 14]. This was the start list used when first considering the data
collected during the document analysis and interviews. The data was sorted and coded
during the data collection phase. An integral part of this process was the identification
of themes, keywords, and key terms, resulting in the addition, deletion, and
modification of codes and code definitions. Once all the interviews were completed, the
main conceptual categories were summarized. Again, this was an iterative process
106
requiring the researcher to revisit both the documents used in the document analysis
and the interview data numerous times. The final stage of the data analysis process was
the creation of matrices to triangulate data from the multiple respondents and
documents [Appendix 15].
SECTION 4.7 - VALIDITY AND RELIABILITY AND THEIR RELATION TO THIS STUDY
The merit of any qualitative study is measured by its validity and reliability
(Patton, 2005). The strengths of this study are its validity and reliability. The following is
a general discussion of validity and reliability and how the researcher can “persuade
his…audiences that the research findings of an inquiry are worth paying attention to"
(Lincoln & Guba, 1985, p. 290).
Halpin and Troyna (1994) define validity as “the extent to which the data we
collect relates to and can answer the research question asked” (p. 163). The general
concept of validity is broken down into three sub-constructs: construct, internal, and
external validity (Pandit, 1996). Construct validity is achieved by establishing operational
procedures, while internal validity is concerned with establishing causal relationships;
external validity focuses on establishing generalizability [Table 4]. Simply stated, validity
is the measure of the strength and quality of the collected data, analysis, and research
design. To ensure the validity of this study, Yin’s (2009) tactics for case study design
were followed.
107
Table 4: Yin’s Tactics for Case Study Design
Tests Yin’s Case Study Tactic to Achieve Validity
This Study’s Tactic to Achieve Validity
Construct Validity Use multiple sources of evidence
Document analysis and multiple key informants used for each case
Establish chain of evidence
Specified process of data collection from both documents and interviews
Have key informants review transcripts
Key informants invited to review and comment on transcripts
Internal Validity Do pattern-matching Pattern-matching completed during data analysis
Do explanation-building Part of the iterative process of data analysis
External Validity Use replication logic in multiple case studies
Four case studies completed
Source: Yin, R. (2009). Case Study Research. London, UK: SAGE Publications.
This study has relied on multiple sources of information about the four
institutions to build each case, including historical information, institutional documents
and reports, interview data, and field notes. The extant literature of governance,
budgeting, management, and organizational design was used as a theoretical
foundation for this study. The triangulation process used the data and information
provided by all these sources to help verify findings.
During the interview process, the themes and subjects that informants chose to
speak about were generally similar, though some of their views differed. Enough of the
informants held approximately the same viewpoint, and subsequently found support
from institutional and historical documents, that a high level of confidence in the
findings is merited. The convergence of data from the interviews and document analysis
108
provided for theoretical saturation, which Miller and Crabtree (1992) describe as the
convergence in understanding between methods that result in the data being more
reliable and valid.
To ensure the accuracy of data collected during the interviews, informants were
invited to review their transcripts and provide follow-up. This allowed the researcher to
be confident in the triangulation of data from a variety of research tools, and collected
from multiple sources, resulting in a more complex understanding of the processes and
effects of RCB/M’s use in universities.
With regard to Yin’s argument for constructing a chain of evidence, the narrative
presented in this study provides a logical map allowing the reader to follow and
understand the foundation of the study, the method of data collection and analysis, and
the resulting findings. A transparent chain of evidence has been developed that leads to
the findings in subsequent chapters.
To achieve internal validity, an explanation-building strategy was chosen. As Yin
(2009) states, “In a multiple-case study, one goal is to build a general explanation that
fits each of the individual cases, even though the cases will vary in their details. The
objective is analogous to multiple experiments” (p. 112). Ultimately, the data collected
during this study has been used to build a narrative that provides an explanation for
what has happened and is happening at these four universities.
Focusing on the generalizability of this study, and by extension on its external
validity, the multiple case study approach was employed with the intention of providing
109
for analytical generalization and allowing for the results to be applied to a broader
theory (Yin, 2009). Although the intent of qualitative research is not to generalize
findings, but rather to interpret unique events and contexts (Merriam, 1998), the
similarity in findings between cases with regard to themes, relationships, and structures
should provide for limited generalizability and for support of the three-factor theoretical
model proposed. The application of the research methods described above to each of
the four cases has created a greater ability to generalize, make recommendations, and
provide a framework for future studies and testing.
Pandit (1996) argues that reliability requires the processes of the study, such as
data collection and analysis, to be repeatable and result in the same or similar results.
Yin (209) outlines two steps needed to achieve reliability: 1. use of a case study
protocol; and 2. development of a case study database. To ensure the reliability of this
study, a case study database was developed and a case study protocol was followed. It
should be noted that the replication of qualitative case studies is difficult due to their
particularly individual nature. However, through the document analysis and interview
processes, enough data was collected to allow others to apply the findings in similar
cases.
The specified processes of: 1. constructing the Interview Protocol; 2. building and
deploying the research questions; 3. the iterative creation of a coding scheme; 4.
reviewing throughout the data collection processes; and 5. sorting and analyzing data;
have resulted in the triangulation of data and findings. The Interview Protocol helped to
110
strengthen the ability to compare the information gathered from informants.
Subsequently, this allowed for the development of an analytical framework during the
data analysis phase; this framework served to order and analyze the data in an attempt
to strengthen the reliability of this study.
SECTION 4.8 - LIMITATIONS OF THIS STUDY
This multiple case study approach was meant to encourage the validity and
reliability of this study. Various tools were used to gather information and develop the
four comparative case studies presented. The research tools were intended to develop a
better understanding of the effects of RCB/M’s use at universities, the governance
structures employed, and the effect of organizational structure. All this was done to
start the testing process of the three-factor model of organizational design presented in
Chapter Three. However, this study is not without its limitations. Although all effort has
been made in the creation and application of the research-method structure outlined
above, some limitations exist.
First among the limitations of this study is a reflection of the quantity and
complexity of the data gathered during the document analysis and interview stages. Due
to the amount of data gathered, the analysis was a difficult task, and some of the
nuances may have been lost as it was incorporated into this study. Additionally, the time
and resources needed to complete this study, in terms of the cost of travel,
111
transcription services, analysis, and crafting this report, were significant and acted as a
constraint.
The second limitation of this study is researcher bias. As only one researcher was
involved in the data collection and analysis, this study was subject to a single
interpretation. Although multiple sources [document analysis and interviews] were
utilized and completing interviews with fifty five participants helped to triangulate the
findings and provide a convergence of ideas and of themes, the findings were all viewed
through a single researcher’s lens.
Third, this study is limited in terms of which individuals were selected, agreed to
be interviewed, and, more importantly, refused to be interviewed. Although the
number, position, and experience of those interviewed should be considered more than
adequate, it should be noted that a number of key individuals (eg. certain presidents,
provosts, senior budget officers, and deans) were not able to be interviewed due to
scheduling conflicts or lack of response. The inability to interview everyone suggests
that some points of view were not captured in the interview process.
It should be noted that the researcher took every available step to mitigate the
limitations of this study. Seeking numerous key informants at each university, applying
the Interview Protocol, recording field notes, and seeking verification from key
informants were all steps taken to alleviate limitations. Through a meticulously
constructed approach, and careful execution of the research design, many of the
limitations in this study were reduced or eliminated.
112
CHAPTER FIVE
FRAMING VERTICAL COORDINATION
“It isn’t all about money, but it was mostly about money.”
(personal communication, April 2, 2014)
SECTION 5.1 – INTRODUCTION
This chapter presents the data and resultant findings pertaining to vertical
coordination. Vertical coordination provides a concept to evaluate the presence and
degree of alignment, cooperation, and coordination between the central administration
of an institution and the individual units. Vertical coordination is evaluated by
considering the degree of cooperation and coordination, or competition and conflict,
present at an institution. As discussed previously in Chapter Three, the levels of
cooperation and coordination will have a material impact on a variety of matters in
universities, including: 1. competition between units; 2. interdisciplinary programs; 3.
cross appointments of faculty; 4. opportunities for new programs at the intersection of
traditional knowledge domains; and 5. the development of programs offered across
multiple units that provide increased value for students. It is noteworthy that a
significant degree of consensus regarding the relationships between central
administration and units, and between units, was espoused by the interview
participants with regard to their respective institutions.
113
A discussion of the essential features that influence vertical coordination at the
four universities is presented, including governance control form, budgeting,
management, and institutional structure. Although differences in institutional
characteristics existed, thematic similarities were present within and across these
institutions. Interviews with 55 participants revealed many shared experiences and
provided consistent reinforcement of general themes. In this chapter the common
themes are presented along with a case study analysis of each institution. A distinct
discussion will be provided for each institution, followed by a discussion of the four
propositions relating to vertical coordination.
SECTION 5.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
Informants identified three broad themes that impact vertical coordination at
Midwestern U.S. University: 1. the role of the central administration; 2. changing unit
oversight and central administrative influence; and 3. a model of management and
oversight that blends interactive and diagnostic control. At Midwestern U.S. University
the central administration provides support for units while serving as a unifying agent by
applying both interactive and diagnostic management techniques. A more in-depth
exploration of the vertical coordination present at the University will be discussed
below.
114
5.2.1 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION
At Midwestern U.S. University the central administration acts in a federal
capacity, providing resources and support to units while acting as a coordinating force
that promotes the alignment of unit decisions and initiatives with the mission and
strategic goals of the university. Informants identified a wide array of responsibilities
that are held by the central administration, including the: 1. establishment of
institutional strategy; 2. provision of internal regulatory controls and oversight for unit
decision-making; 3. management of capital investments and projects; and 4.
responsibility operations and general management. These responsibilities can only be
acted upon successfully when vertical coordination between units and the central
administration is sufficiently strong as to promote communication and cooperation.
Informants identified three factors that determine the efficacy of the central
administration and its relationship with units: 1. the retention of central financial
resources; 2. the presence of processes, both formal and informal, that promote vertical
discussion, negotiation, and collaboration; and 3. the central administration serving as a
resource for units.
5.2.2 - THE IMPACT OF CENTRALLY HELD FINANCIAL RESOURCES
Midwestern U.S. University has operated under a decentralized budgeting and
management structure for nearly two decades. Over this time period the budgeting
formulas have been periodically revised to more accurately reflect the resource
allocation needs of the institution and to promote operational efficiency. Under the
115
Budget Model and System [a revised version of the Value Centered Management [VCM]
model, and the RCB/M structure currently in use by Midwestern U.S. University] the
central administration wields significant power and is able to direct strategic initiatives
through the retention of financial resources, collected via holdbacks and taxes on unit
revenue (Courant & Knepp, 2002). These resources also allow the central administration
to provide support for important but non-self-supporting programs, and provide funds
to help units weather fiscal challenges (Courant & Knepp, 2002; personal
communication, February 20, 2014).
As a consequence of the increase in centrally held financial resources, the central
administration is able to exert increased influence over unit decision-making via the
disbursement of funding to units. Historically under the VCM model the central
administration was only able to oversee unit decision-making at a high level, with little
real influence over the growing budget deficits (personal communication, February 18,
2014). The inability to influence unit-level resource allocation decisions was manifested
by units funding programs with declining enrollment, resulting in structural budget
deficits (personal communication, March 11, 2014). Consequently, these units did not
have the funds necessary to invest into growing and increasingly popular programs,
limiting their ability to grow enrollment and revenues and “stay relevant” (personal
communication, February 17, 2014) for students. Under the UBM, the ability of the
central administration to influence unit decision-making has increased. The
maintenance of central funds has enabled the central administration to provide
incentives and one-time investments that align unit decision-making with the overall
116
strategy of the University (personal communication, February 17, 2014; February 18,
2014; February 19, 2014; February 21, 2014; March 11, 2014). Centrally held funds are
accessed via a bidding process whereby units present detailed plans and rational that
justifies how the funding will support the institution’s broader mission and strategic
direction (personal communication, March 11, 2014). Informants lauded these
incentives and investments as helping to promote new programs and unit initiatives
that would otherwise be impossible for individual units to implement [due to limited
unit finances] (personal communication, February 17th, 2014).
While the central administration at Midwestern U.S. University provides
oversight for all units, direct involvement in unit decision-making is typically reserved for
units who display structural budget deficits. The result of increased central involvement
can be seen in increased unit revenues and the reversal of the unit deficits, moving units
in financial trouble towards solvency and improving revenues for financially sustainable
units. The increased oversight and influence possible under the University Budget Model
and System has resulted in improved relations and increased communication between
units and the central administration. This improved vertical coordination has
strengthened both formal and informal communication channels and initiated a variety
of vertical interactions between the central administration and units, such as meetings
and presentations (personal communication, February 18, 2014). The improved vertical
coordination present at the University has enabled the continued improvement of
oversight and monitoring practices and the alignment of unit-level strategic decision-
117
making with institutional priorities (personal communications, February 17, 2014; March
11, 2014).
5.2.3 - FORMAL AND INFORMAL PROCESSES THAT ENCOURAGE VERTICAL COORDINATION
In addition to acting as an aligning mechanism, centrally held financial resources
have allowed the central administration to develop formal and informal processes to
encourage dialogue and provide direction, oversight, and support to units. One
informant noted that “there is a great deal of collaboration between the various
colleges and the central administration, through formal and informal groups, meetings
and relationships” (personal communication, February 21, 2014). One of the “numerous
central initiatives intended to encourage [vertical] communication and cooperation such
as the monthly BAG [Budget Advisory Group] meetings” (personal communication,
February 19, 2014). The Budget Advisory Group is structured to bring deans, senior unit
administrators, and central administrators from the Provost’s and Budget and Planning
offices together to discuss current challenges and opportunities facing the University
and units. Informants reported that the BAG meetings have increased both the
frequency and quality of vertical communication taking place at the University, while
promoting networking and informal lateral communication between unit leaders.
Informants believe that the increased communication resulting from the BAG, and other
centrally supported initiatives, will encourage unit leaders to consider the University as
a whole when making decisions (personal communication, February 21, 2014).
118
Additionally, the centrally supported formal processes help to ensure that the budget
system serves, but does not define, the academic commitments of the units and
university (Cantor & Courant, 1997). This relationship allows each “college [to be] able
to paddle their own boat but still [be] supported and supervised” (personal
communication, February 19, 2014) by the central administration.
The most formal example of vertical interaction at Midwestern U.S. University is
the annual budgeting process3. The Budget Model and System is a hybrid of activity-
based and discretionary budgeting (Courant & Knepp, 2002). The discretionary portion
of the budget [discussed above] is composed of the resources that are centrally held
and allocated to encourage initiatives aligned with the strategic direction of the
University. Conversely, the activity-based based funds are allocated to units
synchronously with student enrollment patterns, sponsored research revenue, and
auxiliary activities. The general fund [or base] budget for each unit is determined
through extensive information sharing between the unit and the Provost’s office.
Throughout the year units participate in nearly continuous communication and
consultation with the central administration; these conversations serve as a foundation
upon which units identify current threats and opportunities and develop their budget
proposals. The ongoing vertical interactions allow unit leaders to operate with
autonomy, while facilitating central oversight throughout the budget cycle. The budget
development process culminates with Deans presenting their budget proposals to the
Provost; because of the extensive vertical communication throughout the year, this
3 Budget units at Midwestern U.S. University are divided into five distinct categories: 1. schools and colleges; 2. academic; 3. auxiliary; 4. research; and 5. central service.
119
process resembles a discussion rather than a traditional approval process (personal
communication, February 18, 2014; March 11, 2014). Multiple informants suggested
that the data, information, and guidance provided by the central administration during
the budgeting process allows for more informed decisions-making (personal
communications, February 20, 2014; February 21, 2014; March 11, 2014).
In addition to the annual budget process other formal centrally supported
initiatives facilitate vertical coordination. These include Deans and Chairs meetings that
are organized on a regular basis and provide a forum for unit leaders to address
concerns with the central administration while enabling the central administration to
assist units with problem solving (personal communications, February 17, 2014;
February 19, 2015; March 11, 2014); and quarterly budget meetings that engage the
central administration and unit leaders to provide progress updates vis-à-vis unit budget
plans. These meetings were characterized as ‘light touch’ interactions by informants and
they provide immediate feedback for units and the central administration and
strengthen the vertical relationships at the University (personal communication,
February 18, 2014; March 11, 2014).
At Midwestern U.S. University, the result of these formal and informal central
processes has been an increase in communication and cooperation between the Office
of Budget and Planning, the Provost’s staff, and units leadership. Additionally, these and
other similar initiatives have created a positive vertical relationship between the
Provost’s office and units, further strengthening vertical cooperation and
120
communication practices (personal communication, February 17, 2014; February 18,
2014; February 21, 2014).
It is important to note that within these vertical interactions the central
administration holds the power to influence units interactively, through investment and
consultation, but is also willing to influence unit behaviour via diagnostic methods, such
as veto power, the setting of tax rates and unit risk assessments. The central
administration at Midwestern U.S. University is generally considered by informants to
employ a ‘soft power’ approach to unit oversight and only resorts to using veto power in
extreme situations that require expedient corrective action (personal communication,
Feburary 19, 2014; February 20, 2014).
5.2.4 - CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION ACTING AS A RESOURCE
At Midwestern U.S. University the central administration encourages vertical
coordination by providing support services and expertise for units. One informant
commented that increasingly “central provides and shares expertise with us. It is quite
helpful because sometimes we don’t possess specialized capabilities in-house to help us
make the best informed decision possible” (personal communication, February 20,
2014). One dean stated that the “Provost’s office has provided us with the information
needed to build a holistic understanding of our operations and how we fit into the
university” (personal communication, February 18, 2014). By acting as a resource for
units, the central administration maintains a natural vantage point from which to
121
oversee and influence unit-level decision-making processes. The central administration
at Midwestern U.S. University operates a number of programs to support units, staff,
and faculty. One informant stated that “central [administration] helps to inform us of
more general trends and acts as a resource to help take advantage of trends and
mitigate risk” (personal communication, February 17, 2014). Examples of centrally
administered programs include the Center for Research on Learning and Teaching,
which is intended to support faculty and graduate student teaching efforts; the
Interdisciplinary Faculty Initiative, which provides cost sharing between units and the
Provost’s office to encourage the hiring of new faculty members who teach in
interdisciplinary programs or teach across units; and initiatives that provide resources
related to cost reduction and revenue enhancements, space planning and utilization,
accreditation, and program development and support.
One centrally supported exercise that merits further discussion is the
benchmarking initiative; this initiative collects information from every unit that
composes Midwestern U.S. University and publishes the data internally to support units
in informed decision-making (personal communication, February 19, 2014; February 20,
2014). The benchmarking process examines the cost of administrative functions,
including finance, human resources and payroll, procurement, information technology
[IT], student services, development, communications, and research administration.
Benchmarking is an ongoing process that is jointly sponsored by a variety of central
122
administrative departments at the University4. The objective of the Benchmarking
initiative is to increase the effectiveness of resource allocation and the alignment of
ancillary services towards the mission of teaching, research and service.
In addition to support programs, such as the Benchmarking initiative, the central
administration at Midwestern U.S. University employs diagnostic tools to support “those
colleges that do not meet their budget”. Those units that are trending toward break
even, at break even or running deficits are provided with increased oversight and
communication expectations from the Chief Financial Officer and Provost’s office
(personal communication, February 18, 2014). Informants characterized these
interactions as “‘light-touch’ conversations where the central administration wields far
more power” than is normally the case with solvent units (personal communication,
February 21, 2014). For units in financial crisis the Provost exercises extensive influence,
most often manifesting in the provision of support, direction, and analysis for unit
leadership (personal communication, February 20, 2014). Additionally, reporting
expectations increase in an effort to strengthen vertical communication and develop
solutions.
5.2.5 - HYBRID GOVERNANCE AND OVERSIGHT
Based on data established through discussions with informants and supported by
the document analysis, it is clear that the central administration at Midwestern U.S.
4 The Benchmarking initiative is co-sponsored by the Offices of the Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer, Provost for Academic and Budgetary Affairs, Executive Vice President for Medical Affairs, and Associate Vice President for Finance.
123
University has, since the transition to the University Budget Model and System,
employed a hybrid governance control form that includes both diagnostic and
interactive approaches. In this hybrid system the Provost has the ability to exert
significant influence on unit-level decision-making through the provision of veto power
over programs and initiatives and through increased reporting requirements. Similarly,
the Chief Financial Officer can influence programs and initiatives where risk profiles are
beyond acceptable institutional norms. Recent trends have shown that the central
administration will block certain decisions and initiatives proposed by the units
(personal communication, February 17, 2014) if they do not align with institutional goals
or are otherwise deemed unsatisfactory. However, as one dean stated “[the] central
[administration] is relatively hands-off, they present guidance to help and do not act as
an overbearing partner” (personal communication, Feb 21, 2014).
Although the central administration does have the ability to employ considerable
diagnostic control mechanisms, interactive forms of control are most often utilized. The
vertical relationship between units and the central administration at Midwestern U.S.
University was frequently described as a process of communication and negotiation
between deans and the provost, with one informant stating that “there are many
meetings between the Deans and the Provost’s office, resulting in a great deal of
negotiation.” (personal communication, February 18, 2014) and another stating that the
norm is a “consultative process between the deans and the provost” (personal
communication, February 20, 2014). This approach should come as little surprise, as
Midwestern U.S. University’s budget model is self-described as dean-centric. Deans
124
have “a great deal of power [at Midwestern U.S. University]; for this reason, the central
administration is forced to be consultative in their approach with the colleges” (personal
communication, March 11, 2014).
A senior central administrator provided a summary of the vertical relationship
between units and the central administration when s/he suggested that “transparency
and communication are the best tools for aligning unit priorities and building trust. The
use of soft power is necessary in a decentralized system such as that at Midwestern U.S.
University” (personal communication, February 21, 2014).
5.2.6 - SUMMARY
At Midwestern U.S. University the central administration relies on what
informants termed a ‘soft touch’ and ‘soft power’ approach. Interactive management
techniques are frequently employed to encourage the alignment of unit decisions with
the strategic direction and mission of the University. Through consultation,
communication, and collaboration, the central administrator encourages and influences
the decision-making of the unit. However, by retaining full discretion over central funds
and through the deployment of these funds via a ‘bidding’ process, the central
administration wields robust diagnostic control; this diagnostic control compels units to
behave in a self-interested manner while also collaborating with peer units and
promotes centrally aligned unit-level decision-making. For units experiencing financial
difficulty, the central administration takes on a more active role in reorganization and in
125
unit decision-making, often applying diagnostic control mechanisms. Based on the
evidence presented above, Midwestern U.S. University’s central administration applies a
hybrid approach relying primarily on an interactive control form of governance and
oversight while applying diagnostic measures when needed.
At Midwestern U.S. University, the formal processes and programs facilitated by
the central administration have encouraged the achievement of unit efficiencies.
Through bench-marking and best practice processes, informants identified cost savings
within their units. The centralization of certain support services has provided expertise
on subjects such as human resources, information technology, procurement, and
finance to units; without central resources the responsibility for these service areas
would fall to individual units, requiring substantial duplication of expertise and
personnel. These central initiatives have allowed the achievement of economies of scale
for numerous units that could not have done so otherwise.
The coordinating role that the central administration performs has also helped
provide efficiencies across the units of the university. Through the building of processes
to encourage cooperation between units, duplicate courses have been reduced and in
many cases eliminated. Units have also been encouraged to work together to hire cross-
appointments, helping to attract top talent while minimizing salary costs to each of the
units.
Oversight of decision-making by the central administration, both through formal
and informal processes, was also identified as a means to encourage financial stability.
126
Through interactive and ongoing communication, the central administration and units
were able to align their efforts with the goals of the institution while also addressing the
needs of the units. This has helped to provide direction and expertise to those units that
need it as well ensure that decisions are financially sound. Through the use of
discretionary funding, the central administration was able to influence and direct unit
decision-making. Such funding has also allowed the investment into new and cutting
edge programs to help increase revenues through enrollment, private funding, and
research funding.
SECTION 5.3 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
At Central Canadian University the central administration operates in a federal
capacity5. This role is analogous to the role of the central administration at Midwestern
U.S. University; the similarity between the universities is not surprising considering that
the RCB/M model employed by Central Canadian University [the New Budget Model]
was developed in consultation with Midwestern U.S. University (personal
communications, March 25, 2014; April 3, 2014). The relationship between Central
Canadian University and Midwestern U.S. University is ongoing and organizational
similarities in form and policy reflect this continued relationship.
5 The central administration at Central Canadian University is comprised on the Office of the President, the Office of the Provost, the Office of Planning and Budget, and a variety of Vice President portfolios that includes operations, advancement, research and innovation, human resources and equity, and university relations.
127
Informants identified several important concepts that impact the level of vertical
coordination at Central Canadian University. These broad areas include: 1. the impact of
centrally retained financial resources; 2. the presence of centrally supported formal and
informal processes; 3. the central administration serving as a resource for units; 4. the
budget review process; 5. evolving oversight and management strategies; and 6. hybrid
governance and oversight that blends diagnostic and interactive management
techniques. An in-depth discussion of vertical coordination at Central Canadian
University follows below.
5.3.1 - THE IMPACT OF CENTRALLY HELD FINANCIAL RESOURCES
At Central Canadian University the central administration retains control over
financial resources, which are dispersed to units on an annual basis to promote the
alignment of unit decision-making with institutional strategic goals. The central
retention of financial resources, managed through the ‘University Fund’, was identified
by informants as an important central control mechanism to allow for central influence
over unit decision-making (i.e. personal communications, March 25, 2014; March 27,
2014; March 31, 2014; April 2, 2014; April 3, 2014). When the New Budget Model was
first introduced at Central Canadian University, the University Fund was used as a
mechanism for ensuring that no unit would receive less revenue under the New Budget
Model than they received under the old model. Currently, the University Fund is funded
by a 10 percent tax from divisional gross revenues across the institution and comprises
the non-formulaic portion of unit budgets.
128
The importance of the University Fund as a “strategic tool for new initiatives and
as a bailout on a one time only basis has been invaluable for the Provost” (personal
communication, April 2, 2014). The University Fund has enabled the strengthening of
quality and the provision of stability for units and the institution as a whole (Central
Canadian University, 2012b). A percentage of the University Fund is allocated for annual
unit budgets, forcing units to rely on the central administration for daily operating
funds. The rationale for this allocation is that no unit should be fully self-sustaining in
order to avoid isolation and decision-making that is independent of institutional context
and goals. The remainder of the fund is allocated on an ad hoc basis, at the discretion of
the Provost, to provide strategic funding for initiatives that align with the University’s
academic values and priorities (Central Canadian University, 2013b). When making
decisions on how the discretionary portion of the University Fund will be allocated, the
Provost relies on the recommendations of a committee composed of relevant unit
leaders and central support units, such as the Office of Planning and Budget.
5.3.2 - FORMAL AND INFORMAL PROCESSES THAT ENCOURAGE VERTICAL COORDINATION
At Central Canadian University, the central administration works to encourage
vertical coordination via formal and informal processes. The central administration
provides support and oversight through a variety of initiatives and committees that
engage units in ongoing dialogue with the central administration and promote vertical
coordination. One example of this ongoing, formal dialogue is the integration of
129
budgeting and institutional strategic direction. This initiative brings together the
academic board that is “responsible for budgeting oversight and approving and directing
the academic direction”, and the central administration that is responsible for setting
strategic direction and institutional goals. By formally encouraging dialogue between
these two groups, it is anticipated that budgetary allocations may be more aligned with
strategic direction and as a result enhance vertical alignment (personal communication,
April 3, 2014).
A second formal mechanism that is supported by the central administration is
the ‘Provostial Committee’. In addition to being responsible for the administration of
the University Fund, the Provostial Committee provides units with guidance during the
academic appointment approval process and also oversees the distribution of academic
reserve funds. The Provostial Committee works collaboratively with deans and senior
unit administrators to identify unit priorities and to provide problem solving and
strategic planning support to units (Central Canadian University, 2009). This consultative
process was identified by informants as producing significant engagement from deans,
directors, and senior administrators. By engaging both unit leaders and administrators
this process promoted vertically aligned decision-making while granting the central
administration the ability to oversee unit activities in an unobtrusive manner (personal
communication, March 25, 2014).
With an approach that encourages “participatory decision-making where
budgets are presented to the president, provost, deans and principals” (personal
communication, March 27, 2014), the Provost’s office works to guide and support units
130
while providing oversight through discussion and collaboration (personal
communication, April 2, 2014). Additionally, the central administration takes an active
role in providing financial support for struggling units in an attempt to “help the faculty
[unit] help themselves” (personal communication, April 2, 2014). When financial issues
arise at the unit level the central administration works in active partnership with the
unit to overcome risks, and to identify and capitalize on opportunities for growth and
revenue generation. One dean noted that “together [central administration and the
unit] will look for solutions and often central will help with support” (personal
communication, April 3, 2014).
5.3.3 - CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION ACTING AS A RESOURCE
The central administration at Central Canadian University serves as a resource
for units by providing formal and informal processes, programs and support initiatives
that address a wide variety of operational and strategic areas. One important area of
support is related to the annual budget planning process. The New Budget Model is
based on the institutional need for data driven decision-making (Lang, 2002; Central
Canadian University, 2009; 2012b). Under this system, units receive support from the
Planning and Budget Office in the form of training, and seminars. Additionally, budget
data is made available for units to use in their annual planning process (Central
Canadian University, 2007; personal communication, April 3, 2014). Specifically, “during
the fall planning process a large amount of budget information is provided by [the office
of] budgeting and planning; 1 and 5 year plans are built and during this process we need
131
to reach out to a variety of central administration areas for both support and sign off”
(personal communication, March 27, 2014). The central administration provides support
through data analyses and the authoring of reports that provide context to budgetary
data (personal communication, March 28, 2014). Several informants noted that the
central administration has become a valuable resource in the creation and management
of unit budgets. One unit leader praised the central administration’s efforts to “become
more customer service oriented, with increased staff capacity and increased technical
capabilities. More and more the focus is on our [the units] needs” (personal
communication, March 26, 2014).
In addition to the budget planning process the central administration at the
Central Canadian University encourages vertical coordination through administrative
programs that provide specialized expertise and support for unit’s administrative and
operational needs. One central program that merits further discussion is the financial
and budgetary training initiative. This initiative provides unit administrators with
education and expert support related to the budgeting process, as well as general
financial administration (personal communication, March 25, 2014; April 2, 2014). This
initiative includes “a number of boot camps in budgeting, finance, and human resources
provided through the Provost’s office to encourage ongoing training and constant
refreshing” (personal communication, March 26, 2014).
A second central initiative that was identified by informants as encouraging
vertical coordination is related to unit-level risk management. As an institution, Central
Canadian University has placed a high priority on being more attentive to risk factors
132
(Central Canadian University, 2011a). The risk management initiative supports units by
providing training on risk factors and mitigation strategies. This initiative has been
successful in developing risk management as a crucial element of divisional planning.
One informant elucidated the concept of risk when stating that “today there is an
increased awareness of risk and risk management is more important at the unit level
under the New Budget Model because [units] are more directly effected by fluctuations
in budget and external economic factors (personal communication, April 2, 2014). This
increased awareness of risk, and the increasingly data-driven nature of risk
management at Central Canadian University has demaned increased central resources,
support, and oversight (Central Canadian University, 2011a).
5.3.4 - THE BUDGET REVIEW PROCESS
Vertical coordination is encouraged in a variety of ways at Central Canadian
University. One significant avenue that promotes vertical coordination is the budget
review process. Unit budgets are presented to the president, provost, deans, and
principals with the explicit objective of encouraging transparency and understanding
(personal communication, March 27, 2014). The budget presentation represents the
culmination of conscious and continuous vertical interaction between the unit and
central administration. The personal relationships fostered by consistent vertical
communication provide incentives for the alignment of unit-level budget decisions with
academic and extra-unit goals (Central Canadian University, 2011a). Because of the
continual nature of the vertical communication at Central Canadian University few
133
surprises arise at the budget presentation stage (personal communication, April 3,
2014). One informant likened this process to “a complicated dance where both parties
(central administration and units) attempted not to step on each other’s toes” (personal
communication, April 2, 2014). The budget process culminates in a series of central
approvals; the Provost’s Advisory Committee [composed of deans and principals]
provides the final approval and “rolls all unit budgets together” (personal
communication, March 27, 2014), this comprehensive budget is then presented to the
Provost’s Executive Group [composed of the Provost and senior deans] where the
budget process is finalized. The budget process at Central Canadian University is
intended to “provide for transparency and openness, to support collegiality, building of
trust, credibility and transparency of intent” (personal communication, April 2, 2014)
and represents a process of oversight rooted in the tradition of collegial governance.
5.3.5 - EVOLVING OVERSIGHT AND MANAGEMENT
Informants at Central Canadian University identified a trend of increasing central
oversight and influence; this increased central role affects both services and programs,
while concurrently changing the dynamic of vertical relationships at the University. This
centralizing trend of increasing oversight and shifting vertical relationship dynamics is
especially evident when examining units that have experienced or are experiencing
financial challenges. In instances where central funds are needed to support the
operation of a program, the central administration takes an active role program
assessment and unit budget evaluation. Additionally, the central administration exerts
134
increased influence over unit operations and unit decision-making in such cases
(personal communication, April 4, 2014). Informants identified an example of this
increased central involvement in the Faculty of Music, which has experienced sustained
structural budget deficits. The Faculty of Music was granted $1 million in one-time
funding to aid in the transition to a sustainable financial structure (Central Canadian
University, 2011a). During this transition, the central administration provided crucial
support and acted as a collaborator in the decision-making process surrounding the
restructuring; without the involvement and resources of the central administration, it is
doubtful that the Faculty of Music would have been able to successfully restructure
their program and ensure the balancing of future budgets (personal communication,
April 3, 2014).
5.3.6 - HYBRID OVERSIGHT AND MANAGEMENT
The central administration of Central Canadian University operates a variety of
programs, and provides a wide array of supports for units. These initiatives promote
vertical coordination and the alignment of unit decision-making with institutional goals.
Informants (e.g. March 25, 2014; March 27, 2014; March 30, 2014; April 2, 2014; April 3
2014; April 4, 2014) reported that the central administration, by default, applied an
interactive control form of governance and oversight; this is evidenced by the
collaborative nature of the budget review process and the allocation of the University
Fund. However, when necessary, the central administration is able to apply a diagnostic
control form to “firmly encourage support of the University’s strategic priorities”
135
(personal communication, April 2, 2014). One senior unit-level administrator summed
the approach up by stating “they [central administration] approach every problem in a
collegial fashion. This is the carrot. However, when needed they are capable of applying
a great deal of force. This is the stick” (personal communication, March 27, 2014).
The interactive approach employed by the central administration is made
possible through constructive and frequent communication between the central
administration and the deans. It has been suggested that this communication and the
commitment to transparency in the decision-making and budgeting processes helps
“both [the] governance and management of resource allocations” (April 3, 2014) and
encourages unit plans that “meet divisional needs and the University’s direction, plan,
and mission” (personal communication, March 25, 2014).
5.3.7 - SUMMARY
At Central Canadian University the central administration employs a hybrid form
of governance that combines both interactive and diagnostic control mechanisms. The
interactive control form appears to be the default approach and is achieved through
vertical communication, cooperation and collaboration between the central
administration and units. The central administration often takes a collegial approach to
the governance and oversight process, and it grants deans substantial latitude in
decision-making. It should be noted that the interactive control form as default control
mechanism is not a surprising finding at Central Canadian University. At the University,
Dean’s possess a great deal of power, and, if they choose, could create a difficult vertical
136
relationship with the central administration (personal communication, April 3, 2014).
Because Central Canadian University is a dean-centric school, high degrees of autonomy
are provided to the units; however, through the use of soft power, the central
administration is able to bound unit decision-making by providing oversight (personal
communication, March 31, 2014).
SECTION 5.4 - EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
Informants described a budgeting and management environment that differs
greatly from the observations at Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian
University. One such difference was the theme of ‘underfunding’ which was a prevalent
concern voiced by informants. One informant described the funding environment at
Eastern U.S. University when s/he stated that the university operates with an “appalling
level of underfunding from the State” (personal communication, February 25, 2014).
The University has experienced recent cuts in public funding; however the culture of
austerity that is present at Eastern U.S. University is a reflection of sustained fiscal
constraint that has been present for decades. This austerity culture has had a dramatic
effect on the structure of the RCB/M model employed and, consequently, on the
vertical relationship between the central administration and units.
Informants repeatedly spoke about three main areas that impact the vertical
coordination at the University: 1. the over-decentralization of the University; 2. the
137
historical role of central administration and a tradition of diagnostic control; and 3. a
new commitment to vertical coordination.
5.4.1 - A STATE OF OVER DECENTRALIZATION
The RCB/M model employed by Eastern U.S. University is highly decentralized,
and is a reflection of broader state culture. State residents, as a generalization, are
proud of their rugged individualism and this is reflected in their state government,
which is small and unobtrusive. Analogously, the central administration at Eastern U.S.
University is small and controls few financial resources. Higher education funding in the
state is famously fiftieth [50th] out of the fifty [50] states. For Eastern U.S. University,
state appropriations only account for six percent of the university’s total operating
budget (Huddleston, 2014).
The “over-decentralization” (personal communication, February 24, 2014)
present at Eastern U.S. University is represented by the ongoing “struggle to find
balance [between the direction of the university and the decisions of the units]”
(personal communication, February 26, 2014). The central administration has
historically lacked the funds to provide “support for programs in financial need or to
provide strategic money to initialize large campus initiatives” (personal communication,
February 27, 2014). The lack of centrally held financial resources has resulted in the
inability, on the part of the central administration, to apply interactive governance.
Without financial resources the central administration is unable to effectively incentivise
138
units to align their decision-making to institutional strategic goals. As a result,
management through the application of diagnostic control techniques has resulted in
the central administration providing unit management and oversight through a “force of
will and policy” (personal communication, February 28, 2014) that compel units to align
decisions with the strategic direction of the university (personal communications,
February 6, 2014; March 13, 2014). As a consequence of this diagnostic management
method the central administration is viewed by informants as being a “service support
centre” (personal communication, February 27, 2014) and the “creator of obstacles”
(personal communication, February 28, 2014) rather than the “captain of the ship”
(personal communication, March 13, 2014). Recently, the central administration has
recognized that it lacks the ability apply interactive governance and oversight (personal
communications, February 25, 2014; March 13, 2014). One central administrator
lamented that the “pendulum has swung too far towards decentralization. It is time that
we correct this imbalance and move towards a more balanced model” (personal
communication, February 24, 2014). To achieve this rebalancing, recent refinements to
the RCB/M model have been approved (Eastern U.S. University, 2009). One corrective
measure is the creation of the Strategic Initiative Fund. This fund is centrally controlled
by the Provost and it intended to promote the utilization of interactive control through
the creation of “appropriate incentives in support of [Eastern U.S. University’s] mission
and academic plan” (Eastern U.S. University, 2009, p.1). The goal is that the fund will
represent approximately two per cent of the University’s annual budget, and will
maintain a balance of between $5 million and $15 million.
139
5.4.2 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION: A TRADITION OF DIAGNOSTIC CONTROL
At Eastern U.S. University the central administration has historically served in “a
support mode [for units] rather than the leading and directing mode” (personal
communication, February 26, 2014). The central administration provides support for
units thought a variety of service centers that help units with operational needs such as
finance and human resource, projections and financial modelling, budget monitoring,
and guidance in adhering to the University System and institutional policies (Eastern U.S.
University, 2011). Although these supports extend across numerous functional areas,
informants in unit leadership and central administrative roles reported concern that
they are not sufficient to promote the desired degree of vertical coordination.
Informants reported several aspects of the current budget process that hinder
vertical coordination. Specific areas of concern are the lack of transparency surrounding
how allocation formulas are developed, the limited two-way vertical communication
relating to budget allocations, and the perception by unit leaders that the central
administration is unresponsive to unit needs and concerns. It was noted that the RCB/M
structure currently employed at the University creates definitive boundaries that
delineate the distribution of power between units and the central administration. This
rigid and sometimes divisive framework has resulted in “decreasing cooperation
between [the central administration] and the faculties [units]” (personal
communication, February 24, 2014). Consequently, the nature of vertical interaction at
Eastern U.S. University has become adversarial in nature, with each side trying to gain
140
“the upper hand in negotiations” (personal communication, February 27, 2014). The
unclear formulaic allocation of revenues, and more recently the central administration’s
efforts to modify the existing allocation formulas to create the Strategic Initiatives Fund
have only increased the adversarial nature of vertical interactions at the University. One
informant explained the mistrust of the allocation formulas when s/he stated that “it is
not clear why they [the formulas] were developed in the way they were as they create
clear winners and losers; for instance lab based programs suffer” (personal
communication, February 26, 2014). Another informant provided support for this by
arguing that “the formulas need to be reliable for planning but they also need to be
adjusted with priorities” (personal communication, February 28, 2014).
The mistrust surrounding the allocation model at Eastern U.S. University has
been exacerbated by the prevalent belief by unit leaders that the central administration
does not communicate effectively (e.g. February 24, 2014; February 25, 2014; February
27, 2014; February 29, 2014). Where communication is present, “it has been one way;
there is a lack of transparency of process and communication from the [central
administration]” (personal communication, February 28, 2014). Generally speaking, the
informants at the university attributed the increased vertical friction to a lack of
transparency and communication (personal communication, February 25, 2014;
February 28, 2014). One informant queried, “how can we become an internationally
recognized school, attracting foreign students and researchers, if we do not have
cooperation between [the central administration] and the deans?” (personal
communication, February 26, 2014).
141
The inflexibility exhibited around budgetary allocations, the general mistrust of
the allocation process, and the lack of effective vertical communication has hampered
vertical coordination at Eastern U.S. University (personal communication, February 24,
2014). These factors, compounded by the lack of centrally help financial resources, have
resulted in an incongruent understanding of the central administration’s role at the
university. On one hand, the central administration wants more power to help direct
unit decision-making; conversely, the units want to hold onto their power, afforded
through revenue retention, as they believe that localness in decision-making will ensure
the best outcomes for themselves (personal communication, February 24, 2014). The
resulting vertical relationship at Eastern U.S. University is adversarial and pervaded by
suspicion. Eight informants, occupying unit leadership roles, suggested that increasing
the power of the central administration is not in the best interests of the units, with one
informant stating that there is “little trust in the central administration” (personal
communication, February 26, 2014). Another informant suggested that there is a
“growing feeling that the move towards more centralized power erodes the power of
the unit and puts at risk the collegial model (personal communication, February 24,
2014). Echoing this sentiment, one dean suggested that “there has been a growth of
administration at Eastern U.S. University, especially in the central administration. These
are career administrators, who are very corporate and who negatively affect the culture
of collegiality” (personal communication, February 25, 2014). The increase in corporate-
style management and the growth of administrative ranks have seeded resentment
throughout the faculty (personal communication, February 27, 2014). With increasing
142
corporatization [even if only perceived], the faculty feel that they are losing their power
to central administrators.
It is important to note that although the vertical relationship at Eastern U.S.
University is adversarial and combative, traditional collegial relationships have remained
constructive. The tension between the central administration and units centers around
the erosion of unit power and influence and less around the erosion of traditional
collegial processes within the faculty ranks.
5.4.3 - A NEW BEGINNING?
The central administration at Eastern U.S. University has acknowledged that
levels of vertical coordination must improve for the institution to meet its strategic
goals. To support this improvement, a new Provost was appointed in July 2013; she is
working actively to increase decanal participation in decision-making, creating processes
that encourage two-way communication with regards to strategy, finance, and budgets,
and to support the growth of new programs and initiatives [with seed money provided
by the Strategic Initiative Fund].
Informants identified several initiatives that have been undertaken to promote
improved vertical coordination and the repair damaged vertical relationships that exist
between unit leadership and the central administration. The development of the
Strategic Initiatives Fund was a conscious first step in transitioning from a primarily
diagnostic form of management control to an interactive and consultative model
143
(personal communication, February 28, 2014). Although there has been tension
surrounding the taxation of units to fund this initiative, it is already beginning to
accomplish its mandate and promote vertical coordination at the University. Some of
the benefits that have already been realized through the Strategic Initiatives Fund are
investment in multidisciplinary programs and capital projects, such as the new Marine
School [an interdisciplinary school that brings together faculty members from across
colleges and serves as a strategic advantage for the institution as a whole], and the
financial support of strategic initiatives, such as the STEM [Science, Technology,
Engineering and Math] initiative that has encouraged coordinated hiring practices
across faculties.
In addition to facilitating the maintenance of centrally held financial resources
there has been a conscious effort to increase in the use of soft power, communication,
and interactive collaboration to promote strategically aligned unit-level decision-
making. In order to increase coordination between units and promote transparency and
participation, the Provost is encouraging regular meetings that include all deans. The
purpose of these meetings is to engage deans in the development of a unified direction
for unit initiatives, encourage inter-unit cooperation, and introduce new strategic
initiatives (personal communication, February 28, 2014). This advisory group, the Dean’s
Collaborative Group, is designed to encourage local thinking while establishing
boundaries for unit-level decision-making that ensure alignment to the strategy of the
institution. A similar approach has been applied to the Dean’s and Provost’s Councils to
144
promote collaboration and communication (personal communication, February 24,
2014).
The necessity of increased vertical coordination has been acknowledged and the
central administration is beginning to gain the traction necessary to tactically enact
structural changes at the University (personal communication, February 24, 2014;
February 25, 2014; March 13; 2014). If Eastern U.S. University is to realize their stated
goal of becoming an internationally recognized institution, vigilance and sustained
commitment to this structural change will be essential (personal communication,
February 25, 2014). The move towards increased interactive control represents a
dramatic change in the institutional approach to governance, oversight, and
management. One informant noted that “the new provost seems to be quite inclusive
and is directing work in collaborative processes. Her intent is to have the faculties [units]
and [the central administration] working and talking together, and trying to coordinated
units to gain economies of scale and efficiency” (personal communication, February 26,
2014). The efforts of the current Provost are encouraging the establishment of vertical
trust. One central administrator noted that, with the increasing transparency, “we are
trying to build the feelings of fairness and trust” (personal communication, February 24,
2014). The consultative process that is being built between the deans, provost, and
academic senate offers the hope that there will be increased vertical coordination at
Eastern U.S. University.
145
5.4.4 - SUMMARY
The historical lack of vertical coordination at Eastern U.S. University is rooted in
the over-decentralized nature of the RCB/M structure employed by the institution.
Without the ability to provide financial incentives that align unit-level decisions with the
institution’s strategic direction, the central administration relied upon diagnostic
policies and processes to compel unit behaviour [often unsuccessfully]. RCB/M became
“a law, versus the tool it was meant to be, and has caused the central administration’s
inability to influence” (personal communication, March 13, 2014). The over
decentralization at Eastern U.S. University stemmed from the original RCB/M budget
allocation formula; the recognition and adjustment of the allocation formula imbalance
was an important first step in correcting the vertical coordination problems faced at the
University.
The low levels of vertical coordination at Eastern U.S. University have resulted in
an environment that informants identified as being restrictive. Informants noted that
the lack of vertical coordination has made it difficult to achieve strategic goals. Others
have suggested that the problems are more deeply rooted and that the lack of vertical
coordination precludes the identification and selection of meaningful strategic goals.
The general strategic goals identified by informants were the increase in
multidisciplinary programs and research, financial sustainability, and transitioning from
a regionally known institution to one that was nationally and internationally recognized.
Although there is a concrete understanding of the institution’s stated strategic goals,
the low level of lateral coordination has hindered the achievement of these goals.
146
However, Eastern U.S. University is in the process of transition. Institutional
leadership continues to champion governance control reform and the transition from a
diagnostic to a more interactive governance process that encourages cooperation,
communication, and coordination is underway. Informants [supported by the
institutional document analysis] identified changes to the RCB/M model that have been
implemented to encourage increased vertical coordination. The appointment of a new
Provost, whose mandate includes increasing collaboration and alignment throughout
the institution, represents a commitment to change by senior central leadership.
Furthermore, interdisciplinary programs and centers are being built to meet the
institutional goal of increased collaboration. Although these changes represent a
conscious step towards increased coordination, only time will reveal if they are
sustainable and if they will achieve the desired increase in vertical coordination and
institutional goal achievement.
SECTION 5.5 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
Contextual similarities were noted between Western Canadian University and
Eastern U.S. University. Analogous to Eastern U.S. University, Western Canadian
University operates an RCB/M model that is over-decentralized and lacking
transparency regarding resource allocation formulae. Additionally, the central
administration attempts to act as a resource for units but has been unable to do so, or
to provide effective oversight due to a lack of centrally held financial resources. Unlike
Eastern U.S. University [where the Provost and central administration is working to
147
improve the RCB/M model], Western Canadian University has elected to retire RCB/M
and revert back to an incremental budgeting process. The decision to return to an
incremental budgeting model was made, in part, due to the low levels of vertical
coordination present at the University. A discussion of vertical coordination at Western
Canadian University follows below.
5.5.1 - OVER-DECENTRALIZATION AND DIAGNOSTIC CONTROL
At Western Canadian University the RCB/M structure was originally designed to
drive down power and decision-making responsibility to the dean level. The rational for
this distributed power structure was to promote immediate enrollment growth [which
was a primary institutional goal at the time] and to encourage local initiatives. Under
the RCB/M system the central administration retained limited oversight power and
meager financial resources. As was noted at Eastern U.S. University, the lack of centrally
retained financial resources has resulted in the inability of the central administration to
effectively influence unit-level decision-making via the provision of financial incentives.
One informant, occupying a senior central administration role, stated that “although we
[the central administration] are responsible for the allocation of funds, we have limited
influence on how those funds are used at the unit level” (personal communication,
March 3, 2014).
The absence of centrally controlled financial resources has resulted in the
deployment of diagnostic management controls as a mechanism that attempts to shape
unit behaviour. The diagnostic approach to unit oversight has resulted in a severely
148
limited vertical communication stream; informants occupying both unit leadership and
central administrative roles identified that constructive vertical communication is
essentially absent at Western Canadian University. Vertical relationships at Western
Canadian University can be considered tense and as a consequence of the limited
vertical coordination, there is a divergence between unit-level initiatives and the
institutional strategic direction. One informant described the current vertical
relationship as an ongoing competition between the central administration and the
units, with interactions that are tit-for-tat in nature (personal communication, March 4,
2014). Institutional documents from Western Canadian University confirm the tensions
caused by the primarily diagnostic approach to management (e.g. Western Canadian
University, 2012a; Western Canadian University, 2013d). The ability to promote unit-
level decision-making that is aligned with broader institutional priorities is often absent
at Western Canadian University (Western Canadian University, 2012a); to align unit level
decision-making with institutional goals the central administration has identified that
interactive vertical communication must be increased (Western Canadian University,
2013f). It has been reported in institutional documents that individuals with “the
appropriate knowledge and expertise [need] to contribute to the decision-making
process” (Western Canadian University, 2012a, p.3). In the Western Canadian University
Comprehensive Institutional Plan 2013/14-2015/16 document, it is noted that:
Over the past several years, the University has revised its budget process to
ensure that the institution is in a position to make resource allocation decisions
that will advance the University’s strategic directions. Especially in challenging
149
financial times, we need to be able to quickly adapt to the situation without
losing sight of the priorities that have been established through out academic,
research, and strategic plans. (Western Canadian University, 2013c, p.33).
The Comprehensive Institutional Plan [2013/14-2015/16] dedicated significant
attention to the vertical tension present at the University and explicitly acknowledged
the divergence of initiatives and strategic direction due to poor vertical coordination.
This report was instrumental in the decision to revert back to an incremental budgeting
model from the RCB/M model that had been in use since 1994. Through the transition
back to an incremental budget model the central administration hopes to increase its
ability to influence and, when needed, define the direction of unit initiatives (personal
communication, March 3, 2014).
5.5.2 - THE ABSENCE OF TRANSPARENCY AND VERTICAL COMMUNICATION
Informants from Western Canadian University identified the lack of transparency
[related to resource allocation and decision-making] and effective vertical
communication as significant barriers to constructive vertical coordination. This is
echoed in the Report of the President’s Task Force on Budget Processes (2012) where it
is recognized that an increase in constructive communication, fairness, transparency,
and trust needs to be fostered to increase vertical coordination. Informants mutually
identified confusion around the RCB/M budget process. Even informants who had been
150
involved with the RCB/M process since its adoption in 1994 expressed that it is difficult
to understand how and why allocation decisions are made (Western Canadian
University 2012a).
Unlike Eastern U.S. University, Western Canadian University has experienced
decreasing transparency and vertical coordination over the past several years. Several
events have influenced this trend. In 2012 the longstanding ‘Budget Committee’, which
served in an advisory capacity to the president, was disbanded. This committee
operated interactively and had boasted significant faculty participation. Additionally, it
was instrumental in steering the University’s financial and non-academic processes; the
dismantling of this committee has resulted in a decline in the collegial governance
processes present at the University (personal communication, March 3, 2014). A second
event that has affected the level of transparency and vertical coordination was the
removal of faculty members from the Budget Advisory Board. One informant described
the new structure of the Budget Advisory Board as ‘merely a window dressing of
transparency’ (personal communication, March 6, 2014). In addition to these events,
transparency and vertical coordination are impacted by the mistrust of and secrecy
surrounding the formulae that govern the allocation of the government operating grant
[which accounts for approximately seventy [70] percent of the total operating budget].
Unlike the other universities in this study, who have published allocation formulas,
Western Canadian University relies on a series of past practice agreements to allocate
financial resources. In practical terms there is no standard allocation formula present at
Western Canadian University. The allocation practices that result from these historical
151
agreements lack transparency and predictability (personal communication, March 3,
2014). One informant questioned the validity of the allocation process when s/he stated
that “with seventy percent of the revenue from the government grant being allocated to
the units without a specific formula detailing that allocation, how am I supposed to
budget for this year let alone three or five years out?” (personal communication, March
3, 2014). The lack of clear and transparent formulas was a continual point of contention
with deans and clearly affects vertical coordination at the University (personal
communication, March 5, 2014).
The uncertainty and lack of transparency surrounding resource allocation at
Western Canadian University has fostered competition between units for resources
(personal communication, March 3, 2014). There is a perception that the relationship
between the units and the central administration is a zero-sum game (personal
communication, March 7, 2014). One informant stated that “[I] have been working with
this process for a long time and still have little understanding of the process of
prioritization of resource allocation. It is a flexible distribution of funds based on
historical ad hoc deals made between past deans and past provosts and presidents”
(personal communication, March 6, 2014). Another informant confirmed that
competition is an integral part of the budgeting strategy for units when s/he states that
“the incentive then is to grab the largest chunk you can by being strategic and building
your power” (personal communication, March 4, 2014). The lack of transparency in the
budget process was reported unanimously by informants and has resulted in “[a
152
situation where] no one can explain why units get the money they get” (personal
communication, March 6, 2014).
The lack of transparency reported at Western Canadian University has been
linked to the frequency and nature of vertical communication. One senior unit
administrator suggested that communication between the central administration and
units is often characterized by conflict, providing little substantive value for either party
(personal communication, March 3, 2014). A second informant stated that there is a
lack of communication to the units regarding the strategic goals of the institution and
this makes it difficult to encourage units to align their plans with the institutional
priorities (personal communication, March 5, 2014). Informants espoused that “it seems
that it’s a personal choice whether things are communicated” by the central
administration (personal communication, March 7, 2014). As a result of the lack of
consistent communication the central administration is perceived by many institutional
members as not being concerned with the needs of the units. There is also a belief
among unit leaders that the central administration relies on diagnostic management
techniques too frequently, resulting in oversight that is too heavy handed and that
shows a disregard for the collegial process. The central administration is viewed as
“keeping what they are doing and their decision-making close to the chest (personal
communication, March 6, 2014). Informants reported that central decision-making is
often conducted behind closed doors without consultation, resulting in a lack of
transparency (personal communication, March 3, 2014; March 5, 2014; March 6, 2014).
A number of informants openly questioned the central decision-making process, with
153
one informant asking “if you can’t trust the process and the system, how can you trust
the outcomes?” (personal communication, March 3, 2014).
At Western Canadian University, meetings between the units and the central
administration are held in camera; this practice led one associate dean to question
“what does this say symbolically? What does this say about the value of transparency?”
(personal communication, March 4, 2014). This practice may lead to a competitive
mentality between the units and the central administration, especially regarding the
budgeting process. As noted in a Western Canadian University institutional document
“accountability and transparency are critical in the budget process. Greater
transparency and accountability contribute to greater collaboration” (Western Canadian
University, 2012a; p.30). Institutional documents have noted that strong and sustained
commitment to change by both constituent groups [units and the central
administration] is needed in order for lasting reform to be achieved at the University
(Western Canadian University, 2012a). Recently, the Task Force on Budget Processes has
formally recommended that vast improvement is needed in vertical consultation
practices in order to create a participatory and consultative relationship between units
and the central administration (Western Canadian University, 2012a).
5.5.3 - THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION AS A RESOURCE FOR UNITS
Informants from all four institutions espoused the belief that the central
administration should function to support units. However, at Western Canadian
154
University there is a perceived, and real, lack of service and support provided by the
central administration. One informant suggested that this lack of support is related to
the lack of centrally controlled financial resources (personal communication, March 3,
2014). The central administration at Western Canadian University provides only limited
training and resources for units. Institutional documents and informants both
communicated the need for increased training, development, and support improve the
ability of unit leaders to understand and comment on the budget process and resulting
allocation decisions (Western Canadian University, 2012a; 2013f). When specifically
queried about the support processes provided to units by the central administration no
substantive examples were provided by informants.
5.5.4 - A LACK OF BUDGET OVERSIGHT
There is strong evidence that suggests a lack of oversight and influence over
unit-level decision-making. This finding is supported by both informants and the
institutional documents that were reviewed during the document analysis phase of this
study. The 2012 report of the University Budget Committee is especially noteworthy,
stating that the “scope of their [the central administration’s] authority and influence on
[unit] budget decisions is limited” (Western Canadian University, 2012a, p.21).
Consequently, the central administration relies on policies and procedures to encourage
adherence to the budget process. The informant reports of limited and ineffectual
vertical communication, coordination, and collaboration strongly suggests that a
diagnostic approach to governance and oversight is in use at the University.
155
5.5.5 - SUMMARY
Western Canadian University has been operating an RCB/M structure for nearly
two decades, first implementing RCB/M in 1994. Similar to Eastern U.S. University the
RCB/M model at Western Canadian University is highly decentralized. Informants
characterized this system as ‘over-decentralized’ and ineffective. Under the RCB/M
model at Western Canadian University the central administration retains extremely
limited financial resources and, as a consequence, is unable to influence unit level
decision-making in an interactive manner. Additionally, the absence of centrally held
financial resources prevents the central administration from providing support services
for units [as was noted at Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian University].
The level of vertical coordination at Western Canadian University was reported
to be low. Informants noted that there is a sustained absence of transparency at the
institution. Annual budget allocations relied on historical agreements and did not
adhere to a published formula. None of the informants interviewed [either central
administrators or unit leaders] were able to reliably predict their budget for future
budget years. This ambiguity of process has resulted in pervasive mistrust and sustained
conflict between the central administration and the units.
The absence of financial resources available to the central administration and
the longstanding mistrust of process have resulted in the central administration
becoming reliant upon diagnostic policies and processes to compel aligned unit
behaviour [often unsuccessfully]. Institutional documents, central administrators and
unit leaders have explicitly recognized that the current RCB/M model at Western
156
Canadian University is not working to promote vertical coordination but rather acts to
encourage vertical competition and misalignment, hindering the achievement of
institutional goals. To address this disconnect, Western Canadian University
commissioned the President’s Task Force in 2012 to seek solutions to these issues. The
result has been an abandonment of the RCB/M model and the implementation of an
incremental budgeting process that went live on April 1, 2014.
SECTION 5.6 - PROPOSITIONS ON VERTICAL COORDINATION
Vertical coordination provides a measure to evaluate the presence and degree of
alignment, cooperation, and coordination between the central administration and the
operational units of an institution. In this research, vertical coordination has been
evaluated by considering the degree of cooperation and coordination, or competition
and conflict, present at each of the four universities between the central administration
and units.
Drawing upon the data presented in this chapter, five matrices have been
developed to illustrate the level of vertical coordination at each of the universities.
Vertical coordination has been evaluated in relation to the four propositions, each of
which will be discussed individually.
157
5.6.1 – PROPOSITION ONE
Proposition one focuses on the relationship between the central administration
and units. This relationship is defined by the institutional approach to governance,
oversight, and the management of units. Proposition one reads: HEIs that employ an
interactive control form of governance that allows unit autonomy and ensures central
level oversight and influence will experience increased vertical coordination as a result of
the alignment between unit decisions and the institutions’ mission and strategic goals.
Through this research, two additional factors have been identified as important in
shaping the vertical relationship between the central administration and the units: 1.
the degree of decentralization present in the RCB/M structure employed; and 2. the
amount of discretionary financial resources held by the central administration for use in
strategic initiatives and for providing incentives that encourages the alignment of unit
behaviour with the strategic goals and mission of the institution.
Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian University employ governance
control forms that are primarily interactive in nature. At both of these institutions,
informants reported high levels of vertical coordination. Interactions between the
central administration and units were for the most part based on communication,
collaboration and transparency. The maintenance of centrally held financial resources
and the use of an interactive governance control forms allow the central administration
at Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian University to provide effective
oversight and influence for unit decision-making.
158
As reported above, Eastern U.S. University is currently in a state of transition.
Presently the central administration employs a primarily diagnostic form of governance.
Consequently, the levels of vertical coordination reported by informants can be
categorized as low. In recognition of this the university is in the process of implementing
an interactive form of governance with the expectation that this will increase levels of
vertical coordination. Based on informant responses there is some evidence that vertical
coordination and communication are increasing. Currently, the data suggests that the
central administration at Eastern U.S. University possesses low levels of influence and
oversight over unit-level decision-making; however, it is expected that this will improve
with the transition to more interactive governance methods.
Western Canadian University currently experiences low levels of vertical
coordination due to the lack of centrally held financial resources and issues surrounding
transparency and trust. As such, a diagnostic governance control form is employed by
the central administration in an attempt to align unit-level decision-making with
institutional goals. Presently, the central administration is limited in their ability to
provide oversight and influence for unit-level decision-making. It remains unclear how
the decision to abandon RCB/M in favour of an incremental budgeting model will affect
levels of vertical coordination at the University.
159
Table 5: Governance Control Form and Corresponding Levels of Vertical Coordination
Low Vertical Coordination High Vertical Coordination
Diagnostic Control Form Governance Structure
Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University [current state]
Interactive Control Form Governance Structure
Eastern U.S. University
[future state?]
Hybrid Control Form Governance Structure
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
Table 6: Oversight and Influence of Decision-making and Governance Control Form
Central Administration Oversight and Influence
Diagnostic Governance Form Interactive Governance Form
Low levels of oversight and influence over unit decision-making
Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
High levels of oversight and influence over unit decision-making
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
5.6.2 – PROPOSITION THREE
Proposition three focuses on the relationship between vertical coordination and the
achievement of organizational goals. The assumption present in the literature is that
high levels of vertical coordination will result in a high degree of strategic goal
achievement (Crotts, Dickson, & Ford, 2005; Hides, Davies, & Jackson, 2004; Kretschmer
& Puranam, 2008; Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967; Miles & Snow, 1984; Taylor, 2000); for this
reason vertical coordination is believed to align unit goals and behavior with the
160
institution’s strategic goals. Proposition three reads: High levels vertical coordination
will encourage the achievement of the HEI’s organizational goals.
At Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian University informants identified
a high degree of goal achievement that was due, in part, to the high levels of vertical
coordination. At both institutions there was congruence between the general
institutional goals identified by informants and the stated institutional goals, as
published in institutional documents. This congruence was also detected in the
decisions and actions of the units. At both institutions it was noted that processes are
present to encourage transparency and open communication between units and the
central administration. These processes have promoted coordination, efficiencies, and
common institutional languages, which help encourage financially responsible decision-
making that is aligned with the academic mission of the institutions. Finally, the
promotion of interactive decision-making at both institutions engages faculty, and
encourages coordination and communication promoting the integrity of the collegial
culture of the institutions.
At Eastern U.S. University and Western Canadian University, informants
suggested that low levels of vertical coordination [especially the lack of transparency
and communication] encouraged units to focus on their own goals rather than acting in
the interest of the universities. The data collected at both of these institutions suggests
that tension between units and the central administration, coupled with the lack of
coordination has hindered the achievement of institutional goals.
161
Table 7: Levels of Vertical Coordination and Organizational Goal Achievement
Vertical Coordination Levels of Reported Organizational Goal Achievement
Low High
Low Level Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
High Level Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
5.6.3 – PROPOSITION FIVE
Proposition five considers the relationship between financial incentives and the
levels of vertical and lateral coordination present in institutions. The RCB/M literature
argues that there are two categories of incentives for units: 1. the reduction of costs;
and 2. the encouragement of revenue-seeking behaviour (Lang, 1999; Strauss & Curry,
2002; Strauss, Curry, Whalen, 1996; Whalen, 1991). This proposition tests the predictive
power of the RCB/M literature and examines whether the unit behaviour patterns
expected under the RCB/M model are occurring [i.e. strong incentives for both cost-
reduction and revenue-seeking behaviour]. Proposition five reads: If the incentive for
revenue-seeking behaviour is stronger than the incentive [or ability] to reduce costs,
units will exhibit lower levels of vertical and lateral coordination.
Although the incentives for revenue-seeking behaviour at Midwestern U.S.
University and Central Canadian University were reported to be stronger than those for
the minimization of costs, there was no evidence that this negatively affected the level
of vertical coordination present at the University. It should be noted that revenue-
seeking behaviour was reported to have caused issues, on the margin, with regard to
service teaching and the duplication of courses.
162
At Eastern U.S. University, the low level of vertical coordination appears to be
the result of the highly decentralized RCB/M model in use and that revenue-seeking
incentives act to exacerbate, not moderate, the low levels of vertical coordination that
already exist at the university. Likewise, the incentives for revenue-seeking behavior
were stronger than those for the minimization of costs at Western Canadian University.
However, at Western Canadian University, the lack of transparency surrounding the
budget model underlies the low levels of coordination.
Table 8: Vertical Coordination, and Cost and Revenue Incentives
Dominant Incentive Low Levels of Vertical
Coordination High Levels of Vertical
Coordination
Cost Minimization
Revenue Seeking Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
5.6.4 – PROPOSITION TEN
Proposition ten focuses on the relationship between vertical coordination and
organizational effectiveness. The value that universities produce is not easily measured
and often lies in the achievement of social purposes (Moore, 2000). Unlike for-profit
firms, the maximization of profit and creation of wealth for shareholders are not
measures of goal and mission achievement for HEIs (Cameron, 1978); in consideration
of this, measurements of goal and mission achievement specific to HEIs must be applied.
In this research, institutional goal achievement is used as a proxy for the measurement
of organizational effectiveness. Proposition ten reads: Interactive control systems will
encourage institutional goal achievement at HEIs that have implemented RCB/M.
163
Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian University both employ hybrid
governance control forms that are primarily interactive in practice. Support for
proposition ten was noted at both universities [see Appendix 16 and Appendix 17].
Unfortunately some data was not available [e.g. placement of graduate students] and
other areas were inconclusive based on the current data set.
164
CHAPTER SIX
LATERAL COORDINATION
SECTION 6.1 - INTRODUCTION
This chapter provides a presentation and discussion of the data and resultant
findings pertaining to lateral coordination. Lateral coordination provides a concept to
evaluate the presence and degree of inter-unit alignment, cooperation, and
coordination present within an organization. Lateral coordination is evaluated by
considering the degree of cooperation and coordination, or competition and conflict
present between units. As discussed previously in Chapter Three, the level of
cooperation and coordination will have significant impact on a variety of matters in
universities, including: 1. inter-unit initiatives and agreements; 2. inter-unit competition;
3. perceptions of transparency, fairness and trust; and 4. operational efficiency.
A discussion of the essential features that impact lateral coordination
[coordination between units] at each of the four universities is presented, highlighting
the experiences and outcomes, as reported by the informants and supported by the
document analysis, with respect to the levels of cooperation and coordination between
the units of the universities. Interviews with informants revealed shared experiences
and provided reinforcement of general themes. In this chapter the common themes are
presented along with a case study of each institution. A distinct discussion of each
institution will be provided, followed by a discussion of the three propositions relating
to lateral coordination.
165
SECTION 6.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
Informants identified four thematic areas that relate to and impact the amount
of lateral coordination present between units at Midwestern U.S. University: 1. the role
of the central administration; 2. interdisciplinary programs and research initiatives; 3.
the impact of the RCB/M; and 4. inter-unit communication. At Midwestern U.S.
University, a high level of lateral coordination, in the form of inter-unit cooperation and
interdisciplinary programs, was detected. A more in-depth exploration of the lateral
coordination present at the University will be discussed below.
6.2.1 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION
Lateral coordination is affected by the selection and application of governance
control forms and oversight processes which have a material impact on the cooperation,
coordination, and collaboration that occurs between units. At Midwestern U.S.
University informants identified both formal and informal processes that encourage
lateral coordination. Elgass notes that a good budget system will:
…make obvious how one's self-interest as a faculty member or student is fed by
taking part vigorously in the life of the campus and of our broader community of
scholarly activity. A bad budget system will narrow the arenas of our
participation by encumbering our efforts to take part in such a way as to drain
the motivation and fool us into questing after only the tangible rewards,
separate of the opportunities for intellectual and social life.” (Elgass, 1995, p.2)
166
The literature has widely acknowledged that RCB/M can encourage fragmentation of
the University. At Midwestern U.S. University, the central administration has taken a
leadership role in removing barriers and promoting lateral coordination through both
formal and informal channels; “we will do what needs to be done to assure that the
budget system’s automatic incentives in opposition to collaborative work are countered,
in both research and teaching, and to assure that the location of these collaborations be
dictated by the intellectual merits, not by automatic rules regarding who gets financial
credit” (Cantor & Courant, 1997, p.13).
Informants noted the importance of formal processes and programs in
promoting lateral coordination at the University. The revenue-sharing program is one
example of a formal program that promotes collaboration and inter-unit coordination at
Midwestern U.S. University. This program provides centrally disbursed revenue for
initiatives that operate collaboratively across multiple units. The revenue-sharing
program has increased unit prosperity and growth by connecting units and promoting
lateral coordination (personal communication, February 17, 2014). Inter-unit programs
are integral to Midwestern U.S. University’s value proposition; they help the University’s
program rankings and are a fundamental component of institutional strategy (personal
communication, March 11, 2014). Formal initiatives, such as the revenue-sharing
program, provide financial incentives for units to act in a laterally coordinated manner
(personal communication, February 21, 2014).
167
Another avenue that promotes lateral coordination at Midwestern U.S.
University is the presence of formal processes that bring unit leaders together for
regular communication and consultation. Informants identified the variety of meetings,
committees, working lunches, and workshops as helping to develop and strengthen lines
of communication between unit leaders that can be leveraged informally to promote
lateral coordination (personal communication, February 18, 2014; February 19, 2014;
February 20, 2014). One dean noted that, “we have a large number of University
conferences and specialized services meant to bring together staff and faculty to
promote cooperation, coordination, information sharing and relationship building.”
(personal communication, February 20). One example of this is coordinated by the
Provost and Chief Financial Officer who jointly host monthly meetings for senior unit
leaders. At these meetings best practices and common administrative problems are
collaboratively discussed and unit leaders are encouraged to establish specialized
groups that meet for inter-unit topical information-sharing and problem-solving
(personal communication, February 19, 2014). These specialized groups gather around
functional areas and include groups of human resources professionals or budget
officers, as an example; they meet independently from the central administration and
work to foster coordination between units.
The final program that was noted by informants as increasing lateral
coordination is the Cluster Hires program, which was developed by the Provost with the
explicit goal of increasing cooperation between units. Under the Cluster Hires program,
multiple units coordinate to hire faculty that can work across traditional disciplinary
168
boundaries and teach across units. The incentive for units to participate in this program
is that the Provost’s office offsets a portion of the faculty’s salary. Informants noted that
this program has helped to increase cooperation and coordination among units
(personal communication, February 19, 2014).
In addition to developing programs that promote lateral coordination directly,
informants noted that the Provost consciously implements programs to counteract the
incentives for competition that are inherent under an RCB/M system. One informant
noted that “the Provost tries to ensure that the budget model does not impact
cooperation and coordination between units. She has created a number of processes to
ensure we [units] are able to work together without being financially disadvantaged.”
(personal communication, February 20, 2014). There is an explicit recognition that
preventative measures need to be in place “to assure that the location of collaborations
be dictated by the intellectual merits, not by automatic rules regarding who gets
financial credit for what” (Cantor & Courant, 1997, p.13).
6.2.2 - INTERDISCIPLINARY PROGRAMS AND RESEARCH INITIATIVES
Informants from Midwestern U.S. University unanimously praised the Graduate
School as promoting lateral coordination between units. The Graduate School serves as
the single entity at Western U.S. University that is responsible for “acting as a resource
to help units provide interdisciplinary graduate programs” (personal communication,
169
February 18, 2014). The Graduate School provides tangible resources for units6 with the
mandate of promoting inter-unit participation in interdisciplinary programs and studies
at the graduate level; for units that participate “this often leads to networking
opportunities for faculty and an increase in interdisciplinary research” (personal
communication, February 18, 2014). By acting as a facilitator and mediator “the
Graduate School has helped us cut through the red tape and provide an increased
offering of programs for our graduate students” (personal communication, February 21,
2014). One informant noted that the “central administration has provided a great deal
of resources to support the Graduate School, as they see the graduate student as a
vector to facilitate cooperation between units” (personal communication, February 19,
2014). The Provost’s office works closely with the Graduate School to remove barriers to
collaboration between units and ensure the opportunity for growth in graduate
programs (personal communication, February 19, 2014).
The interdisciplinary programs and research that are facilitated by the Graduate
School represent a challenging undertaking. Each unit that is involved with the school
comes to the table with different budgeting, revenue, and management approaches
(personal communication, February 17, 2014). One dean stated that “it’s the central
administration’s job to remove barriers to cross-unit degrees and appointments and
they have done a respectable job through the Graduate School.” (personal
communication, March 11, 2014). Before the Graduate School, faculty reported that
6 These resources include financial, oversight and direction, records, and academic policies (personal
communication, February 20, 2014).
170
they would avoid inter-unit activities because the negotiation costs were prohibitively
high (Cantor & Courant, 1997).
In addition to the coordination efforts of the Graduate School, Midwestern U.S.
University provides support for inter-unit research activities. To support an inter-unit
approach to global research a $50 million one-time fund was set up (personal
communication, February 20, 2014). Out of this fund, monies have been provided to
support the hiring of 100 faculty members, over five years, in areas that advance
interdisciplinary teaching and research (personal communication, February 18, 2014).
The goal of this initiative is to produce world-class research, leading to opportunities for
students, and increased coordination between units (personal communication, February
19, 2014). One informant noted that “there is a culture [at Midwestern U.S. University]
to produce world-class research and this often takes an interdisciplinary approach so we
are excited about the opportunity to continue this tradition.” (personal communication,
February 21, 2014).
6.2.3 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M
It is well documented in the literature that RCB/M can negatively impact the
levels of cooperation and coordination between units. Informants from Midwestern U.S.
University identified a number of potentially negative impacts resulting from the use of
RCB/M which are corroborated by the institutional documents from the University (e.g.
Cantor & Courant, 1997; Courant & Knepp, 2002). One example of the negative and
171
unintended effects of RCB/M is manifested in the duplication of services and offerings
[often initiated to maximize revenue] (person communication, February 17, 2014). At
Midwestern U.S. University this phenomena was cited by informants as one of the most
salient challenges posed by RCB/M; however, due to a variety of central administrative
processes and the ongoing encouragement of lateral coordination, it is seen only “on
the margins and without material effect on revenues” (personal communication, March
11, 2014).
Although RCB/M can create barriers to lateral coordination, the central
administration at Midwestern U.S. University works to break down these barriers
(personal communication, February 20, 2014). To this end, one dean stated that “I can
understand how competition could occur under the budget model; however, there are a
great number of incentives to help release this tension.” (personal communication,
February 20, 2014). One informant noted that RCB/M can create competition and
friction, both vertically and laterally, resulting in winners and losers (personal
communication, February 17, 2014). However, another informant noted that:
“Midwestern is a world-class institution and we don’t have to fight over marginal
students. There are extremely high demands for all of our programs and as such
there is little competition for individual students. There is a cultural imperative
here and that is excellence and cooperation. We must be strong together
because the only way to be excellent is at the institutional level. Competition
172
only harms other units and the institution.” (personal communication, March 11,
2014).
At Midwestern U.S. University the central administration provides incentives
that serve to release inter-unit tensions. Informants specifically identified the difficulties
related to the logistics of service teaching7. Historically, under the Value Center
Management model [the original RCB/M model employed by Midwestern U.S.
University], service teaching presented an accounting challenge that units overcame
through the duplication of courses. Course duplication was initially encouraged because,
due to the mechanics of tuition flow, the budget model created disincentives for
cooperation (personal communication, February 17, 2014). However, under the
University Budget Model and System, and with support from the Provost’s office and
the Rackham Graduate School, many of the challenges surrounding service teaching
have been mitigated. One informant stated that “the challenges to service teaching are
certainly on our radar, however the outcomes are not material and there seems to be a
great deal of cooperation between units to work things out.” (personal communication,
February 21, 2014).
7 Service teaching refers to one unit teaching a student, or students, from a different unit.
173
6.2.4 - INTER-UNIT COMMUNICATION
The final thematic area that informants identified as being related to lateral
coordination at Midwestern U.S. University was inter-unit communication. Although
RCB/M budget models “naturally hinder cooperation between units, the expectation of
collegiality and relationships built through formal and informal processes [at
Midwestern U.S. University has] helped us to overcome that challenge” (personal
communication, February 19, 2014). One informant noted that, although there are
formal processes in place to encourage lateral coordination it was “the strong culture of
collegiality [that] has promoted the communication, cooperation and collaboration
[between units]” (personal communication, February 21, 2014).
Informants spoke in detail about the benefit of effective inter-unit
communication and noted that strong inter-unit communication practices have helped
units identify opportunities and efficiencies (personal communication, February 17).
One informant stated that inter-unit communication “has led to the identification of
opportunities for program growth and new program start-up. This has resulted in an
increase in revenues for our unit” (personal communication, February 18, 2014). A
second informant suggested that inter-unit communication has helped her/his unit
identify opportunities that include an expanded range of course offerings for both
graduate and undergraduate students (personal communication, February 19, 2014).
174
6.2.5 - SUMMARY
In the years since Midwestern U.S. University first implemented an RCB/M
system, it has experienced substantial challenges regarding lateral coordination.
However, through numerous reviews and several major revisions the RCB/M model has
been improved to support lateral coordination and communication. As a part of the
transition to the University Budget Model and System, a variety of formal processes
were implemented by the central administration; these processes have been found to
encourage communication, cooperation, and collaboration between units. The
interactive approach employed by the central administration has provided for the
identification of opportunities to develop new programs, encourage interdisciplinary
research, seek cost savings, and increase operational efficiencies.
SECTION 6.3 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
Informants spoke extensively about the level of lateral coordination present at
Central Canadian University. Three thematic areas were identified as being particularly
influential at the University, including: 1. the role of the central administration; 2. the
impact of RCB/M; and 3. inter-unit communication. An in-depth discussion of lateral
coordination at Central Canadian University follows below.
6.3.1 - THE ROLE OF THE CENTRAL ADMINISTRATION
The central administration at Central Canadian University employs a hybrid
governance form that blends interactive and diagnostic management strategies to
175
promote lateral coordination between units. Under the New Budget Model [the RCB/M
structure employed by Central Canadian University] the assignment of revenues and
costs is done in “a fashion that encourages and supports interdivisional activity at all
levels of teaching and research rather than reinforcing the creation and maintenance of
a series of isolated academic units” (Central Canadian University, 2011a, p.8) while still
allowing for decentralized, unit-centered decision-making. The New Budget Model
recognizes the importance of collaboration and inter-unit activities while also
acknowledging the challenges presented by inter-unit or service teaching (Central
Canadian University, 2012b). The New Budget Model is a ‘hub-and-spoke’ design that
allows the central administration to facilitate support for lateral coordination. The ‘hub-
and-spoke” model was selected with the goal of improving inter-unit cooperation and
collaboration at the University (personal communication, March 26, 2014).
At Central Canadian University the central administration provides support for
inter-unit agreements by working to maintain fairness in lateral interactions (Central
Canadian University, 2012b). The perception of fairnes has allowed a foundation of trust
to be built and confidence in the procedural justice of lateral initiatives. As a
consiquence of this long term commitment to lateral equity, it has been possible to
establish an institutional expectation of cooperation and collaboration (personal
communication, March 27, 2014). Informants noted that the central administration
promotes lateral coordination by mediating lateral interactions, removing barriers that
hinder inter-unit programs and teaching, and promoting cross appointments and
entrepreneurial activities between units (personal communication, April 2, 2014). To
176
encourage and facilitate service teaching, the Provost’s office provides direction and
seeks to limit the duplication of courses (personal communication, April 2, 2014).
Presently the Provost’s office is working as an intermediary between the School of
Engineering and the Faculty of Arts and Science to release tensions surrounding course
duplication (personal communication, April 3, 2014). Informants noted that this type of
competition is rare and only occurs at the margins (personal communication, March 27,
2014).
As was noted at Midwestern U.S. University, the central administration at
Central Canadian University provides a variety of support programs for units and formal
processes that promote lateral coordination. A variety of meetings, committees and
working groups provide consistent opportunities for unit leaders to discuss common
issues and develop lateral relationships that can be leveraged in the future. Informants
reported that the central administration actively encourages communication,
cooperation, and coordination between units (personal communication, March 25,
2014). A second informant provided support for this sentiment when s/he stated that
“because of all the meetings and information sessions [provided by the central
administration], each unit has a relatively holistic understanding of the people and
processes external to their faculty [unit]” (personal communication, April 3, 2014).
In addition to broadly promoting lateral coordination at Central Canadian
University, the central administration has recognized the importance of interdisciplinary
study and provides financial support for inter-unit activities that allow students to take
177
courses across the University (personal communication, April 3, 2014). The central
administration has been instrumental in removing structural barriers to interdisciplinary
study and research. Inter-unit cooperation and interdisciplinary initiatives were noted
by informants as being a significant strength for the University that provide substantial
value for students (personal communication, April 2, 2014). Informants viewed inter-
unit activities as being possible, even in the face of increased costs [service teaching] or
lost revenue [students taking courses at other units], because the central administration
provides support, through revenue sharing, that renders these costs as immaterial to
unit operations. Many of the informants commented that interdisciplinary study options
provide value and flexibility for students, and consequently are used as a recruiting tool
to attract top tier applicants.
At Central Canadian University a culture of collegiality was observed; this has
resulted in a willingness to act in an interdisciplinary manner, even if a unit finds itself in
deficit as a result. One informant suggested that cooperation and coordination are
foundational to the institutional culture at Central Canadian University; another
informant noted that due to the culture of collegiality at the University, the bottom-line
thinking promoted by RCB/M is moderated and usually aligned with the academic
mission (personal communication, March 25, 2014).
6.3.2 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M
By nature RCB/M encourages units to act in a self-interested manner to
maximize revenues and minimizes expenses. However, RCB/M also provides a language
178
that can enable coordination between units. At Central Canadian University “the
language [of RCB/M] has allowed for clear communication between units, using the
same language we are able to come together and identify threats and opportunities”
(personal communication, March 25, 2014). One informant suggested that this
language allows for lateral coordination and cooperation between units [eg. service
teaching, cross faculty appointments, and inter-unit programs] that was not previously
possible (personal communication, April 2, 2014). One example of this coordinating
power at the Central Canadian University is the ability to bring units together to
negotiate service teaching fees. Without the common language provided by RCB/M it
would be difficult to find a ‘win-win’ outcome (personal communications, March 27,
2014).
Beyond providing a common language for inter-unit communication, the
structure and reporting requirements of RCB/M have created a level of transparency in
the resource allocation process that was not present or possible before RCB/M.
Informants reported that this has led to increased trust in the budgeting model and has
allowed lateral negotiations to take place in good faith (personal communication, March
27, 2014).
6.3.3 - INTER-UNIT COMMUNICATION
Inter-unit communication was highlighted by informants as being critical to
lateral coordination at Central Canadian University; this is particularly significant
because no question pertaining to this subject was posed to the informants. From the
179
interview data gathered at Central Canadian University it is clear that inter-unit
communication has a material impact on both lateral and vertical relationships.
Informants brought forward a number of specific examples of inter-unit communication
that takes place at Central Canadian University.
The first example of inter-unit communication at Central Canadian University
centers is on the budget review process. One informant noted that the budget review
process is based on participatory decision-making and open budget discussions that
take place in a series of meetings that include all deans of the University (personal
communication, April 3, 2014). Informants viewed this process as helping to provide
transparency, and promoting open lateral communication channels that did not exist
prior the implementation of the New Budget Model (personal communication, April 3,
2014).
The second example relates to the open and recurring nature of discussions and
consultations that occur between units (personal communication, March 26, 2014). The
culture of collegiality at Central Canadian University works to encourage transparency in
lateral communication; the result has been the identification and realization of
efficiencies relating to enrollment growth and space utilization (personal
communication, April 2, 2014). One informant suggested that this inter-unit
communication and collaboration should not be surprising as “the norm and cultural
expectation of collegiality, due in part to the unicameral governance structure which
although cumbersome due to its inclusive nature, demands consultation. This process is,
180
in part, responsible for the encouragement of inter-unit communication and
cooperation.” (personal communication, March 25, 2014).
6.3.4 - SUMMARY
As discussed in Chapter Five, Central Canadian University employs a hybrid
governance form that relies primarily on interactive management practices. The use of a
hybrid governance control form has resulted in the encouragement of ongoing lateral
coordination and inter-unit communication. Lateral coordination is fostered by the
central administration through the presence of meetings and committees that bring
units together and promote inter-unit collaboration. The central administration utilizes
formal processes to provide a wide range of financial, budgetary, and administrative
expertise to units. Informants widely reported that these formal processes encourage
lateral coordination and are instrumental in breaking down barriers to inter-unit
activities. Through the use of a hybrid governance form the central administration is
able to counteract the fragmentation induced by RCB/M and works to support the
culture of collegiality that has become an expectation at the Central Canadian
University. Although some tension and competition between units is still present, this
hybrid governance structure facilitates high levels of lateral coordination at the
institution.
181
SECTION 6.4 - EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
The data collected at Eastern U.S. University illustrates an environment of lateral
coordination that differs markedly from the observations at Midwestern U.S. University
and Central Canadian University. Several issues that have been identified in the
literature as problematic results of RCB/M were noted to be occurring at Eastern U.S.
University [e.g. internal competition, low levels of communication and cooperation, and
negative impacts on interdisciplinary programs]. Informants expressed frustration when
discussing past and current levels lateral coordination. However, when speaking about
future prospects for improved lateral coordination informants were more positive,
although reserved. Five main thematic areas relating to lateral coordination were
identified by informants: 1. processes that encourage coordination; 2. inter-unit
programs; 3. the impact of RCB/M; 4. the austerity narrative; and 5. a new direction. A
more detailed discussion of lateral coordination at Eastern U.S. University follows
below.
6.4.1 - PROCESSES THAT ENCOURAGE COORDINATION
Historically, the central administration at Eastern U.S. University has been unable
to counteract the negative effects that have resulted from the highly decentralized
nature of the RCB/M model employed at the university. This inability to take corrective
action can be linked to the absence of centrally held financial resources. Consequently,
the central administration has been unable to provide programs that support lateral
coordination, inter-unit communication and cooperation (personal communication,
182
February 24, 2014). One informant argued that “the lack of financial resources held by
the central administration makes it difficult to help struggling programs or to encourage
cooperation” (personal communication, February 27, 2014). Another informant noted
that historically, the central administration “did little to encourage coordination
between the colleges [units]” (personal communication, February 25, 2014). More
recently, the central administration has gained the financial resources necessary to
implement programs that support lateral coordination. One informant suggested that
“currently we are seeing a large increase in collaboration efforts. We’ve seen the
creation of a teaching and learning group and the promotion of interdisciplinary schools
and appointments.” These programs are being developed to coordinate revenue
sharing, decrease competition for students, and abolish the duplication of classes and
programs (personal communication, February 26, 2014).
One centrally supported initiative that promotes lateral coordination is cluster
hiring, which encourages two of more units to hire faculty that can teach at the
intersection of traditional knowledge areas (personal communication, February 22,
2014). This initiative is intended to make the hiring process more strategic by increasing
lateral communication. Unlike the cluster hiring program that is present at Midwestern
U.S. University, Eastern U.S. University has been unable to provide any significant
funding for this program. As a consequence this initiative has drawn concern from units
that their already tight budgets will be negatively impacted (personal communication,
February 24, 2014; February 26, 2014; February 27, 2014, March 13, 2014). Some
informants were concerned that the cluster hire initiative would result in students
183
taking more classes outside of the unit, resulting in payments from the unit of
enrollment to the unit of instruction; because Eastern U.S. University is a tuition driven
institution, a shift in enrollment patterns could materially affect unit revenue.
Recognizing the concern surrounding the financial implications of the cluster
hiring initiative the central administration has attempted to provide seed money to
encourage the development of interdisciplinary research (personal communication,
February 28, 2014). This financial support was intended to bypass the negotiation
process that has traditionally existed between units at Eastern U. S. University, and to
encourage unit participation (personal communication, February 24, 2014). One
example of this central support for lateral coordination can be seen in the
interdisciplinary STEM research initiative. The central administration has provided
funding through the Emerging Technology Center, the STEM Discovery Laboratory, and
the School of Marine Science and Ocean Engineering; these initiatives have garnered
support from over forty faculty members representing a wide variety of academic units.
The interdisciplinary work undertaken by these faculty members covers thirty-nine
research areas, and five core undergraduate and four core graduate program streams
(personal communication, February 25, 2014).
The recent focus on increasing lateral coordination is funded, in part, by the
Strategic Initiatives Fund that was discussed in Chapter Five (personal communication,
February 24, 2014; Huddleston, 2013). The focus on an inter-unit approach is a response
to the acknowledgement that the central administration needs to play a key role in
184
creating an environment favourable to lateral coordination (personal communication,
February 26; March 13). The efforts of the central administration to reform the RCB/M
structure and encourage lateral coordination between units have resulted in the
creation of three new inter-unit programs: 1. the analytics program, which provides rich,
relevant data to aid in unit decision-making; 2. the School of Marine Science and Ocean
Engineering, which represents the joint efforts of multiple schools and colleges within
the University8; and 3. an interdisciplinary graduate program being developed between
the School of Business and School of Law that will provide students with instruction that
spans across traditional knowledge areas. Informants noted that these programs have
been made possible, in part, by the recent changes to the RCB/M model. These changes
have made the aggregation of centrally held financial resources possible and have
allowed the central administration to influence unit decision-making and promote
lateral coordination (personal communication, February 26, 2014). These new
initiatives are intended to expand the growth opportunities for all units and are
expected to increase the recruitment of international students and scholars and help
the University meet its goal of becoming an internationally recognized institution
(Huddleston, 2010).
8 The School of Marine Science and Ocean Engineering represents a partnership between the Graduate School, the College of Engineering and Physical Sciences, the College of Life Sciences and Agriculture, the College of Applied Science, and the College of Liberal Arts.
185
6.4.2 - INTER-UNIT PROGRAMS
It was widely acknowledged by informants that the RCB/M model at Eastern U.S.
University had a chilling effect on cooperation and collaboration between units.
Informants identified interdisciplinary programs and research as being particularly hard
hit by the transition. During the 2010 review of the budget model it was acknowledged
that disincentives for interdisciplinary activities need to be removed (Eastern U.S.
University, 2011); institutional documents note that Eastern U.S. University needs to
embrace interdisciplinary programs and research as a vehicle to redefine institutional
culture of the university to be more collaborative (Huddleston, 2009). Additionally, the
need to realign the budget model and budget priorities to support the broader
academic mission of the institution is a priority for the University. Informants reported
that there are often structural budget impediments that result in a culture of lateral
isolation and diminishes collaboration across the University.
To combat the isolation of units, Eastern U.S. University has elected to focus on
fostering inter-unit programs and research. Informants noted that these initiatives are
viewed as the most effective way of increase lateral coordination (personal
communication, February 24; March 13, 2014). Additionally, the predicted growth in
enrollment and revenue are expected to help decrease the amount of inter-unit
competition for students (personal communication, February 28, 2014). One informant
stated that “some units use interdisciplinary programs the put bums in seats and
increase their revenue. With an increase in enrollment this may result in a net gain for
all units involved.” (personal communication, February 25, 2014). At Eastern U.S.
186
University, interdisciplinary research is a popular concept among faculty because it is
viewed as helping to promote research [which is an explicitly stated, faculty lead,
institutional goal] (personal communication, February 24, 2014).
6.4.3 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M
The introduction of RCB/M at Eastern U.S. University created clear boundaries
between units and increased fragmentation at the institution. One informant proposed
that RCB/M strengthens the fragmented nature of the university and helps to reinforce
the silos that each unit operates in (personal communication, February 27, 2014).
Another informant suggested that “many faculty find RCB/M to be too constrictive and
lacking any incentives for cooperation” (personal communication, February, 24, 2014).
Because the revenue allocation at Eastern U.S. University is tuition driven many
informants felt that RCB/M constrains choices. One dean described RCB/M as requiring
“focus on the bottom line. We just can’t look beyond that and neither can many of the
other deans.” (personal communication, February 25, 2014). The result of RCB/M at
Eastern U.S. University has been decreased lateral coordination and lateral relationships
that “at times create an us versus them mindset.” (personal communication, February
26, 2014). Another informant suggested that RCB/M seems to create a quid pro quo
relationship between the units (personal communication, February 24, 2014).
At Eastern U.S. University competition for students [and by extension revenue]
has resulted in decreased lateral coordination. One informant identified “discovery
187
courses”9 as an area where competition for students is problematic (personal
communication, February 26, 2014). Informants hailing from four different units noted
that discovery courses are often over-subscribed and voiced concern about the central
administrations seeming lack of power with regard to enforcing course capacity rules.
Over-subscription of discovery courses creates a clear set of financial winners and
losers. The result has been increased internal competition for students.
In addition to competition for students, the language of RCB/M has exacerbated
the already contentious conversations that occur between units. With what has been
described as “a zero sum game”, conversations surrounding students, facilities, services,
and space can become hostile (personal communication, February 27, 2014). One
informant stated that “we’ve seen a competition for students, facilities, and space
caused by our budget model” (personal communication, February 24, 2014). A second
informant suggested that “there is no doubt that RCB/M has created competition and
conflicts between colleges.” (personal communication, February 25, 2014). The
language of profit, loss, and cost has promoted competition between units at the
University (personal communication, February 27, 2014).
The need to respond, at an institutional level, to the competition encouraged by
RCB/M has been put forward in multiple institutional budget reviews. The institution
9 Discovery courses are core curriculum courses that are mandated by the University as a requirement for
graduation. Discovery courses provide the intellectual framework for students in all majors. All students are required to take one discovery course from each of the following categories: Biological Science; Physical Science; Environment, Technology and Society; Fine Arts; Historical Perspectives; Humanities; Social Sciences; World Cultures.
188
needs to re-align incentives for revenue growth without encouraging internal
competition (Eastern U.S. University, 2011). The central administration must have the
power and influence to stop the manipulation of the credit hour system to ‘generate’
additional revenue [e.g. through increasing the number of required courses taken within
the student’s home unit] (Proulx, 2004). One area that has received specific attention in
this regard is service teaching. Under the RCB/M system employed at Eastern U.S.
University, service teaching has presented a challenge, which some departments
overcoming by not “allowing their students to take courses at other units” (personal
communication, February 24, 2014). One informant suggested that they find it almost
impossible to bring in instructors from outside the unit to teach courses due to the
negotiation time and resulting costs (personal communication, February 26, 2014). A
second informant echoed this frustration, stating “we’ve given up on service teaching. It
only causes competition and conflict” (personal communication, February 28, 2014). At
Eastern U.S. University, units often find that it is more revenue efficient to duplicate a
course and hire a contract instructor than to pay for service teaching (personal
communication, February 26, 2014).
6.4.4 - THE AUSTERITY NARRATIVE
Through the document analysis and interview process it became clear that
Eastern U.S. University operates under an austerity narrative. As a result, the
universities and colleges within the State must consider cost as a primary factor in all
decision-making. In 2011 State funding for higher education was cut by 49%, leading the
189
President of the University to state “before the cut, the State was famously 50th out of
50 in per capita support for higher education. After the cut, we’re scrambling for new
metrics: How [are we] doing vis-à-vis Albania, for instance?” (Huddleston, 2014, p.1).
The environment of sustained financial constraint coupled with the dramatic cuts to
state appropriations in 2013 have encouraged the focus on individual unit revenue goals
at the expense of other units and the institution as a singular whole (personal
communication, February 24, 2014).
Informants reported operating under a continual state of budget crisis. In this
constant state of austerity, forward thinking and innovation are not front-of-mind, yet
both are needed to constructively increase enrollment and revenues for Eastern U.S.
University over the long-term (personal communication, February 27, 2014). One result
of this sustained austerity has been the loss of full time positions [when faculty retire
they are either not replaced or are replaced increasingly with contract faculty]. One
informant questioned “who can act entrepreneurially when you are forced to live with
an austerity narrative? The rich schools can look forward, the poor schools can only look
at today.” (personal communication, February 25, 2014). The resulting focus on revenue
producing efforts has had a negative effect on lateral coordination (personal
communication February 28, 2014). Informants reported the inability to think
strategically as they are forced to focus on the financial results of the current fiscal year
(personal communication, March 13, 2014).
190
6.4.5 - A NEW PATH FORWARD
In recognition of the poor lateral coordination at Eastern U.S. University a
number of reforms to improve inter-unit relationships have been initiated. An
adjustment to the RCB/M allocation formula has resulted in the retention of central
funds [held in the New Ventures Fund]. The vision for these funds is that they will be
used to align unit behaviour with the strategic direction of the institution and allow the
central administration to encourage and support lateral coordination. In addition to the
development of the New Ventures Fund, the appointment of a new Provost has
provided an opportunity for the University to embark on a reimagining of itself.
This reimaging is outlined in the University’s strategic plan, which seeks to
transition Eastern U.S. University from a regionally known institution to a nationally and
internationally recognized university. Eastern U.S. University plans to accomplish this
through increased investments in STEM research and programs, and through the inter-
unit initiatives presented above. Through these initiatives the University hopes to
experience increased demand for enrollment, leading to increased revenues for all units
(personal communication, February 24, 2014).
6.4.6 - SUMMARY
Eastern U.S. University employs an RCB/M model that is over-decentralized. As a
result of the over-decentralization low levels of vertical coordination were noted at the
university. The central administration has historically been unable to influence lateral
coordination due to an absence of centrally held financial resources. Additionally,
191
Eastern U.S. University operates in a state of sustained austerity which forces unit
leaders to focus on short term revenue generating activities. The combination of these
factors has caused an increased fractionalization of the institution and reinforced the
siloing of the University.
Recently, Eastern U.S. University is attempting to move in a new direction.
Adjusting the RCB/M model and the retention of centrally held financial resources is
expected to lead to increased influence and power for the central administration.
Coupled with the appointment of a new Provost, who is focused on increasing lateral
coordination and building a foundation for enrollment growth through interdisciplinary
programs, the University is beginning a transformation. However, this new direction is in
its infancy. As the transformation continues to progress, a move towards more
interactive management and communication may improve the outcomes for the
institution.
Eastern U.S. University is an environment of low lateral coordination. It was
suggested by informants that the internal competition and lacking lateral coordination
hinder the promotion of institutional goals. Rather, the focus is on individual unit goals
[often centered on the development of new revenue], at times at the expense of other
units. Informants described units as ‘pulling in different directions’, making the
achievement of institutional goals difficult. However, as noted above, Eastern U.S.
University is in transition. Recent initiatives and changes to the budgeting model seem
to have increased the levels of communication and collegiality. Furthermore,
interdisciplinary programs and centers are being built to meet the institutional goal of
192
increased collaboration. However, only time will reveal whether these changes are
sustainable and if they will impact the degree of lateral coordination present at the
institution.
SECTION 6.5 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
Like Eastern U.S. University, Western Canadian University suffers from low levels
of lateral coordination. The low degree of lateral coordination detected at the University
can be attributed to a lack of transparency, few centrally controlled discretionary
resources, and an extremely decentralized RCB/M model. Three main thematic areas
were identified as impacting lateral coordination at Western Canadian University: 1.
interdisciplinary programs; 2. the impact of RCB/M; 3. a lack of transparency, fairness
and trust. A detailed discussion of lateral coordination at Western Canadian University
will be presented below.
6.5.1 - INTER-UNIT PROGRAMS
At Western Canadian, informants viewed inter-unit programs as an opportunity
to differentiate the University from its provincial peers, however in practice,
opportunities for these initiatives [e.g. cross appointment, and interdisciplinary research
and instruction] are limited. Informants identified several barriers to inter-unit
initiatives including, a lack of transparency, the absence of direction from the central
193
administration, and low levels of lateral coordination. One informant suggested that
there have been few cross appointments between units due to a lack of lateral
coordination and communication (personal communication, March 3, 2014). A dean
stated that interdisciplinary majors are generally offered within the individual units as
there seems to be hesitation to work with outside faculties due to the financial issues
and the general lack of lateral coordination (personal communication, March 4, 2014).
Finally, a third informant argued that the reason Western Canadian University only has a
small number of interdisciplinary programs is “a lack of leadership, structures, and
support that encourage such initiatives.” (personal communication, March 3, 2014). It
was noted that Western Canadian University lacks the support structures necessary to
encourage lateral coordination. As a result, inter-unit activities are cumbersome to
negotiate and tend to be avoided.
A second factor that has limited the development of inter-unit activities and
lateral coordination is the complexity of the RCB/M budget model that is employed by
the University. The revenue sharing model at Western Canadian University is complex
and not well understood (personal communication, March 3, 2014; March 4, 2014;
March 5, 2014); the revenue sharing process has hindered interdisciplinary programs
and cross appointments because it requires one unit to lose for another to win (personal
communication, March 5, 2014). Informants repeatedly spoke about the difficulty of
negotiating agreements with other units. In addition to being poorly understood, the
RCB/M model at Western Canadian University rewards units for the number of students
they can bring to their own courses (Western Canadian University, 2013f). This
194
“mitigates against the development of new cross-disciplinary courses and programs”
(Western Canadian University, 2013f, p.8) resulting in a negative impact on the student
experience, as this experience is “hampered by a lack of collaboration across units and
campuses” (Mahon, 2012, p.6).
In spite of the difficulties presented by the budget model, there are some
examples of inter-unit initiatives at Western Canadian University. Recently, there has
been a grass roots faculty movement to address the obstacles to interdisciplinary
programs that are created by RCB/M. One example of these efforts is the new health
sciences faculty that required support from deans across instructional areas. One
informant, who was directly involved in the health sciences initiative, discussed the
importance of encouraging inter-unit (personal communication, March 3, 2014). It was
noted by multiple informants that units that do collaborate are often encouraged to do
by the informal processes and existing lateral relationships that exist among faculty
members (personal communication, March 4, 2014).
6.5.2 - THE IMPACT OF RCB/M
The RCB/M model that is employed at Western Canadian University operated in
a highly decentralized state compared to the models used by Central Canadian
University and Midwestern U.S. University. One effect of this extreme decentralization
has been increased fragmentation. One informant, whose tenure spans the entire
history of RCB/M at the University, stated that “since the introduction of RCB/M at
Western Canadian University I have observed an increased siloing [sic] effect, increased
195
competition through the duplication of courses and the competition for students, and
the decrease in collaborative actions” (personal communication, March 4, 2014).
At Western Canadian University lateral competition normally revolves around
students; this occurs because 30% of the unit budgets are funded based on the number
of students enrolled. The remaining 70% of unit funding is the result of historical one-
on-one negotiations between units and the central administration (personal
communication, March 3, 2014; March 4, 2014; March 6, 2014; March 7, 2014). The
result of this arrangement is that units can only affect their revenue by increasing their
enrollment or by increasing tuition. The outcome is ongoing competition for students,
often through the duplication of course offerings. Multiple informants provided
examples of course duplication that has taken place across the University (personal
communication, March 3, 2014; March 5, 2014; March 7, 2014).
Two related areas of concern were discussed by informants. The first centers
around academic standards for elective courses. Multiple informants voiced concern
that performance expectations placed on elective courses were being lowered to
promote increased course enrollment [and revenue for the unit operating the course].
The second area of concern relates to a trend of ‘course packing’ at the University.
Course packing was described by informants as the process of increasing the number of
courses that students are required to take within their home unit in order to be eligible
for graduation. One informant commented that they “have observed some majors
increasing the number of courses needed for their degree that must be taken within
their own department to decrease the amount of service teaching and maximize
196
revenue” (personal communication, March 4, 2014). Another informant remarked that
course packing was a clear form of competition at the University and was based on the
fear of losing revenue (personal communication, March 6, 2014). This informant
continued by stating that the university has built a culture of defense and secrecy rather
than one of cooperation and collaboration and attributed this culture to the
competition resulting from the RCB/M model.
To address these concerns the President’s Task Force was commissioned to
review the budget model and its impact on coordination at Western Canadian
University. The resulting report has led the administration to acknowledge the need to
encourage cooperation and collaboration. The findings stated:
“…communication and collaboration across campus units and groups in general
needs to improve. There are large gaps that exist and somehow they need to be
bridged and greater transparency encouraged. It was often mentioned that our
approach to resource allocation creates these issues and that similar
investments are present in a variety of units across campus with little to no
coordination between them.” (Western Canadian University, 2013f, p. 5-6).
To address these concerns the RCB/M model at Western Canadian University
was revised in 2012. The intention was to create a framework that would increase trust
between colleagues and with administrators. The expectation of the revision was that
unit leaders would “act on behalf of the entire University…rather than acting mainly as
197
an advocate for his/her individual faculty/school or administrative unit” (Western
Canadian University, 2012a, p.11). However the refinement of the model was not
successful in overcoming the imbalances that were created through the original
allocation methodology. There was a clear consensus on the part of informants
regarding the negative impact the RCB/M model had on communication and
collaboration at Western Canadian University. It was also noted that the central
administration lacked the influence and at times authority to balance the resource
allocations so that units did not manipulate the allocation model to gain an advantage at
the expense of their peer units (Western Canadian University, 2013f).
6.5.3 - TRANSPARENCY, FAIRNESS AND TRUST
At Western Canadian University informants frequently spoke about the need to
improve transparency [both as related to the budget process, and as shift of
institutional culture]. Informants noted en mass that transparency is lacking at Western
Canadian University and that its absence has had material effects on lateral
coordination and trust. One informant commented that “due to the lack of transparency
in reporting, and a lack of understanding of how much of the money is distributed, units
are in a continual competition for resources, as they see it as a zero sum game, resulting
in relatively low levels of cooperation” (personal communication, March 3, 2014).
Another informant remarked that a feeling of trust and fairness is needed to instill
lateral coordination (personal communication, March 5, 2014).
198
The lack of transparency in the allocation of funds from the government
operating grant was the most often identified issue with the RCB/M model. One
informant remarked that the lack of transparency hinders the cooperation and
coordination between units, as the distributions of financial resources have been based
on private, behind the scenes negotiations and not by a publically available formula
(personal communication, March 6, 2014). The behind the scenes negations result in
units being unable to predict funding or plan for future budget years strategically
(personal communication, March 5, 2014). The result of the secrecy surrounding the
allocation model is a focus inward and an increased level of self-interested decision-
making (personal communication, March 3, 2014). Informants repeatedly noted that the
secretive nature of resource allocation results in a lack of procedural justice and
pervasive mistrust (personal communication, March 7, 2014). The lack of open and
consultative processes at Western Canadian University undermines lateral coordination
and trust (Western Canadian University, 2012a).
A common sentiment espoused by many of the informants from Western
Canadian University was that there was a lack of formal and informal processes
designed to encourage lateral coordination and trust between units. One informant
commented that there “seems to be a lack of services and support to encourage
coordination between units. It is not surprising however due to the lack of financial
resources held by the central administration” (personal communication, March 3, 2014).
The central administrators who participated in interviews for this research commented
that without financial resources at their disposal they felt powerless to provide services
199
and initiatives to encourage communication between units. One informant remarked
that “there is no promotion of collaboration between units by the central
administration. We just don’t have the budget” (personal communication, March 3,
2014). A second informant stated that they were unaware of any formal programs or
processes initiated by the central administration that encouraged lateral coordination or
transparency (personal communication, March 6, 2014).
Although the central administration at Western Canadian University expressed
feeling powerless to influence unit behaviour and decision-making, there was an
acknowledgement of the need to build processes that encourage lateral coordination
and transparency. In the Final Report of the President’s Task Force it was noted that the
administration needs to build structures to encourage lateral coordination (Western
Canadian University, 2012a). Specifically, the administration needed to build what they
termed ‘lateral communication structures’ to increase coordination between units and
to counteract the current budget process that “tends to pit departments against each
other” (Western Canadian University, 2012a, p. 29). Informants identified the lack of
transparency as the largest hindrance to lateral coordination at Western Canadian
University. Additionally, in the Final Report of the President’s Task Force (2012), this lack
of transparency was identified as a major obstacle to institutional success. It was
suggested that the central administration needed to retain resources in order to change
processes so as to encourage transparency and coordination, clearly define allocation
formulas, and to increase the consultative and interactive nature of lateral interactions
(Western Canadian University, 2012a). It was anticipated that these changes would
200
result in the encouragement of “a sense of community and collaboration through
enhanced understanding of other areas’ strengths, challenges, priorities, and overall
budget context; and greater transparency in the budget process” (Western Canadian
University, 2012a, p. 12).
6.5.4 - SUMMARY
Western Canadian University employs an RCB/M model that informants termed
‘over-decentralized’. In this model the central administration retains very few financial
resources and, as a consequence, has been unable to provide support for initiatives that
encourage lateral coordination. Although there are some examples of faculty led,
grassroots lateral initiatives, the RCB/M model at Western Canadian University is
complex and is a barrier to inter-unit cooperation. In this case the RCB/M model
promotes inter-unit competition for students [taking the form of course-packing, or
through the modification of course evaluation standards]. Additionally, Western
Canadian University experiences extremely low levels of transparency resulting in an
environment of pervasive mistrust. The combination of these factors has resulted in
limited inter-unit cooperation and encouraged competition between units.
In this environment of low lateral coordination, informants suggested that the
internal competition and lack of transparency hinder the promotion of institutional
goals. Instead, the focus is on individual unit goals, even if they are achieved at the
expense of other units. Informants described units as competitors [who are often
treated with mistrust]. Although there has been a recognition that increased lateral
201
coordination and transparency are needed, the path to practice is ill-defined in
institutional documents and was unclear to informants.
Recently, the central administration at Western Canadian University decided
that returning to an incremental budget model would help to alleviate the coordination
problems surrounding the RCB/M model. It remains unclear how this transition will
impact lateral coordination at the university.
SECTION 6.6 – PROPOSITIONS ON LATERAL COORDINATION
Lateral coordination provides a measure to evaluate the presence and degree of
alignment, cooperation and coordination between units of an institution. In this
research lateral coordination is evaluated by considering the degree of cooperation and
coordination, or competition and conflict present between units at each of the four
universities.
Drawing upon the data presented in this chapter two matrices have been
developed to illustrate lateral coordination at each of the universities. Lateral
coordination has been evaluated in relation to three propositions, each of which will be
discussed individually.
6.6.1 – PROPOSITION TWO
Proposition two focusses on the relationship between units [inter-unit] and the
impact that central governance and oversight processes have on these relationships.
202
Proposition two reads: High levels of lateral coordination by units will be encouraged by
interactive control forms of governance, while diagnostic control forms of governance
will encourage lower levels of lateral coordination. The literature suggests that RCB/M
may increase levels of competition and decrease collaboration between units (e.g.
Cantor & Courant, 1997; Gros Louis & Thompson, 2002; Hearn et al. 2006; Lang, 2002),
however, this work suggests that interactive control forms of governance may moderate
this relationship and lessening the levels of competition between units.
Central Canadian University and Midwestern U.S. University each employ a
governance control form that should be categorized as hybrid. At both institutions, the
central administration relies primarily on interactive management techniques that are
supported by diagnostic processes to promote lateral coordination. At both of these
institutions, lateral coordination levels were reported as being high by informants.
Informants credited the central administration as provide support for lateral
coordination through a wide variety of initiatives and opportunities for collaboration
and relationship building. Conversely, Western Canadian University employs a
governance control form that is primarily diagnostic. Informants reported that lateral
coordination at Western Canadian University is lacking, with units viewing each other as
competitors. Informants noted that there is limited lateral coordination at Western
Canadian University and were unable to identify any formal initiatives or activities that
promote lateral coordination. Finally Eastern U.S. University is in the process of
transition. The historically diagnostic governance control form is being transformed to
focus on interactive management techniques. Informants reported that there has
203
historically been competition between units, however there was a widespread, yet
reserved, belief that the renewed commitment to interactive management will promote
increased lateral coordination.
Table 12: Governance Control Forms and Levels of Lateral Coordination
Governance Control Form Low Levels of Lateral
Coordination High Levels of Lateral
Coordination
Diagnostic
Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
Interactive
Hybrid
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
6.6.2 – PROPOSITION FOUR
Proposition four speaks to the relationship between the degree of lateral
coordination present at an institution and the achievement of organizational goals.
Proposition four reads: High lateral coordination will encourage the achievement of the
HEI’s organizational goals. The assumption present in the literature is that high levels of
lateral coordination will result in a high degree of strategic goal achievement (Crotts,
Dickson, & Ford, 2005; Hides, Davies, & Jackson, 2004; Kretschmer & Puranam, 2008;
Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967; Miles & Snow, 1984; Taylor, 2000). The findings in the
literature suggest that high levels of lateral coordination will result in units acting in a
relatively aligned fashion that is expected to be congruent with the strategic direction of
the institution resulting in higher levels of strategic goal achievement.
204
Midwestern U.S. University has achieved high levels of lateral coordination and
although tension between the units does occur, informants generally reported that
there is a collegial and constructive approach to lateral interactions. Informants at
Midwestern U.S. University reported three main institutional goals: 1. the building of
reputation and ranking; 2. financial stability and sustainability; and 3. the promotion of
excellence. The high level of lateral coordination present at the university promotes the
achievement of these institutional goals. Reputation and ranking is achieved through
interdisciplinary programs that provide cutting-edge, world-class research opportunities
for students and faculty. Without strong lateral coordination the facilitation of
interdisciplinary agreements between units would be hindered. Financial stability,
through the identification of efficiencies, innovation, and improved management and
decision-making is made possible because of the numerous formal and informal
processes that foster lateral coordination. The sharing of best practices and building of
informal connections between units have helped improve decision-making and were
cited by informants as driving efficiencies and decreasing costs. Finally, the institutional
commitment to world-class excellence was reported by informants as being an
important driver of unit behaviour and lateral coordination (personal communication,
March 11, 2014). Informants reported that, through cooperation and collaboration,
Midwestern U.S. University as an institution can continue to achieve levels of excellence
that will draw top faculty, researchers, and students.
Analogous to Midwestern U.S. University, Central Canadian University
experiences institutional goal achievement supported by high levels of lateral
205
coordination. Broadly stated, informants identified three main institutional goals: 1. the
focus on and enhancement of research and teaching; 2. financial sustainability and
responsibility; and 3. support for the university through a collegial culture. The
enhancement of research and teaching has resulted in the creation of inter-unit
programs, including forty collaborative graduate programs that informants identified as
a way to attract top-tier talent [both students and faculty], gain external funding, and
promote cutting-edge research (Central Canadian University, 2014). The high level of
lateral coordination at the university has encouraged the growth of these inter-unit
programs. Lateral coordination also promotes the institutional goal of financial
sustainability. Informants viewed their competitors as other universities, instead of
other units within the institution. As one informant noted, the lateral coordination
between units “allows us [Central Canadian University] to look outwards for growth
opportunities rather than focusing inwards on protect our programs from internal
threats” (personal communication, March 7, 2014). Finally, the use of collegial processes
to support the university community is enhanced by the high level of lateral
coordination present at the university. Informants reported that decision-making is
academically focused and relies on faculty participation.
At Eastern U.S. University and Western Canadian University low levels of lateral
coordination have inhibited the achievement of organizational goals. The low levels of
lateral coordination present at these universities can be partially attributed institutional
size and prestige. The cost of running an RCB/M system can be prohibitively expensive
for units, taking precious resources away from inter-unit initiatives. Informants also
206
noted that both universities are regionally known. This limits the base from which they
recruit and, as a result, may encourage internal competition for students, decreasing
lateral coordination. At both institutions informants suggested that unit level initiatives,
coupled with the need to secure revenue dominated unit decision-making processes. At
Eastern U.S. University the creation of the centrally held discretionary funding is
beginning to foster lateral coordination. It is expected that the transition to more
interactive governance control, combined with centrally held resources will help
promote institutional goal achievement. Conversely, Western Canadian University has
been largely unable to realize institutional goals. Enrollment growth, financial
sustainability, and a focus on teaching and research comprise the institutional goals
identified by informants. With demographic trends suggesting decreasing demand, cuts
in provincial funding and increased competition from provincial counterparts, the 2014
Strategic Plan acknowledged that Western Canadian University must look increasingly
towards interdisciplinary programs and offerings to promote growth and sustainability.
However, this has been difficult to achieve as the level of competition between units is
high and the levels of cooperation and collaboration have been low.
Table 13: Levels of Lateral Coordination and Institutional Goal Achievement
Levels of Lateral Coordination
Low Reported Institutional Goal Achievement
High Reported Institutional Goal Achievement
Low
Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
High
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
207
6.6.3 – PROPOSITION FIVE
The fifth proposition considers the relationship between financial incentives and
levels of vertical and lateral coordination. Proposition five reads: If the incentive for
revenue seeking behaviour is stronger than the incentive [or ability] to reduce costs units
will exhibit lower levels of vertical and lateral coordination. The RCB/M literature argues
that there are two general incentives for units. The first is the reduction of costs and the
second is the encouragement of revenue seeking behaviour (Lang, 1999a; Strauss &
Curry, 2002; Strauss, Curry, Whalen, 1996; Whalen, 1991). This proposition is meant to
examine whether the behaviour expected in an RCB/M model is occurring.
At each of the four universities the incentive to seek new revenue was reported
to be greater than the incentive to minimize costs. However, the impact of this incentive
on lateral coordination seemed to be moderated by the governance control from in use
at the institution. Although efficiencies and cost savings were sought by units at
Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian University, informants, both at the
unit level and from the central administration, stated that there was little ability to
materially lower costs as salaries and facilities made up the majority of the budgets for
units. For this reason, the search for new revenue is the main focus of units seeking to
increase their financial standing. At Eastern U.S. University and Western Canadian
University incentives for revenue seeking behaviour were reported to be stronger than
those for cost containment. Although increased lateral competition was reported by
informants, the low levels of lateral coordination present at the university appear to be
208
influenced more by the radically decentralized nature of the RCB/M models and the lack
of centrally held financial resources.
209
CHAPTER SEVEN
UNIT AUTONOMY
“The university is so many things to so many people that it must, of necessity, be
partially at war with itself” (Kerr, 1982, p. 8).
SECTION 7.1 - INTRODUCTION
This chapter presents the data and resultant findings pertaining to unit
autonomy. As discussed in Chapter Three unit autonomy is defined as the level of
funding authority and task accountability possessed by a unit. Funding authority is the
provision of resource allocation decision-making powers, while task accountability
denotes that units are held accountable for the decisions that they make and the
resulting outcomes. Unit autonomy also includes the responsibility for outcomes of the
decision-making process. Consequently, the financial outcomes of decision-making,
both positive and negative, have implications for future budget years and, as a result
partially define the future options available to units.
A discussion of the essential institutional factors that influence unit autonomy is
presented below. Although differences in institutional characteristics existed, thematic
similarities were noted across all four institutions. In this chapter the common themes
are presented along with a case study analysis of each institution, followed by a
discussion of the propositions relating to unit autonomy.
210
SECTION 7.2 - MIDWESTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
Informants identified four broad themes that impact unit autonomy at
Midwestern U.S. University: 1. a trend of centralization; 2. the financial position of units;
3. a dean centric management model; and 4. the university’s financial position. At
Midwestern U.S. University the Provost maintains substantial oversight power over unit
budgets, however this power is most often exercised interactively, via collaboration
with deans (personal communication, February 19, 2014). Interactions between deans
and the Provost center around two-way communication and are best characterized as
discussions between colleagues (personal communication, March 11, 2014). The existing
vertical relationships at Midwestern U.S. University have direct bearing on the degree of
unit autonomy at the institution. A more in-depth exploration of the factors that impact
unit autonomy at the University will be discussed below.
7.2.1 - TREND OF CENTRALIZATION
Informants identified a trend of centralization occurring at Midwestern U.S.
University; a review of institutional documents situates the initiation of this trend in the
early 1990s when a process of strategic buying was undertaken and increased
procurement reporting requirements were developed (Courant & Knepp, 2003). More
recently, centralization has increased at the University and has been framed by the
central administration as a rational process towards cost savings, undertaken with the
intent to maintain unit decision-making autonomy (personal communication, February
211
18, 2014) 10. Informants noted that the centralization process has grown to encompass
‘shared services’, which include information technology, grievance processes, and some
general human resource services (personal communication, February 17, 2014). The
purpose of centralizing shared services is to achieve economies of scale, and to increase
standardization across units (personal communication, February 20, 2014). Additionally,
centralization is being driven by government demands. Midwestern U.S. University is a
public institution and the government has a great deal of influence on the institution
through the Board of Regents. Demands for increased efficiencies to help keep the cost
of tuition down are a significant driver of centralization initiatives at the University
(personal communication, February 19, 2014; Midwestern U.S. University, 2005).
Although the central administration has tried to highlight the benefits of centralization,
it is evident that this trend has created tension between units, faculty and
administration (personal communication, Feb 18, 2014). One informant stated that
“there is a tension between the central administration and decentralized rights with
regard to the centralizing of services” (personal communication, February 19, 2014).
The trend of centralization has not been without detractors. Recently a faculty
petition with more than 1,000 signatures was presented to the Provost demanding that
the most recent centralization initiative, labeled the Administrative Services
Transformation [AST], be reconsidered (personal communication, February, 17, 2014).
The AST initiative intends to centralize finance personnel and services [traditionally held
10 It should be noted that while centralization efforts were in place prior to the implementation of RCB/M, a marked increase in centralization can be observed in institutional documents as a response to the over-decentralization present in the Value Centered Management model [the original iteration of RCB/M employed by Midwestern U.S. University].
212
at the unit-level], expand centralized human resources support, and increase the shared
procurement initiatives. The reality of the AST initiative will be the loss of unit specific
administrators who will move under the umbrella of the central administration
(personal communication, February, 19, 2014). Informants noted that this will penalize
efficient units, as it is anticipated that the cost for centralized services will be greater
than those incurred while services were delivered in-house (personal communication,
Feb 21, 2014). Additionally informants noted that increased centralization will result in
decreasing unit autonomy.
7.2.2 - THE FINANCIAL POSITION OF UNITS
The second variable that impacts unit autonomy at the University is the financial
position of individual units. Units that operate at breakeven or deficit are subject to
increased oversight, support, and direction from the central administration, resulting in
decreased autonomy (personal communication, February 19, 2014). Conversely, units
that operate with surpluses, experience enrollment growth, or generate external
funding retain autonomy. One informant noted that “the financial position of the unit
defines its autonomy” (personal communication, February 21, 2014). It was noted by
several informants that endowment size is an important driver of financial performance;
units possessing large endowments experience greater autonomy in decision-making
than their counterparts with smaller endowments.
213
7.2.3 - DEAN CENTRIC MODEL
As discussed in Chapter Five, the RCB/M model employed at Midwestern U.S.
University is dean centric with deans possessing substantial power (personal
communication, February 17, 2014). The resulting autonomy afforded to deans under
the University Budget Model and System, has resulted in self-management,
entrepreneurship and innovation at the unit level (Midwestern U.S. University, 2005).
One informant stated that “over the years we have gotten a clearer
understanding of what is and should be decentralized but this has not decreased our
[deans’] autonomy in a meaningful way” (personal communication, February 18, 2014).
Informants viewed the central administration as being hands off and allowing the deans
to lead their units (personal communication, February 20, 2014). On informant noted
that “at Midwestern U.S. University the power and the budgets are held at the college
[unit] level and driven by the deans. The level of autonomy at the college [unit] level is
linked to the strength of the dean.” (personal communication, February 18, 2014). A
second informant stated that “at Midwestern U.S. University deans have a great deal of
power. It’s a true RCB/M system with the ability to control revenues and costs at the
unit level” (personal communication, March 11, 2014).
7.2.4 - THE UNIVERSITY’S FINANCIAL POSITION
In addition to the financial position of the individual units, the University’s
financial position is an important determinant of unit autonomy. Informants suggested
214
that the increasing level of oversight of unit level decision-making was linked to the
recent financial crisis. One informant stated that “increasing oversight over the past few
years has been necessary due to external government pressure and increasing financial
constraints (personal communication, February 17, 2014). The institution-wide focus on
structural and operating deficits has resulted in more central monitoring of unit
decisions. However, as noted in Section 7.3.2, this has most notably affected units that
experience budget deficits.
7.2.5 - SUMMARY
The data gathered from Midwestern U.S. University demonstrates substantial
unit autonomy. The hybrid governance model provides deans with meaningful control
over their units and securing their position as active contributors to institutional
decision-making. However, the design of the RCB/M model explicitly emphasizes that
units are not supposed to be self-supporting; the necessity of central resources serves
to align unit decision-making to the strategic direction of the university (Cantor &
Courant, 1997). Although central resources are needed by all units, high levels of unit
autonomy are present at the university.
SECTION 7.3 - CENTRAL CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
Like Midwestern U.S. University, Central Canadian University has a long history
of decentralization. As outlined in Chapter Four, Central Canadian University had
215
experience with decentralized budgeting models prior to the implementation of the
New Budget Model; one of the institution’s satellite campuses experimented with
RCB/M, and the School of Management previously operated a decentralized model. As
such, units had experience with relatively high degrees of autonomy before the
implementation of RCB/M. When discussing unit autonomy at Central Canadian
University, informants identified two salient issues: 1. the trend of centralization; and 2.
the dean central management model. A more detailed discussion of these issues will be
presented below.
7.3.1 - TREND OF CENTRALIZATION
As was noted at Midwestern U.S. University, a trend of centralization is evident
at Central Canadian University. A number of respondents commented on centralization
processes taking place across the institution, including initiatives to centralize certain
‘shared services’ [e.g. information technology and e-mail] (Central Canadian University,
2012b). Informants noted that these initiatives are viewed as mostly positive. The
motivation for centralizing shared services is the achievement of efficiencies and
economies of scale. Informants identified fiscal constraints as encouraging centralization
across the university (personal communication, March 25, 2014). The hope is that
systematic and streamlined services will help minimize costs without impacting service
and support levels (personal communication, April 3, 2014). Several informants were
concerned that this centralization process will reduce unit autonomy (personal
communication, March 25, 2014; April 3, 2014).
216
7.3.2 - DEAN CENTRIC MODEL
At Central Canadian University, deans operate with high degrees of decision-
making autonomy that is bounded by moderate central oversight. As was noted at
Midwestern U.S. University, decision-making is bounded by fiscal constraints, and unit
decisions are expected to be aligned with the mission and strategic direction of the
university. Central oversight is provided through interactive vertical communication
between deans and the provost. Within these vertical interactions there is an
expectation of collegiality that results in consultative decision-making (personal
communication, March 25, 2014). Deans are considered to be autonomous leaders, and
informants noted that the Provost’s office and central administration work to provide
help and support in a manner that is respectful of unit autonomy (personal
communication, April 2, 2014). Deans’ are responsible for the costs and revenues
generated by their unit (personal communication, March 25, 2014). They have
autonomy in decision-making allowing them to act entrepreneurially and seek out
revenue and growth (personal communication, March 27, 2014). Although the central
administration provides support services for units, the responsibility to build and
execute plans is most often in the hands of the dean and their staff (personal
communication, March 31, 2014). The structures to provide unit oversight have been
designed to respect the concept of decentralization while ensuring alignment to the
institution’s needs (personal communication, April 3, 2014). Informants noted that
alignment is the main constraint on unit autonomy; those units that promote and
217
achieve the mission of the institution experience significant autonomy (personal
communication, March 25, 2014).
7.3.3 - SUMMARY
As discussed in Chapter Five Central Canadian University employs a hybrid form
of governance control. This model is comparable to the model employed by Midwestern
U.S. University in that there are a number of processes to allow for the oversight of
decision-making while respecting the autonomy of deans. Informants overwhelmingly
identified central oversight practices as a steering process that does not have a material
effect on unit autonomy.
SECTION 7.4 – EASTERN U.S. UNIVERSITY
At Eastern U.S. University informants identified three factors that impact the
level of unit autonomy present at the university: 1. the radically decentralized nature of
the RCB/M model; 2. long standing fiscal constraints; and 3. the recent trend of
centralization. These factors will be discussed in more detail below.
7.4.1 – RADICAL DECENTRALIZATION
At Eastern U.S. University the RCB/M model distributes the vast majority of the
financial resources to the unit level and affords deans substantial decision-making
autonomy. It closely resembles a decentralized budget model employed in for-profit
218
industry in that it is “radically decentralized” (personal communication, February 24,
2014) with little central oversight of decision-making (personal communication, March
13, 2014). Informants described this model as “overly decentralised” (personal
communication, February 26, 2014), and noted that it has resulted in a high level of unit
autonomy. Additionally, the radically decentralized nature has resulted in low levels of
task accountability [in terms of reporting]. Recently, changes in the budgeting model
have been introduced to help bound unit decision-making, limit lateral competition and
increase central oversight and influence. The result has been a moderate decrease in
unit autonomy and an increase in task accountability.
7.4.2 – FISCAL CONSTRAINTS
The second factor that informants identified as impacting unit autonomy is fiscal
constraint. As discussed in Chapter Five, Eastern U.S. University has operated under as
austerity narrative for more than a decade. Informants noted that the sustained lack of
financial resources has negatively impacted unit autonomy. One informant commented
that it is “difficult to act entrepreneurially and innovatively when many schools [units]
are at break-even or running deficits” (personal communication, February 27, 2014). As
a result of fiscal constraints, deans are often forced to think short-term, looking for
opportunities to fill revenue gaps and meet the budgetary needs of the current fiscal
year (personal communication, February 25, 2014). One dean stated that this fiscal
context limits the options the unit can pursue, and as an extension limiting unit
autonomy (personal communication, February 24, 2014).
219
In addition to the general state of fiscal constraint that affects all units at the
university, the financial position of individual units has a material impact its autonomy.
Informants noted that when units experience a budget deficit much of their autonomy is
removed by the central administration. Increased oversight and direction are mandated
during the bailout process and units with deficits are required to submit a mitigation
plan to the central administration that outlines a plan for deficit resolution (Proulx,
2004). Informants suggested that the deficit resolution process may take years to
complete and that during this period unit autonomy is greatly decreased (personal
communication, March 13, 2014). Alternatively, it was also noted that “those units that
run lean and efficient hold the power in the relationship [between the unit and the
central administration] and experience a great deal of autonomy” (personal
communication, February 28, 2014).
7.4.3 – TREND OF CENTRALIZATION
External fiscal constraints are driving the trend of centralization at Eastern U.S.
University11. As noted in Chapter Five, the university has been operating under a
narrative of austerity for a prolonged period of time. In response to recent cuts in state
appropriations increased efficiencies and cost cutting measures have been
implemented. One of the primary optimization initiatives has been the centralization of
services and support. To achieve this, a review and reconsideration of unit autonomy
11 In 2011 the State cut funding for public higher education institutions by 49%. This drastic funding cut resulted in increased centralization efforts at Eastern U.S. University, and as an extension unit autonomy has decreased.
220
was conducted, ultimately resulting in changes to the RCB/M allocation formula and
increased central tax rates. Increased central taxes have been allocated to fund the
centralization efforts across the institution; this has resulted in a decrease of unit
autonomy as units lose control over shared services, such as information technology,
human resources activities, and some procurement processes (Proulx, 2004; personal
communication, March 13, 2014). The centralization process has caused concern at the
unit level with one informant stating that “there is a great deal of anxiety about the
move towards centralization and the decrease of school [unit] autonomy” (personal
communication, February 24, 2014).
The radically decentralized nature of the budget model has created an
expectation of unfettered unit autonomy. This expectation has created a disconnect
between the central administration and units (personal communication, February 26,
2014). Increasingly, the central administration and units have differing understanding of
the future. The central administration believes that there is a need for increased
centralization of services, while the units want to continue operating under a radically
decentralized structure (personal communication, February 27, 2014).
The centralization process is intended to not only drive efficiencies as identified
above, but also to allow for centrally driven initiatives such as interdisciplinary
programs, building renewal and restoration, capital works projects, and investments
into information technology and upgrading cyber capacity on campus (Huddleston,
2010). This process is intended to provide increased financial resources that are
221
centrally controlled to allow the University to act strategically and influence decision-
making at the unit level (personal communication, February 28, 2014). It was noted that
the President is trying to bring more power and control over the budget and the
financial resources of the institution under the purview of the central administration;
the result has and will continue to be decreasing unit autonomy (personal
communication, February 26, 2014).
7.4.4 - SUMMARY
Historically, units have experienced high degrees of autonomy with few
constraints on decision-making. However, the highly autonomous environment at
Eastern U.S. University has resulted in low levels of both vertical and lateral
coordination. The recent changes being implemented at the university are meant to
decrease unit autonomy and provide constraints and boundaries on decision-making;
these changes are also intended to provide increased task accountability. The goal is to
promote unit decision-making that is aligned with the institution’s strategic direction,
and to provide streamlined processes that will drive efficiencies and lower costs across
the units.
SECTION 7.5 - WESTERN CANADIAN UNIVERSITY
At Western Canadian University informants identified three factors that impact
the level of unit autonomy present at the university: 1. the need for revenue and
222
enrollment growth; 2. a trend of centralization; and 3. Campus Alberta. These factors
will be discussed in more detail below.
7.5.1 – REVENUE AND ENROLLMENT GROWTH
Like Eastern U.S. University, Western Canadian University employs an RCB/M
model that is highly decentralized. Deans possess high levels of decision-making
autonomy and are subject to low levels of task accountability. Additionally, the central
administration is unable to provide effective oversight or influence unit decision-making
due to a lack of centrally held resources. Many informants noted that deans hold
significant power at the university.
As discussed in Chapters Five and Six, units have limited ability to increase their
budgets from year to year. Without a clear, published allocation formula units are
unable to predict revenue growth year over year. The only predictable avenue to grow
unit revenue is through enrollment growth [because tuition dollars follow the student].
In this way, the RCB/M model employed at Western Canadian University encourages
deans to grow enrollments at the expense of other activities. Units that successfully
grow enrollment experience increased autonomy and power within the University
(personal communication, March 3, 2014). This arrangement is not an accident, the
RCB/M model was originally designed to incentivise units to grow enrollment and act
entrepreneurially; decentralizing power at the dean level was viewed as a mechanism to
jump start institutional enrollment numbers and allow the institution to compete with
its larger provincial rivals (personal communication, March 5, 2014).
223
7.5.2 – TREND OF CENTRALIZATION
As was detected at the other universities, there is a trend of centralization
occurring at Western Canadian University. Analogous to the observations from Eastern
U.S. University, the central administration at Western Canadian University has
historically lacked the resources necessary to influence and direct unit-level decision-
making (personal communication, March 6, 2014). As discussed in Chapter Six, the result
has been internal competition and conflict. To overcome these challenges, and increase
vertical and lateral coordination, the central administration has proposed the
centralization of certain services and an increase in tax rates that will be used to build
discretionary funding that will be disbursed to fund initiatives that align with the
strategic direction of the institution (personal communication, March 3, 2014).
Informants espoused a strongly negative view of centralization with one informant
stating that this initiative is designed to “decrease the power and influence of the
deans” (personal communication, March 5, 2014).
Another factor that is contributing to the centralization process occurring at the
university is the need for increased operational efficiencies. Provincial funding cuts and
changing government policies have accelerated the centralization process at Western
Canadian University. The 2013 Provincial budget [which announced significant
decreases in provincial funding for all universities] presented a ‘significant barrier’ to
Western Canadian University meeting its full potential, resulting in an increasing
centralization of power and influence in attempt to find operating efficiences and
increase central influenuce over unit decision-making (Western Canadian University,
224
2013c). Interestingly the central administration at Western Canadian University is
asserting that the centralization of power will increase innovation and efficiency
(personal communication, March 5, 2014) which is contrary to what the RCB/M
literature suggests.
7.5.3 – CAMPUS ALBERTA
It is noteworthy that the largest potential threat to unit autonomy at Western
Canadian University comes from outside the institution. A new provincial government
proposal has recently been forwarded that seeks to diminish the regional autonomy of
the Alberta universities in the name of ‘Campus Alberta’. Campus Alberta is a
government initiative that was created to formalize and encourage collaboration
between the province’s 26 publicly funded post-secondary institutions. It is meant to
have a centralized effect on the province’s higher education institutions and would
materially affect individual units. The concern with the Campus Alberta initiative is that
it may remove decision-making responsibilities related to the determination of research
priorities, program initiatives, and program offerings away from the individual
institutions and instead place them with the provincial government (Western Canadian
University, 2013e). In order to combat the Campus Alberta initiative and retain
institutional autonomy, Western Canadian University may opt to decrease unit
autonomy and shift in power and resources to the central administration. Informants
expressed concern that a reassignment of power could be justified as allowing more
225
responsive action with regards to the Campus Alberta System (Western Canadian
University, 2013c).
7.5.4 - SUMMARY
Currently, units at Western Canadian University experience high levels of
autonomy and relatively low levels of task accountability. However, lacking central
oversight and an inability to influence unit decision-making has resulted in low levels of
both vertical and lateral coordination. Unlike Eastern U.S. University, that has elected to
implement interactive governance to moderate unfettered unit autonomy, Western
Canadian University has opted to increase the use of diagnostic control via a return to
an incremental budgeting model. The intention on the part of the central administration
is to increase controls over unit decision-making and decrease unit autonomy.
SECTION 7.6 - PROPOSITIONS REGARDING UNIT AUTONOMY
Unit autonomy provides a measure to evaluate the presence and degree of
funding authority and task accountability. In this research unit autonomy is evaluated by
considering the degree of power and influence the central administration wields over
unit decision-making and resource allocation. Drawing upon the data presented in this
chapter five matrices have been developed to illustrate the level of unit autonomy at
each of the universities.
226
7.6.1 – PROPOSITION SEVEN
Proposition seven considers the relationship between unit autonomy and
diagnostic control forms of governance and the resulting impact on the levels of vertical
and lateral coordination. Proposition seven reads: Higher levels of unit autonomy in a
diagnostic control form governance structure will result in lower levels of lateral and
vertical coordination. Eastern U.S. University and Western Canadian University both
employ governance forms that are primarily diagnostic. High levels of unit autonomy
and low levels of vertical and lateral coordination were detected at both institutions.
Although Eastern U.S. University is in a period of transition the impact for unit
autonomy remains undetermined. Based on the observations at both of these
institutions, support was found for proposition seven.
Table 14: Unit Autonomy and Diagnostic Governance Control Form’s Relationship to Vertical Coordination
Levels of Unit Autonomy Low Vertical Coordination High Vertical Coordination
Low
High
Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
Table 15: Unit Autonomy and Diagnostic Governance Control Form’s Relationship to Lateral Coordination
Levels of Unit Autonomy Low Lateral Coordination High Lateral Coordination
Low
High
Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
227
7.6.2 – PROPOSITION EIGHT
Proposition eight considers the relationship between unit autonomy and
interactive governance and the resulting impact on lateral and vertical coordination.
Proposition eight reads: Higher levels of unit autonomy in an interactive control form
structure will result in higher levels of lateral and vertical coordination. As discussed in
Chapter Five, Midwestern U.S. University and Central Canadian University employ a
hybrid governance control form that is primarily interactive in practice. Because of this
[primarily] interactive approach to governance and management, support is present for
proposition eight.
Table 16: Unit Autonomy and Hybrid Governance Control Form’s Relationship to Vertical Coordination
Levels of Unit Autonomy Low Vertical Coordination High Vertical Coordination
Low
High
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
Table 17: Unit Autonomy and Hybrid Governance Control Form’s Relationship to Lateral Coordination
Levels of Unit Autonomy Low Lateral Coordination High Lateral Coordination
Low
High
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
228
7.6.3 – PROPOSITION ELEVEN
Proposition eleven considers the relationship between unit autonomy and
interactive governance within an RCB/M system. Proposition eleven reads: Units will
experience lower levels of decision-making autonomy in HEIs that have implemented
RCB/M and employ an interactive control form of governance. This proposition proposes
an inverse relationship between unit autonomy and interactive control forms of
governance. The more interactive a central administration becomes the lower the
autonomy of unit-level decision-making. Surprisingly the data suggests that interactive
control forms of governance may act to encourage high levels of unit autonomy.
However, due to the employment of a hybrid control form of governance at Midwestern
U.S. University and Central Canadian University the following matrix will include a hybrid
category.
Table 18: Governance Control Forms and Unit Autonomy
Governance Control Forms Levels of Unit Autonomy
Low High
Diagnostic Western Canadian University
Eastern U.S. University
Interactive
Hybrid
Midwestern U.S. University
Central Canadian University
229
CHAPTER 8
CONCLUSION
SECTION 8.1 – INTRODUCTION
This study was conducted to provide further understanding of the roles that
institutional internal structure and governance control forms perform in universities
that use decentralized budgeting and management models. This research presents
empirical evidence which suggests public universities employing an RCB/M structure will
experience varying institutional outcomes depending upon the levels of vertical
coordination, lateral coordination, and unit autonomy present. Further, the findings
from this study suggest that the predominate use of an interactive or diagnostic
governance control form will have a material effect on the outcomes experienced by the
university.
It was expected that those universities employing a predominantly interactive
governance control form would experience higher levels of vertical and lateral
coordination, and because of the nature of RCB/M high levels of unit autonomy.
Furthermore, it was expected that those universities that employ a predominantly
diagnostic control form would experience lower levels of vertical and lateral
coordination, and high levels of unit autonomy. Both of these expectations found
support in this study.
230
These findings merit attention within future higher education research. Although
this study focuses on four public North American universities, the findings may be
applied to other universities that employ RCB/M.
This study has developed and presented the three-factor model of internal
structure in an effort to increase the understanding of behaviour and outcomes in public
RCB/M universities. To this end, the relationships between the three factors [vertical
coordination, lateral coordination, and unit autonomy] and governance control forms in
public universities that employ RCB/M models have been explored.
SECTION 8.2 - SUMMARY OF MAIN FINDINGS
The evidence presented in this study strongly suggests that vertical coordination
is the dominant of the three factors of internal structure. The levels of vertical
coordination present at an institution not only impacted the levels of cooperation and
coordination between the central administration and units, but also had an effect on the
relationships between units and the resulting levels of lateral coordination. When
institutions had high levels of vertical coordination higher levels of coordination were
reported by respondents between units; higher levels of unit- and institutional-level
goal achievement were also reported. This was consistent at all of the institutions
regardless of the governance control form in use.
The data suggests that high levels of vertical coordination are encouraged by the
use of predominantly interactive governance control forms. In itself this was an
important finding of this study. The evidence presented in this study suggests that the
231
choice of governance control form, either interactive or diagnostic, should not be
considered as a binary. Within the current sample of universities, a purely interactive
governance control form was not identified. Rather, it was found that Midwestern U.S.
University and Central Canadian University employed what should be considered a
hybrid governance control form that relies predominantly on interactive techniques
while incorporating diagnostic elements. The data suggests that this hybrid structure
encouraged a collegial form of decision-making providing individual units with high
levels of autonomy while permitting the central administration to bring to bear specific
policies, procedures and expectations to align the efforts and resource allocation
decision-making of the units to the institution’s goals and direction. Predominantly
interactive control forms were shown to facilitate the alignment of effort and resource
allocation of the central administration and units, resulting in reported high levels of
institutional and unit goal achievement. It was also noted that hybrid governance
control forms encourage interaction and cooperation that is collegial in nature. This
supports the findings of Simons (1995, 2000) and Otley (1999) and extends the
management control systems literature to include collegially governed institutions, such
as universities.
The data suggests that vertical coordination and governance control form had a
meaningful impact on the levels of lateral coordination at the four universities. Although
such findings have been discussed and predicted within the management control
systems literature they have been largely untested (Otley et al., 1995). Interactive and
hybrid control forms encouraged high levels of lateral coordination at Central Canadian
232
University and Midwestern U.S. University. Conversely, the data suggests that diagnostic
control forms appear to produce low levels of lateral coordination and results in
relatively high levels of reported conflict and competition between units. The data also
suggested that lateral coordination impacts organizational goal achievement with low
levels of lateral coordination encouraging competition between units resulting in a zero-
sum game; informants reported that this internal conflict between units hindered the
achievement of institutional goals. This was consistent with prior work conducted by
Weigelt and Miller (2013) in the banking industry, Mayer and Salomon (2006) in
information technology, and the predicted relationships outlined by Cyert and March
(1963) and Lawrence and Lorsch (1967).
High levels of unit autonomy were detected at all four of the universities. This
finding is not surprising as high levels of funding authority and task accountability are
foundational to the RCB/M model. However, the levels of unit autonomy did not seem
to be impacted by interactive or hybrid governance control forms. This was unexpected
because both interactive and hybrid governance control forms encourage centrally
coordinated administrative influence over unit decision-making. Interestingly, when
governance control forms were employed either interactively, or in a hybrid manner, a
strengthening of the collegial processes of decision-making and communication was
reported.
The role that governance control forms play in the vertical relationship between
the central administration and units, and laterally between units is material. There was
233
evidence that diagnostic governance control forms employed at Eastern U.S. University
and Western Canadian University were not congruent with the RCB/M model employed
and led to conflicts within these universities. Nevertheless, the conflict ridden nature of
these two universities was not solely caused by the tension between the diagnostic
control forms and the RCB/M structure but rather was the manifestation of many issues
and decisions made over the course of time. Additionally, the data suggested that
diagnostic control forms hindered the accomplishment of institutional goals due to the
inter-unit and vertical unit/central administrative conflicts. Simply stated, in these two
cases, diagnostic governance control conflicted with the fundamental premises of unit
task authority and task accountability promoted by the RCB/M model. However, it
should be noted that, as per Simon’s (2005) findings, diagnostic control forms can be
used in decentralized environments when units are allowed to act autonomously and
the institution focuses on bottom-up decision-making. In order to successfully employ a
diagnostic governance control form to a decentralized environment while still
encouraging increased levels of vertical and lateral coordination unit level leadership
needs to fully understand both their own operations and strategies, and also being
cognizant and include the institution’s direction and needs into unit level planning and
decision-making.
SECTION 8.3 – IMPLICATIONS FOR THEORY
The findings of this study have several implications for theory. First, this study
presents a new organizational model of internal structure that is applicable in the higher
234
education context as well as to the broader area of organizational investigations. In the
higher education context, this model is intended to extend our understanding of the
RCB/M phenomenon and its impact on the university. Further, it is intended to provide
predictions as to the outcomes of RCB/M’s use with regard to various governance
control forms and to provide a testable theoretical base for a literature that has been
predominately descriptive in nature.
This model is also intended to be comprehensive and not industry-specific; this
was done to promote basic research that is not hindered by industry-specific realities
(Anthony, 1965; Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967). The hope is that this lack of specificity will
result in research that is focused on investigating larger, hierarchical organizations, such
as the modern university, and that future research will be rooted in the behavioral
sciences, and be tested and modified in a variety of industries (Thompson, 2011).
Second, the application of management control systems, through the use of
governance control forms, to the higher education literature is unique (Bisbe & Otley
2004; Otley et al., 1995). The findings of this study suggest that an intimate
understanding of governance control forms is needed both in the planning and
evaluation phases of RCB/M (Simons, 1995). With a better understanding of how to
incorporate management and oversight processes, procedures and protocols higher
levels of vertical and lateral coordination may be achieved while encouraging high levels
of unit autonomy.
235
Third, this study identified the importance of the role of leadership, with specific
emphasis on the Provost (Courant & Knepp, 2002). Leaders were reported to wield
substantial influence and power within the RCB/M environment (Strauss & Curry, 2002;
Whalen, 2002). The approach of the individual leader was shown to have a significant
impact for both vertical and lateral coordination at the institutions. As Whalen (1991)
noted, “not every institution possesses strong leadership characterized by a willingness
to communicate and participatory management” (p. 162). At Midwestern U.S. University
and Central Canadian University such participatory management is fostered by the
Provost through the use of discretionary funding; this was reported as being essential to
increasing the levels of vertical and lateral coordination and, although not unique to
RCB/M, is an important finding. Although these centrally allocated discretionary funds
can be considered a modification to traditional RCB/M, they have been shown to be
essential in the successful use of RCB/M. Additionally, these discretionary funds have
allowed the central administration at Central Canadian University and Midwestern U.S.
University to take a soft power approach to the interactions with units. This soft power
approach is reported to encourage collegial processes, and promote interactions and
discussions rather than relying on edicts and declarations.
Finally, the role of the external funding environment, especially salient for
publically funded universities, was noted frequently by respondents and provides a new
contribution to the RCB/M literature. Discussions regarding the ‘austerity narrative’ at
Eastern U.S. University, Midwestern U.S. University, and Western Canadian University
explored the striking effect that resource constraint had on institutional and unit
236
resource allocation decision-making. Although decreasing public funding has been the
norm for public universities in North America for some time (Deering & Sá, 2014; Dill &
Sporn, 1995), linking this reality to increasing conflict and competition inside universities
is unique. These findings support the observations in the higher education literature
(e.g. Gumport & Sporn, 1999; Gumport, 2012; Hearn & McLendon, 2012) with regard to
managing the complexities of the higher education institution in the modern era.
SECTION 8.4 – IMPLICATIONS FOR FUTURE RESEARCH
Although this study focuses on a small population of four public universities, the
implications for research in higher education, and more generally in organizational
studies, are numerous. This study has provided a foundation for further unlocking the
‘black box’ of internal organizational structure and the application of governance control
forms in an attempt to provide further understanding of power dynamics, resource
allocation decision-making, goal achievement, mission alignment, and vertical and
lateral interactions and relationships. Sufficient support was found for the vertical
coordination, lateral coordination, and unit autonomy factors. Further quantitative
analysis of these factors through either a principal component analysis or confirmatory
factor analysis using sequential equation modelling should be conducted to determine if
each of the three factors are unique. Through this analysis it may be found that the
variations in the three proposed factors can be explained by the variation in one, or two
of the variables.
237
Future studies should question how the university’s internal structure affects
governance choice, and how governance choice hinders or encourages coordination
within the institution. The rather scant attention paid to the influence of internal
structure and governance control form is surprising given the role of internal structure
for the direction of knowledge flows (Weigelt & Miller, 2013) and the impact on goal
achievement and mission alignment. Future scholarship should consider the university’s
allocation of decision rights to units and the coordination among those units and among
the units and the central administration (Lawrence & Lorsch, 1967; Milgrom & Roberts,
1992). Further investigation is also called for to examine how internal structure can
affect the university’s ability to efficiently encourage coordination and cooperation by
its units (Grant, 1996) and the effective allocation of resources (Bower, 1986).
Additionally, investigation is needed to further explore how universities provide for
incentives to encourage lateral coordination between units, and promote the
achievement of unit and institutional goals through increased vertical coordination
(Cyert & March, 1963; Grant, 1996; Milgrom & Roberts, 1992). Through such studies an
increased understanding of the university as an organization can be established,
allowing for a more complete understanding of how internal structure affects, and is
affected by, governance control forms (Demsetz, 1993). The result would be a
substantial contribution to the literature on budgeting, and management in higher
education.
With specific focus on governance control forms there continues to be a need for
research that focusses on management control systems beyond those employed in
238
classically hierarchical organizations. This study has provided a starting point for such
research through the examination of governance control forms in universities employing
decentralized decision-making and resource allocation structures. Further, more
research is needed into the use of governance control forms beyond their use as merely
an exercise of power (Otley et al., 1995). Research into the social, cultural and
contextual power of governance control forms needs to be pursued. Finally, more
research is needed to provide insight into how universities, and organizations more
generally, can develop effective rules and procedures that allow for the regulation of
lateral and vertical interactions while encouraging unit leaders to act with flexibility and
timeliness, engage in meaningful dialogue, share information, and promote
organizational mission achievement.
SECTION 8.5 – IMPLICATIONS FOR PRACTICE
The findings and analysis of this study have practical implications for those
interested in the management and finance of higher education institutions, and
specifically, for those institutional leaders whose university uses or is considering the
use of RCB/M. The findings of this study suggest that it is critical for university
leadership to understand the relationship between governance control forms and the
decentralization of resource allocation decision-making. Further, it is essential that
leadership understands the important role it plays in aligning unit efforts to achieving
institutional goals. Evidence suggests that through the use of soft power and a
predominantly interactive control form, supported by diagnostic rules, processes and
239
principles, the promise of efficiency and effectiveness provided by RCB/M can be
achieved while limiting conflict and competition within the institution. That is, it is vital
that the application of RCB/M at universities be done in such a way that the appropriate
governance control forms are in place to protect the mission and collegiality of the
institution.
Furthermore, during the evaluation, planning and development stages of RCB/M,
and during the review stages for those universities that currently employ RCB/M, the
factors of vertical coordination, lateral coordination, and unit autonomy must all be
considered. The design of RCB/M must be conscious and purposefully tailored to the
institution. The design process must include a review of institutional systems to ensure
that they interface with RCB/M in a manner that encourages vertical and lateral
coordination and the achievement of institutional objectives. As noted in this study,
RCB/M is most effective when it is supported by an influential and finally strong central
administration that employs a predominately interactive governance control form,
support by diagnostic elements. For those universities deliberating the use of RCB/M,
conscious consideration and planning must be given to governance control form
selection, and the development of processes, procedures and protocols that support the
three factors presented in this study. As the evidence provided in this study suggests,
the interplay between these three factors and governance control forms can encourage
positive or negative organizational outcomes. While the institutional contexts of the
four universities examined differed, the use of interactive governance control forms and
consultative leadership techniques increased the effectiveness of RCB/M. To promote
240
positive organizational outcomes institutional leaders should work to encourage
transparency and employ consultative management practices through a predominately
interactive governance control form that is supported by diagnostic systems,
procedures, and sanctions. This structure should provide an environment that promotes
coordination while allowing for creative and entrepreneurial behaviour across all
institutional levels.
Finally, it is important to note that the use of RCB/M does not merely change the
budgeting structure of the university. Rather, as Lang (1999b) argues, it affects each and
every aspect of the institution. As such, a holistic evaluation and planning process that
includes budgeting, finance, management, oversight, reporting, and collegial inter-unit
processes should be applied during the planning phase based on the three-factor model
of internal structure. Subsequently, during RCB/M reviews all aspects of the RCB/M
model should be evaluated using the presented three-factor model, with consideration
of the governance control form in use at the institution. The findings of this study
suggests those institutions that critically review and enact changes to improve the
RCB/M model reported increased engagement from faculty and administration, lower
levels of competition and conflict, and increased levels of vertical and lateral
coordination. For RCB/M to remain institutionally relevant, a systematic process of
review and adjustment is required every five years. However, as noted in this study, a
formal mechanism is necessary to address any material issues or conflicts related to the
RCB/M model that arise between reviews. It is critical that this mechanism engage both
faculty and administrative leadership.
241
SECTION 8.6 – SUMMARY CONCLUSIONS
This study has shown that, as predicted, the two universities employing a
predominantly interactive governance control form experienced relatively high levels of
vertical and lateral coordination with RCB/M encouraging high levels of unit autonomy.
It was also shown that the two universities employing a predominantly diagnostic
control form experienced low levels of vertical and lateral coordination, and RCB/M
encouraging high levels of unit autonomy. However, the relationship between
diagnostic control forms and low levels of vertical and lateral coordination is not causal
and as discussed earlier, diagnostic control forms can be successfully employed in
decentralized environments with the appropriate organizational culture and
management focus.
Furthermore, this study builds a three-factor model of internal structure that is
explored through the consideration of a sample of four public universities employing
RCB/M models. The implications of this study for universities currently employing or
considering RCB/M are numerous. This three-factor model of internal structure provides
a foundation for the exploration of the role of governance control forms in universities
that employ decentralized budgeting and management models. Furthermore, it is
envisioned that this model will be valuable for those university leaders considering the
implementation of an RCB/M structure or those reviewing the use of such structures at
their institution.
242
Further investigation in different organizational contexts, utilizing a quantitative
research methodology, including larger samples, both in terms of respondents and
institutions, is needed. Additionally, further investigation into private universities is
required to explore the similarities and differences compared with the public
universities examined in this study. Differences in revenue sources, regulatory and
reporting responsibilities, stakeholder groups, and government involvement in setting of
strategic direction and goals may all create differing outcomes and may provide for an
extension of this study’s findings. However, due to the low levels of public funding [as a
percentage of total university revenue] provided to Midwestern U.S. University and
Eastern U.S. University I would expect substantial similarities if this study were
replicated utilizing a sample of private universities.
The exploration of internal structure, governance, and relationships within
universities provided in this study should help guide scholarship in higher education
finance, budgeting, and governance, and should encourage researchers to confront
concepts and relationships neglected in the postsecondary literature.
243
REFERENCES
Abernathy, M., & Chua, W. (1996). Field study of control system 'redesign': The impact of institutional process on strategic choice. Contemporary Accounting Research, 13(2), 569-606.
Adams, E. (1997). Rationality in the academy: Why responsibility center budgeting is a wrong road. Change: The Magazine of Higher Learning, 29(5), 58-61.
Alchian, A., & Demsetz, H. (1972). Production, information costs and the economics of organization. American Economic Review, 62(December), 777-795.
Alexander, J. (1991). Adaptive change in corporate control practices. Academy of Management Journal, 34(1), 162-193.
Alexander, V. (1998). Environmental constraints and organizational strategies: Complexity, conflict, and coping in the nonprofit sector. In Powell, W. & Clemens, E. (Eds.) Private Action and the Public Good (pp. 272-290). New Haven, CT: Yale University Press.
Allen, I., & Seaman, J. (2008). Staying the course: Online education in the United States. Retrieved from http://sloanconsortium.org/publications/survey/staying_course
Altbach, P. (1999). The logic of mass higher education. Tertiary Education & Management, 5(2), 107-124.
Alvesson, M., & Karreman, D. (2004). Interfaces of control: Technocratic and socio-ideological control in a global management consultancy firm. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 29(3), 423-444.
American Association of University Professors. (1966). Statement on Government of Colleges and Universities. Retrieved from http://www.aaup.org/report/1966-statement-government-colleges-and-universities
Anderson, R. (1988). The economy and higher education. Teachers College, 3(1), 12.
Anthony, R. (1965). Planning and control systems: A framework for analysis. Boston, MA: Division of Research, Graduate School of Business Administration, Harvard University.
Barnard, C. (1968). The Functions of the Executive. Boston, MA: Harvard University Press.
244
Bass, B., & Avolio, B. (1994). Improving organizational effectiveness through transformational leadership. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Becker, S., & Gordon, G. (1966). An entrepreneurial theory of formal organizations, part I: Patterns of formal organizations. Administrative Science Quarterly, 11(3), 315-344.
Behn, R. (2003). Why measure performance? Different purposes require different measures. Public Administration Review, 63(5), 586-606.
Ben-Ruwin, M. (2010). The corporatization of shared governance. Paper presented at the American Association of University Professors Shared Governance Conference and Workshops, Washington, DC. Retrieved from http://old.suny.edu/facultysenate/TheCorporatizationofSharedGovernance.pdf
Benjamin, R., Carroll, S., Gray, M., Krop, C., & Shires, M. (1993). The Redesign of Governance in Higher Education. Santa Monica, CA: RAND.
Berdahl, R., Altbach, P., & Gumport, P. (2011). Introduction: The contexts of American higher education. In P. G. Altbach, Patricia J. Gumport, Robert O. Berdahl (Ed.), American Higher Education in the Twenty-First Century Social, Political, and Economic Challenges (pp. 1-11). Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Bettinger, E., & Long, B. (2004). Do college instructors matter? The effects of adjuncts and graduate assistants on students' interests and success. Retreieved from http://www.nber.org/papers/w10370
Bettinger, E., & Long, B. (2006). The increasing use of Adjunct Instructors at public institutions: Are we hurting students?. In Ehrenberg, R. (Ed.), Assessing Public Higher Education at the Start of the 21st Century (pp. 51-69). Retrieved from https://www.tiaacrefinstitute.org/public/pdf/institute/research/trends_issues/tr_070105b.pdf
Birnbaum, R. (1988). How Colleges Work. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Birnbaum, R. (1991). How Colleges Work: The Cybernetics of Academic Organization and Leadership. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Birnbaum, R. (2000). The life cycle of academic management fads. Journal of Higher Education, 71(1), 1-16.
Birnbaum, R., & Edelson, P. (1989). How Colleges Work: The cybernetics of academic organization and leadership. The Journal of Continuing Higher Education, 37(3), 27-29.
245
Bisbe, J., & Otley, D. (2004). The effects of the interactive use of management control systems on product innovation. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 29(8), 709-737.
Blau, P. (1973). The Organization of Academic Work. New Brunswick, NJ: Transaction Publishers.
Bobbitt, H., & Ford, J. (1980). Decision-maker choice as a determinant of organizational structure. Academy of Management Review, 5(1), 13-23.
Bok, D. (2003). Universities in the Marketplace: The commercialization of higher education. Princeton, NJ: Princeton University Press.
Borg, W., & Gall, M. (1989). Educational Research. White Plains, NY: Longman.
Bourgeois, L., & Astley, W. (1979). A strategic model of organizational conduct and performance. International Studies of Management & Organization, 9(3), 40-66.
Bourgeois, L., & Eisenhardt, K. (1988). Politics of strategic decision making in high-velocity environments: Toward a midrange theory. Academy of Management Journal, 31(4), 737-770.
Bowen, H. (1980). The Costs of Higher Education. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Bower, G. (1970). Organizational factors in memory. Cognitive Psychology, 1(1), 18-46.
Bower, J. (1986). Managing the resource allocation process: A study of corporate planning and investment. Boston, MA: Harvard Business Review Press.
Brinkman, P. (1989). Instructional costs per student credit hour: Differences by level of instruction. Journal of Education Finance, 15(1), 34-52.
Brinkman, P., & Morgan, A. (1997). Changing fiscal strategies for planning. In J. Yeager, G. Nelson, E. Potter, J. Weidman, & T. Zullo (Eds.), ASHE reader on finance in higher education (pp. 425-436). Boston, MA: Pearson Custom Publishing.
Bryson, J. (2011). Strategic Planning for Public and Nonprofit Organizations: A guide to strengthening and sustaining organizational achievement (Vol. 1). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Buck, J. (2002). Distancing Education. Paper presented at the Oregon Conference of the American Association of University Professors. Portland, OR.
246
Bunce, P., Fraser, R., & Woodcock, L. (1995). Advanced budgeting: A journey to advanced management systems. Management Accounting Research, 6(3), 253-265.
Burgelman, R. (1983). A process model of internal corporate venturing in the diversified major firm. Administrative Science Quarterly, 28(2), 223-244.
Burgess, T., & Pratt, J. (1970). Policy and Practice: The colleges of advanced technology. London, UK: Allen Lane.
Burns, T., & Stalker, G. (1961). The Management of Innovation. University of Illinois: Urbana-Champaign's Academy for Entrepreneurial Leadership historical Research Reference in Entrepreneurship.
Camerer, C., & Knez, M. (1996). Coordination, organizational boundaries and fads in business practices. Industrial and Corporate Change, 5(1), 89-122.
Cameron, K. (1978). Measuring organizational effectiveness in institutions of higher education. Administrative Science Quarterly, 23, 604-632.
Cameron, K. (1981). Domains of organizational effectiveness in colleges and universities. Academy of Management Journal, 24(1), 25-47.
Cameron, K. (1986). Effectiveness as paradox: Consensus and conflict in conceptions of organizational effectiveness. Management Science, 32(5), 539-553.
Cameron, K., & Whetten, D. (1983). Organizational Effectiveness: A comparison of multiple models. Ann Arbor, MI: University of Michigan Academic Press, Vol. 733.
Cameron, K., Mora, C., Leutscher, T., & Calarco, M. (2011). Effects of positive practices on organizational effectiveness. The Journal of Applied Behavioral Science, 47(3), 266-308.
Cantor, N., & Courant, P. (1997). Budgets and budgeting at the University of Michigan: A work in progress. Ann Arbor, MI: The University Record.
Carnaghi, J. (1992). " Set, Go--Ready": Planning for Responsibility Center Budgeting (Doctoral dissertation, Indiana University).
Carnes, B. (1987). The campus cost explosion: College tuitions are unnecessairly high. Policy Review, 40, 68-71.
247
Cekic, O. (2010). Budgeting and Organizational Culture: Exploring responsibility center management (RCM) and cultural change at a public university. Saabrucken: Lambert Academic Publishing.
Central Canadian University. (1994). A Proposal for Integrating ISE and FEUT within Central Canadian University. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2003). Condensed Financial Report. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2006). Task Force to Review Approach to Budgeting Final Report. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2007). Fund Groups Used at Central Canadian University. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2009). Central Canadian University 2009-10 Budget Report and Long Range Budget Guidelines 2009-10 to 2013-14. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2011a). Review of the New Budget Model. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2011b). Central Canadian University Budget Report 2011-12 and Long Range Budget Guidelines 2011-12 to 2015-16. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2012a). Central Canadian University 2012 Budget Brief. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2012b). Transition to a New Budget Model: Central Canadian University Experience After 5 Years. Presentation at the Canadian Association of University Budget Officers, Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2013a). Quick Facts. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2013b). Long Range Budget Guidelines 2013-14 to 2017-18 and Budget Report 2013-14. Central Canadian University.
Central Canadian University. (2014). Mission and Purpose. Central Canadian University.
Chaffee, E. (1983). The role of rationality in university budgeting. Research in Higher Education, 19(4), 387-406.
248
Chandler, A. (1962). Strategy and Sturcture: Chapters in the history of the American industrial enterprise. Cambridge, MA: MIT Press.
Cheit, E. (1971). The New Depression in Higher Education: A Study of Financial Conditions at 41 Colleges and Universities. Hightstown, NJ: McGraw-Hill.
Cheit, E. (1973). The New Depression in Higher Education-Two Years Later. Hightstown, NJ: McGraw-Hill.
Clark, B. (1960). The Open Door College: A case study. New York, NY: McGraw-Hill.
Clark, B. (1972). The organizational saga in higher education. Administrative Science Quarterly, 17(2), 178-184.
Clark, B. (1986). The higher education system: Academic organization in cross-national perspective. Berkley, CA: University of California Press.
Clark, B. (1998). Creating Entrepreneurial Universities. Oxford: IAU Press.
Clark, B. (2001). The entrepreneurial university: New foundations for collegiality, autonomy, and achievement. Higher Education Management, 13(2), 9-24.
Clark, K., & Fujimoto, T. (1991). Product Development Process. Boston, MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Clotfelter, C., Ehrenberg, R., Getz, M., & Siegfried, J. (1991). Introduction to" Economic Challenges in Higher Education" Economic Challenges in Higher Education (pp. 1-16). Chicago, IL: University of Chicago Press.
Clower, R. (1965). The Keynesian counterrevolution: a theoretical appraisal. The Theory of Interest Rates, 103, 270-297.
Clower, R., & Howitt, P. (1978). The transactions theory of the demand for money: a reconsideration. The Journal of Political Economy, 86(3), 449-466.
Coaldrake, P., Stedman, L., & Little, P. (2003). Issues in Australian University Governance. Brisbane: QUT.
Courant, P., & Knepp, M. (2002). Budgeting with the UB Model at the University of Michigan. Ann Arbor, Michigan: The University of Michigan.
Creswell, J. (1998). Qualitative Inquiry and Research Design: Choosing Among Five Designs. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
249
Crotts, J., Dickson, D., & Ford, R. (2005). Aligning organizational processes with mission: The case of service excellence. The Academy of Management Executive, 19(3), 54-68.
Cyert, R. (1981). Management science and university management. New Directions for Higher Education, 1981(35), 27-40.
Dearlove, J. (1997). The academic labour process: From collegiality and professionalism to managerialism and proletarianisation? Higher Education Review, 30(1), 56-75.
DeCanio, S., Dibble, C., & Amir-Atefi, K. (2000). The importance of organizational structure for the adoption of innovations. Management Science, 46(10), 1285-1299.
Deem, R., & Brehony, K. (2005). Management as ideology: The case of ‘new managerialism’in higher education. Oxford Review of Education, 31(2), 217-235.
Deering, D. & Sá, C. (2014) Financial management of canadian universities: Adaptive strategies to fiscal constraints. Tertiary Education and Management, In Press.
Demsetz, H. (1993). The theory of the firm revisited. In N. J. Foss (Ed.), Theories of Firm: Critical Perspectives on Business and Management. New York, NY: Routledge.
Denzin, N. (1970). The research act in sociology: A theoretical introduction to sociological methods. Piscataway, New Jersey: Transaction Publishers.
Denzin, N., & Lincoln, Y. (2005). The Sage handbook of qualitative research. Thousand Oaks, California: Sage.
Dill, D., & Sporn, B. (1995). Emerging patterns of social demand and university reform. Issues in Higher Education.
Drucker, P. (1946). The Concept ofthe Corporation. New York, NY: New American Library.
Drucker, P. (1994). The theory of the business. Harvard Business Review, 72(5), 95-104.
Duncan, S., Brunner, L., & Fiske, D. (1979). Strategy signals in face-to-face interaction. Journal of Personality and Social Psychology, 37(2), 301.
Eastern U.S. University. (2000). Eastern U.S. University Officials Announce New Decentralized Budget Model that Makes Campus More Efficient, Accountable, Adaptable. Eastern U.S. University.
250
Eastern U.S. University. (2005). Five Year RCM Review: Executive Summary. Eastern U.S. University.
Eastern U.S. University. (2009). 2009/2010 RCM Review. Eastern U.S. University.
Eastern U.S. University. (2010). Proposed Changes to RCM: Status Update. Eastern U.S. University.
Eastern U.S. University. (2011). RCM Manual. Eastern U.S. University.
Eastern U.S. University. (2013). Financial Report FY13. Eastern U.S. University.
Ehrenberg, R. (2000). Tuition Rising: Why college costs so much. Boston, MA: Harvard University Press.
Ehrenberg, R., & Rizzo, M. (2004). Financial forces and the future of American higher education. Academe, 90(4), 28-31.
Ehrenberg, R. (2012). American higher education in transition. The Journal of Economic Perspectives, 26(1), 193-216.
Eisenhardt, K. (1989). Building theories from case study research. The Academy of Management Review, 14(4), 532-550.
Elgass, J. (1995). Implementation Team Turns in VCM Recommendations, The University Record. Retrieved from http://ur.umich.edu/9495/Mar27_95/3.htm
Elsas, R., Hackethal, A., & Holzhäuser, M. (2010). The anatomy of bank diversification. Journal of Banking & Finance, 34(6), 1274-1287.
Emmanuel, C., Otley, D., & Merchant, K. (1990). Accounting for Management Control (2nd ed.). Cornwall, U.K.: Chapman and Hall.
Erakovic, L., & Overall, J. (2010). Opening the 'black box': Challenging traditional governance theorems. Journal of Management and Organization, 16, 250-265.
Fahey, L. (1981). On strategic management decision processes. Strategic Management Journal, 2(1), 43-60.
Fisher, D., Rubenson, K., Jones, G., & Shanahan, T. (2009). The political economy of post-secondary education: A comparison of British Columbia, Ontario and Québec. Higher Education, 57(5), 549-566.
251
Fiss, P. (2008). Institutions and Corporate Governance. The Sage Handbook of Organizational Institutionalism, 389-410.
Flamholtz, E. (1983). Accounting, budgeting and control systems in their organizational context: Theoretical and empirical perspectives. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 8(2/3), 35-50.
Ford, J., & Slocum, J. (1977). Size, technology, environment and the structure of organizations. Academy of Management Review, 2(4), 561-575.
Fredrickson, J. (1986). The strategic decision process and organizational structure. Academy of Management Review, 11(2), 280-297.
Fuchsberg, G. (1989). Several big universities give fiscal autonomy to divisions, but the system has its risks, as Johns Hopkins Case Shows. Chronicle of Higher Education, 35(20), 25-27.
Galbraith, J. (1970). American Capitalism: The Concept of Countervailing Power. New Brunswick, NJ: Transaction Publishers.
Galbraith, J. (1973). Designing Complex Organizations. Boston, MA: Addison-Wesley Longman Publishing Co., Inc.
Galbraith, J. (1977). Organization Design. Reading, MA: Addison-Wesley.
Galbraith, J. (1994). A Short History of Financial Euphoria. New York, NY: Penguin Books.
Galbraith, J. (2002). Designing Organizations. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Garner, S. (2008). Transition to a New Budget Model at the University of Toronto. Canadian Association of University Budget Officers.
Ghemawat, P., & Costa, J. (1993). The organizational tension between static and dynamic efficiency. Strategic Management Journal, 14(S2), 59-73.
Gibson, A. (2009). Budgeting in higher education. In E. D. o. t. G. C. o. S. d. Adventists (Ed.). Silver Springs, MD.
Goldstein, L. (2005). College and university budgeting: An introduction for faculty and academic administrators. National Association of College and University Business Officers.
252
Gond, J., Grubnic, S., Herzig, C., & Moon, J. (2012). Configuring management control systems: Theorizing the integration of strategy and sustainability. Management Accounting Research, 23(3), 205-223.
Goodman, P., Atkin, R., & Schoorman, F. (1983). On the Demise of Organizational Effectiveness Studies. In Cameron, S. & Whetten, D. (Eds.), Organizational Effectiveness: A comparison of multiple models. New York, NY: Academic Press.
Goodwin, D., & de Gouw, B. (1997). Budgetary response attitudes in a university environment. International Journal of Educational Management, 11(4), 179-186.
Govindarajan, V. (1986). Decentralization, strategy and effectiveness of strategic business units in multibusiness organizations. Academy of Management Review, 11(4), 844-856.
Grant, R. (1996). Toward a knowledge-based theory of the firm. Strategic Management Journal, 17(Winter Special Issue), 19-122.
Gros Louis, K., & Thompson, M. (2002). Responsibility Center Budgeting and Management at Indiana University. In Priest, D., Becker, W., Hossler, D. & St. John, E. (Eds.) Incentive-based Budgeting Systems in Public Universities. Cheltenham, UK: Elgar.
Gumport, P. (2000). Academic restructuring: Organizational change and institutional imperatives. Higher Education, 39(1), 67-91.
Gumport, P. (2008). Sociology of Higher Education: Contributions and their contexts. Baltimore, Maryland: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Gumport, P. (2012). Strategic thinking in higher education research. In M.N. Bastedo (Ed.), The Organization of Higher Education: Managing colleges for a new era, (pp. 18-44). Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Gumport, P., & Sporn, B. (1999). Institutional adaptation: Demands for management reform and university administration. Stanford, CA: National Center for Postsecondary Improvement.
Hall, D., & Saias, M. (1980). Strategy follows structure. Strategic Management Journal, 1(2), 149-163.
Halpin, D., & Troyna, B. (1995). Researching education policy: Ethical and methodological issues. British Journal of Educational Studies, 43(4), 468-470.
253
Hanover Research Council (2008). Responsibility Centre Management at Major Public Universities: Prepared for the University of California, Berkley.
Hanlon, P., & Schweitzer, G. (2008). Budgeting with the UB Model at the University of Michigan. Ann Arbor, MI: University of Michigan.
Hansen, S., Otley, D., & Van der Stede, W. (2003). Practice developments in budgeting: An overview and research perspective. Journal of Management Accounting Research, 15, 95-116.
Hart, A. (2012). Budget Model Redesign — Responsibility-Centered Management (RCM) Retrieved November 23, 2013, from http://president.arizona.edu/memos_letters/budget-model-redesign-%E2%80%94-responsibility-centered-management-rcm.
Hassel, L. (1993). Budgetary participation: Moderating the incongruence in budget emphasis between the superior and subordinate. Paper presented at the European Accounting Congress, Turku, Findland.
Hawley, A., Boland, W., & Boland, M. (1965). Population size and administration in institutions of higher education. American Sociological Review, 30(2), 252-255.
Hearn, J. (2006). Alternative Revenue Sources. In D. M. Priest & E. P. St. John (Eds.), Privatization and Public Universities (pp. 87-108).
Hearn, J., Lewis, D., Kallsen, L., Holdsworth, J., & Jones, L. (2006). Incentives for managed growth: A case study of incentives-based planning and budgeting in a large public research university. The Journal of Higher Education, 77(2), 286-316.
Hearn, J., & McLendon, M. (2012). Governance research: From adolescence toward maturity. In M.N. Bastedo (Ed.), The Organization of Higher Education: Managing colleges for a new era, (pp. 45-85). Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Hedberg, B., Bystrom, P., & Starbuck, W. (1976). Camping on seesaws: Prescriptions for a self-designing organization. Administrative Science Quarterly, 41-65.
Henri, J. (2006). Management control systems and strategy: A resource-based perspective. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 31(6), 529-558.
Hides, M., Davies, J., & Jackson, S. (2004). Implementation of EFQM excellence model self-assessment in the UK higher education sector–lessons learned from other sectors. The TQM Magazine, 16(3), 194-201.
254
Hirsch, W., & Weber, L. (2001). Governance in Higher Education: The university in a state of flux. Paris: Economica Ltd.
Holian, M., & Ross, J. (2010). Managing the Internal Organization of Colleges and Universities. In Hall, J. (Ed.) Doing More with Less. New York, NY: Springer (pp. 217-234).
Huddleston, M. (2009). Letter regarding University budget, April 2009. Eastern U.S. University.
Huddleston, M. (2010). Breaking Silos, Transorming Lives, Reimagining Eastern U.S. University: Eastern U.S. University in 2020. Eastern U.S. University.
Huddleston, M. (2014). State of the University 2014. Eastern U.S. University.
Inman, P., Schütze, H., & Adam, M. (2010). The Community Engagement and Service Mission of Universities. Leicester, UK: NIACE.
Jarvie, D. (2002). The effect of responsbility centre budgeting/responsible centre management on the rold of academic deans in a public university. University of Lethbridge, Lethbridge, Alberta.
Jones, D. (1984). Higher-education Budgeting at the State Level: Concepts and principles. National Center for Higher Education Managements Systems.
Jones, G. (2010). Organizational Theory, Design, and Change. Upper Saddle River, New Jersey: Prentice Hall.
Kanter, R. (2001). Evolve! Succeeding in the digital culture of tomorrow. Boston, MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Kaplan, G. (2004). Do governance structures matter? Restructuring shared governance. Higher Education(127), 23-24.
Kapu Arachchilage, N., & Smith, M. (2013). The effects of the diagnostic and interactive use of management control systems on the strategy performance relationship. Journal of Applied Management Accounting Research, 11(1), 9-28.
Keitiline, R., & Eugenio, A. (2010). Higher education in management: Reinventing the paradigm to gain the capacity to handle today's complexity. On the Horizon, 18(1), 45-52.
Keller, G. (1983). Academic Strategy: The management revolution in American higher education: Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
255
Kennedy, D. (1993). Making Choices in the Research University. In J. R. Cole, E. G. Barger & S. R. Graubard (Eds.), The Research University in a Time of Discontent. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Kerr, C. (1982). “The uses of the university” Two decades later: Postscript. Change: The Magazine of Higher Learning, 14(7), 23-31.
Kerr, C. (2001). The uses of the university. Boston, MA: Harvard University Press.
Kerr, C., Gade, M. L., & Kawaoka, M. (1994). Higher Education Cannot Escape History: Issues for the twenty-first century. Albany, NY: SUNY Press.
Kezar, A., & Eckel, P. (2004). Meeting today's governance challenges: A synthesis of the literature and examination of a future agenda for scholarship. The Journal of Higher Education, 75(4), 371-399.
Kirp, D. (2003). Shakespeare, Einstain, and the Bottom Line: The marketing of higher Education. Boston, MA: Harvard University Press.
Kirp, D., & Roberts, P. (2002). Mr. Jefferson's university breaks up. The Public Interest, (Summer), 70-84.
Kissler, G. (1997). Who decides which budgets to cut? The Journal of Higher Education, 68(4), 427-459.
Klein, P., & Saidenberg, M. (2008). Organizational structure and the diversification discount: Evidence from commercial banking. Journal of Industrial Economics, 58(1), 127-155.
Koch, R., Reynolds, K., & Rimai, M. (2012). Portland State University. Paper presented at the Winter Symposium 2012, Portland, Oregon.
Kohrs, K., & DeGraff, S. (2005). General Fund Budget Review: A study of perceptions. Ann Arbor, MI: The University of Michigan.
Kornai, J. (1986). The soft budget constraint. Kyklos, 39(1), 3-30.
Kretschmer, T., & Puranam, P. (2008). Integration through incentives within differentiated organizations. Organization Science, 19(6), 860-875.
Krippendorff, K. (2004). Reliability in content analysis. Human Communication Research, 30(3), 411-433.
256
Lang, D. (1999a). A primer on responsibility centre budgeting. Ottawa, ON: CSSHE Professional File.
Lang, D. (1999b). Responsibility centre budgeting and responsibility centre management in theory and practice. Higher Education Management, 11(3), 81-111.
Lang, D. (2001). Responsibility centre budgeting and responsibility centre management at the University of Toronto: Lessons from trial and error. Toronto, Ontario: The University of Toronto.
Lapsley, I. (1994). Responsibility accounting revived? Market reforms and budgetary control in health care. Management Accounting Research, 5(3), 337-352.
Lapworth, S. (2004). Arresting decline in shared governance: Towards a flexible model for academic participation. Higher Education Quarterly, 58(4), 299-314.
Lasher, W., & Greene, D. (1993). Epilogue College and University Budgeting: What Do We Know? What Do We Need to Know? Supplement to Lasher, W. and Greene, D. College and University Budgeting: What Do We Know?
Lasher, W., & Greene, D. (2001). College and University Budgeting: What do we know? What do we need to know? In J. Yeager, G. Nelson, E. Potter, J. Weidman, T. Zullo (Eds.) Finance in Higher Education. Boston, MA: Pearson Learning Solutions.
Lawrence, P., & Lorsch, J. (1967). Organizations and Environment: Managing Differentiation and Integration. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Lepori, B., Usher, J., & Montauti, M. (2013). Budgetary allocation and organizational characteristics of higher education institutions: a review of existing studies and a framework for future research. Higher Education, 65(1), 59-78.
Lijphart, A. (1975). The comparable-cases strategy in comparative research. Comparative Political Studies, 8(2), 158-177.
Lincoln, Y., & Guba, E. (1985). Naturalistic Inquiry. Newbury Park, CA: SAGE.
Lowe, E. (1971). On the idea of a management control system: Integrating accounting and management control. Journal of Management Studies, 8(1), 1-12.
Mahon, M. (2012). The University of Lethbridge - Alberta's Destination University: An Open Letter to our University Communities. Lethbridge, Alberta: University of Alberta.
257
Mallon, W. (2004). Disjointed governance in university centres and institutes. New Directions for Higher Education, 127, 61-74.
Malmi, T., & Brown, D. (2008). Management control systems as a package - opportunities, challenges and research directions. Management Accounting Research, 19(287-300).
March, J., & Simon, H. (1958). Organizations. University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign's Academy for Entrepreneurial Leadership Historical Research Reference in Entrepreneurship.
Marginson, S. (2003). Markets in higher education. National and global competition. Paper presented at the Nzare/AARE Joint Conference, Auckland, New Zealand.
Marginson, S., & Considine, M. (2000). The Enterprise University: Power, governance and reinvention in Australia. Cambridge, UK: Cambridge University Press.
Marshall, C., & Rossman, G. (1999). Designing Qualitative Research. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Martin, R. (2005). Cost Control, College Access, and Competition in Higher Education. Cheltenham, UK: Edward Elgar Publishing.
Mason, J. (2002). Qualitative Researching: Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Massy, W. (1989). Budget decentralization at Stanford University. Planning for Higher Education, 18(2), 39-55.
Massy, W. (1996). Resource Allocation in Higher Education. Ann Arbor: The University of Michigan Press.
Mayer, K., & Salomon, R. (2006). Capabilities, contractual hazards, and governance: Integrating resource-based and transaction cost perspectives. Academy of Management Journal, 49(5), 942-959.
McCann, J., & Galbraith, J. (1981). Interdepartmental Relations. In P. C. Nystrom & W. H. Starbuck (Eds.), Handbook of Organizational Design (Vol. 2, pp. 60-84). New York: Oxford University Press.
McConaghy, T. (1997). How Canadian universities are managing change. Phi Delta Kappan, 78(8), 660-661.
258
McGuinness, J., (1997). The Changing Structure of State Higher Education Leadership. In L. F. Goodchild (Ed.), Public Policy and Higher Education. Needham Heights, MA: Pearson Custom Publishing.
McMaster, M. (2007). Partnerships between administrative and academic managers: How deans and faculty managers work together. Retrieved September 13, 2013 http://trove.nla.gov.au/goto?i=x&w=153103788&d=http%3A%2F%2Fnla.gov.au%2Fnla.arc-10533%20http%3A%2F%2Fnla.gov.au%2Fnla.arc-10533-20021114-www.atem-%20aappa2002.qut.edu.au%2Fprogram%2Findex.html
Meisinger, R., & Dubeck, L. (1984). College and University Budgeting: An Introduction for Faculty and Academic Administrators. Washington, DC: National Association of College and University Business Officers.
Merchant, K. (1989). Rewarding Results: Motivating profit centre managers. Boston: Harvard Business School Press.
Merchant, K. (1998). Modern Management Control Systems: Text and cases. Upper Saddle River, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Merriam, S. (1988). Case Study Research in Education: A qualitative approach. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Merriam, S. (2009). Qualitative Research: A guide to Design and Implementation. San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass.
Metcalfe, A. (2010). Revisiting academic capitalism in Canada: No longer the exception. The Journal of Higher Education, 81(4), 489-514.
Metcalfe, A., Fisher, D., Gingras, Y., Jones, G., Rubenson, K., & Snee, I. (2011). Canada: Perspectives on governance and management. In W. Locke, W. Cummings, and D. Fisher (Eds.) Changing Governance and Management in Higher Education. (pp. 151-174). Netherlands: Springer.
Middlehurst, R. (2004). Changing internal governance: A discussion of leadership roles and management structures in UK universities. Higher Education Quarterly, 58(4), 258-279.
Midwestern U.S. University. (2005). The Midwestern U.S. University General Fund Budget Review: A Study of Perceptions. Midwestern U.S. University.
Midwestern U.S. University. (2013). Fact Book. Midwestern U.S. University.
259
Miles, M., & Hubermann, A. (1994). An Expanded Sourcebook: Qualitative Data Analysis. London: SAGE Publications Inc.
Miles, R., & Snow, C. (1984). Fit, failure and the hall of fame. California Management Review, 26(3), 10-28.
Miles, R., Snow, C., Meyer, A., & Coleman, H. (1978). Organizational strategy, structure, and process. Academy of Management Review, 3(3), 546-562.
Milgrom, P., & Roberts, J. (1990). Bargaining Costs, Influence Costs, and the Organization of Economic Activity. In J. Alt & K. Shepsle (Eds.), Perspectives on Positive Political Economy (pp. 57-89). New York: Cambridge University Press.
Milgrom, P., & Roberts, J. (1992). Economics, Organization and Management. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice Hall.
Miller, D. (1988). Relating Porter's business strategies to environment and structure: analysis and performance implications. Academy of Management Journal, 31(2), 280-308.
Miller, D., Droge, C., & Toulouse, J. (1988). Strategic process and content as mediators between organizational context and structure. Academy of Management Journal, 31(3), 544-569.
Miller, W., & Crabtree, B. (1992). A Template Approach to Text Analysis: Developing and using codebooks. In F. Crabtree (Ed.) Doing Qualitative Research. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publications.
Millett, J. (1962). The Academic Community: An essay on organization. New York: McGraw-Hill.
Mintzberg, H. (1979). The structuring of organizations: A synthesis of the research. University of Illinois at Urbana-Champaign's Academy for Entrepreneurial Leadership Historical Research Reference in Entrepreneurship.
Mintzberg, H. (1983). Power In and Around Organizations. Englewood Cliffs, NJ: Prentice-Hall.
Mintzberg, H. (1990). The design school: Reconsidering the basic premises of strategic management. Strategic Management Journal, 11(3), 171-195.
Moore, M. (2000). Managing for value: Organizational strategy in for-profit, nonprofit, and governmental organizations. Nonprofit and Voluntary Sector Quarterly, 29(suppl 1), 183-208.
260
Nadler, D., & Tushman, M. (1997). Competing by Design. New York: Oxford University Press.
Newberry, S., & Jacobs, K. (2007). Obtaining the levers of power: the Treasury and the introduction of New Zealand's public sector financial reforms. Advances in Public Interest Accounting, 13, 115-150.
Otley, D. (1980). The contingency theory of management accounting: achievement and prognosis. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 5(4), 413-428.
Otley, D. (1994). Management control in contemporary organizations: Towards a wider framework. Management Accounting Research, 5, 289-299.
Otley, D., & Berry, A. (1980). Control, organization and accounting. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 5(2), 231-244.
Otley, D., Broadbent, J., & Berry, A. (1995). Research in management control: An overview of its development. British Journal of Management, 6(S1), S31-S44.
Ouchi, W. (1977). The relationship between organizational structure and organizational control. Administrative Science Quarterly, 22(1), 95-113.
Pandit, N. (1996). The creation of theory: A recent application of the grounded theory method. The Qualitative Report, 2(4), 1-16.
Parkinson, G., & Drislane, R. (2011). Qualitative Research. Online Dictionary of the Social Sciences. http://bitbucket.icaap.org/
Patton, M. (2005). Qualitative Evaluation and Research Methods (3rd ed.). Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE.
Paulsen, M., & Smart, J. (2001). The Finance of Higher Education: Theory, Research, Policy & Practice. New York: Agathon Press.
Priest, D., Becker, W., Hossler, D., & St. John, E. (2002). Incentive-based Budgeting Systems in Public Universities. Northhampton, MA: Edward Elgar.
Priest, D., Jacobs, B., & Boon, R. (2006). Privatization of Business and Auxillary Functions. In D. Priest & E. St. John (Eds.), Privatization and Public Universities. Bloomington: Indiana University Press.
Proulx, D. (2004). Responsibility Center Management: RCM 101. Eastern U.S. University.
261
Puxty, A. (1989). Research and current issues in management accounting: A review essay. The British Accounting Review, 21(1), 31-58.
Rhoades, G., & Slaughter, S. (1997). Academic capitalism, managed professionals, and supply-side higher education. Social Text, 51(Summer), 9-38.
Rhoades, G., & Slaughter, S. (2004). Academic capitalism in the new economy: Challenges and choices. American Academic, 1(1), 37-59.
Rodas, D. (2001). Resource Allocation in Private Research Universities. New York: Taylor & Francis.
Rubin, H., & Rubin, I. (2011). Qualitative Interviewing: The art of hearing data. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Schofield, J. (2002). Increasing the generalizability of qualitative research. In M. Huberman & M. Miles (Eds.) The Qualitative Researcher's Companion, (pp. 171-203). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Schumpeter, J. (1934). The Theory of Economic Development. Cambridge, MA: Harvard University Press.
Scott, K. (1999). Institutions of corporate governance. Journal of Institutional and Theoretical Economics, 155(1).
Simons, R. (1987). Accounting control systems and business strategy: an empirical analysis. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 12(4), 357-374.
Simons, R. (1990). The role of management control systems in creating competitive advantage: New perspectives. Accounting, Organizations and Society, 15, 127-143.
Simons, R. (1991). Strategic orientation and top management attention to control systems. Strategic Management Journal, 12, 46-62.
Simons, R. (1995). Levers of Control: How Managers Use Innovative Control Systems to Drive Strategic Renewal. Cambridge, MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Simons, R. (2005). Levers of organizational design: How managers use accountability systems for greater performance and commitment. Cambridge, MA: Harvard Business School Press.
Slaughter, S., & Leslie, L. (2001). Expanding and elaborating the concept of academic capitalism. Organization 8(2), 154-161.
262
Slaughter, S., & Rhoades, G. (2004). Academic Capitalism and the New Economy: Markets, state, and higher education. Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins University Press.
Small, J. (1994). Reform in Canadian Universities. Canadian Journal of Higher Education, 24(2), 1-15.
St. John, E. (1994). Prices, Productivity, and Investment: Assessing Financial Strategies in Higher Education. Washington, D.C.: George Washington University.
Stocum, D., & Rooney, P. (1997). Responding to resource constraints: A departmentally based system of responsibility center management. Change: The Magazine of Higher Learning, 29(5), 50-57.
Strauss, J., Curry, J., & Whalen, E. (1996). Revenue responsibility budgeting. In W. Massy (Ed.) Resource Allocation in Higher Education, 163-190. Ann Arbor, MI: University of Michigan Press.
Strauss, J., & Curry, J. (2002). Responsibility Center Management: Lessons from 25 Years of Decentralized Management. Washington, D.C.: National Association of College and University Business Officers.
Tavenas, F. (1993). Budgeting for Quality in a University. Keynote speech. Retrieved from http:www.usask.ca/cirpa/proceed1993/tavenas.html
Taylor, D. (2000). Facts, myths and monsters: understanding the principles of good governance. International Journal of Public Sector Management, 13(2), 108-124.
Teece, D. (1996). Firm organization, idustrial structure, and technological innovation. Journal of Eocnomic Behaviour and Organization, 31(2), 193-224.
Teichler, U. (2006). Changing Structures of the Higher Education Systems: The increasing complexity of underlying forces. Higher Education Policy, 19(4), 447-461.
Tellis, W. (1997). Application of a case study methodology. The Qualitative Report, 3(3), 1-17.
Thelin, J. (2004). A History of American Higher Education. Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins University Press.
Thompson, J. (2011). Organizations in action: Social science bases of administrative theory (Vol. 1): Transaction Publishers.
263
Thomson Reuters. (2013). The World University Rankings. Retrieved from http://www.timeshighereducation.co.uk/world-university-rankings/2013-14/world-ranking/region/north-america
Thompson, F. (1998). Cost Measurement and Analysis. In R. Meyers (Ed.) Handbook of Government Budgeting, (pp. 381-411). San Francisco, CA: Jossey-Bass Publishers.
Thompson, F., & Jones, L. (1986). Controllership in the public sector. Journal of Polocy Analysis and Management, 5(3), 547-571.
Thompson, J. (1967). Organizations in action: Social science bases of administrative theory. New Brunswick, NJ: Transaction Publishers.
Thoren, K., & Brown, T. (2004). Development of Management Control Systems in Fast Growing Small Firms. Paper presented at the 13th Nordic Conference on Small Business Research, Tromo, Norway.
Tolbert, P. (1985). Institutional environments and resource dependence: Sources of administrative structure in institutions of higher education. Administrative Science Quarterly, 1-13.
Toutkoushian, R. (2009). An Economist's Perspective on the Privatization of Public Higher Education. In C. Morphew & P. Eckel (Eds.), Privatizing the Public University: Perspectives from Across the Academy (pp. 60-87). Baltimore, MD: Johns Hopkins Press.
Trow, M., & Clark, P. (1994). Managerialism and the Academic Profession: Quality and Control Higher Education Report No. 2. London: Open University.
U.S. World News & Report. (2013). Graduate School Rankings. Retrieved December 20,
2013: http://grad-schools.usnews.rankingsandreviews.com/best-graduate-
schools
Vaira, M. (2004). Globalization and higher education organizational change: A framework for analysis. Higher Education, 48(4), 483-510.
Vancil, R. (1979). Decentralization: Managerial Ambiguity by Design. Homewood, IL: Dow Jones-Irwin.
Vancil, R. (1980). Decentralization: Managerial Ambiguity by Design. New York: Financial Executives Research Foundation.
Vandament, W. (1989). Managing Money in Higher Education. San Francisco: Jossey-Bass.
264
Varlotta, L., Jones, B., & Schuh, J. (2010). Developing budget models, communication strategies, and relationships to mitigate the pain of tough economic times. New Directions for Student Services, (129), 81-87.
Walsh, V., Roy, R., Bruce, M., & Potter, S. (1992). Winning by design: Technology, product design and international competitiveness. Oxford, UK: Blackwell Publishers.
Walter, J., Kellermanns, F., Floyd, S., Veiga, J., & Matherne, C. (2013). Strategic alignment: A missing link in the relationship between strategic consensus and organizational performance. Strategic Organization, 11(3), 304–328.
Weber, R. (1990). Basic Content Analysis. Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage.
Weick, K. (1996). Sensemaking in Organizations. Thousand Oaks, CA: SAGE Publications.
Weigelt, C., & Miller, D. (2013). Implications of Internal Organization Stuctures for Firm Boundaries. Strategic Management Journal, 34(12), 1411-1434.
Weiss, R. (2008). Learning From Strangers: The art and method of qualitative interview studies. New York: The Free Press.
Western Canadian University. (1994). Western Canadian University Planning and Three-year Budget Forecasting Manual. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (1999). Western Canadian University Financial Statements and Supplementary Schedules 1991-1999. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2012a). Final Report of the President's Task Force on Budget Processes. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2012b). Western Canadian University 2008-2012 Business Plan. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2012c). Letter to Chairs and Program Heads. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2012d). Letter to Senior Leaders. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2012e). Letter to the University Budget Committee. Western Canadian University.
265
Western Canadian University. (2013a). Fact Book 2012-2013. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2013b). Report of the University Budget Committee on the 2013-2014 to 2015-2016 University Budget. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2013c). Western Canadian University Comprehensive Institutional Plan 2013/14-2015/16. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2013d). 2013-14 Budget Update. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2013e). Summary Report: Open Call for Feedback. Comments related to the Draft Letter of Expectation from the Ministry of Enterprise and Advanced Education. Western Canadian University.
Western Canadian University. (2013f). Report of Internal Consultation: Strategic Planning Committee. Western Canadian University.
Whalen, E. (1991). Responsibility Center Budgeting: An Approach to Decentralized Management for Institutions of Higher Education. Bloomington, IN: Indiana University Press.
Whalen, E. (1996). Responsibility-centered management: An approach to decentralized financial operations. In D. Honeyman, J. Wattenbarger, & K. Westbrook (Eds.) A Struggle To Survive: Funding Higher Education In the Next Century, (pp. 127-154). Thousand Oaks, CA: Sage Publications.
Whalen, E. (2002). The Case, if any, for Responsibility Center Budgeting. In D. Priest, W. Becker, D. Hossler, & E. St. John (Eds.) Incentive-based Budgeting Systems in Public Universities, (pp. 111-135). Northhampton, MA: Edward Elgar Publishing.
Wildavsky, A. (1964). Politics of the Budgetary Process. Boston, MA: Little, Brown & Company.
Williamson, O. (1975). Markets and Hierarchies: Analysis and Anti-Trust Implications. New York: Free Press.
Williamson, O. (1991). Comparative economic organization: The analysis of discrete structural alternatives. Administrative Science Quarterly, 36(June), 269-296.
Yin, R. (2009). Case Study Research. London, UK: SAGE Publications.
266
Zierdt, G. (2009). Responsibility-centred budgeting: An emerging trend in higher education budget reform. Journal of Higher Education Policy and Management, 31(4), 345-353.
Zimmerman, J. (1995). Accounting for Decision-making and Control. Chicago: Irwin
267
APPENDIX 1: Budget Typology Table
Root Assumptions
Strategies Strengths Weaknesses
Rat
ion
al C
alcu
lati
on
Incremental budgeting
Simplicity
Reduced conflict
Stability
Flexibility
Controllability
Pragmatic
Status quo
Focus on inputs
Driven more by political demands then analytic assessments
Flexibility/opportunism
Continuous commitments not recognized
Planning Programming-Budgeting System (PPBS)
Focus on results
Relating goals to outcomes
Sense of direction
Long range planning (macroeconomic focus)
Qualitative and quantitative dimensions
Assumption of knowledge
Consensus
Flexibility/opportunism
Strong central management
Unreliable measure of inputs and outputs
Costly
Difficult to implement
Institutional missions
Zero-Based Budgeting (ZBB)
Focus on results
Objectivity
Manageable scope
Decentralization
Better understanding of the organization
Valid Criteria
Reliable measures
Ad hoc nature
No budget history
Costly (time and paper work)
Continuous commitments not recognized
Performance Budgeting
Focus on accomplishments (outputs)
Objectivity
Manageable scope
Qualitative and quantitative dimensions
Unreliable measures of inputs and outputs
Ad hoc nature
Complex and long process
Institutional missions
Unable to measure long-term outcomes
Formula Budgeting
Simplicity
Reutilization
Equity
Reduced conflict
Accountability
Objectivity
Status quo
Lack of planning flexibility
Short term orientation
Implicit or explicit incentives in formulas
Quantitative measures
Rigid and simplistic formulas
268
Mar
ket
Inte
ract
ion
Responsibility Centered Management
Responsiveness
Competition
Decentralized (Decisions close to actions)
Flexibility
Responsibility with authority
Accountability
Effective use of resources
Cooperation among units
More student influence
Institutional missions
Absence of pure market conditions
Lack of central controls
Service components
Responsibility center formation
Budget driven academic programs
Difficult cost and revenue attribution
Desire to generate income.
Source: Cekic (2010). Budgeting and Organizational Culture: Exploring responsibility center management
(RCM) and cultural change at a public university. Saabrucken: Lambert Academic Publishing.
269
APPENDIX 2: Public Higher Education Institutions in the Times Higher Education North American
Rankings and Corresponding Budgeting and Management System
Rank Institution Country Decentralized Budgeting and
Management
6 University of California, Berkeley United States No
9 University of California, Los Angeles United States Yes
15 University of Michigan United States Yes
16 University of Toronto Canada Yes
19 University of Washington United States Yes
20 Georgia Institute of Technology United States No
21 University of Texas at Austin United States No
22 University of British Columbia Canada No
23 University of Wisconsin-Madison United States No
24 University of Illinois at Urbana Champaign United States Yes
25 McGill University Canada Yes
26 University of California, Santa Barbara United States Yes
27 University of California, San Diego United States Yes
29 University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill United States No
31 University of California, Davis United States Yes
32 University of Minnesota United States Yes
34 Ohio State University United States Yes
36 University of Southern California United States Yes
37 Pennsylvania State University United States Yes
38 Purdue University United States Yes
39 University of Massachusetts United States No
41 University of Pittsburgh United States No
43 University of Montreal Canada No
45 McMaster University Canada Considering Implementation
46 University of Colorado Boulder United States No
48 Michigan State University United States No
49 University of California, Irvine United States Yes
50 University of Maryland, College Park United States No
Source: Thomson Reuters. (2013). The World University Rankings. Retrieved from
http://www.timeshighereducation.co.uk/world-university-rankings/2013-14/world-ranking/region/north-
america
270
APPENDIX 3: Walter et al.’s Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness
Factor Measurement Variables
Strategic Consensus
Promoting departmental majors to potential students
Improving faculty morale and satisfaction
Placing graduate students (e.g. doctoral student placement)
Encouraging faculty to take leadership roles in scholarly associations (e.g. officers, journal editors)
Improving national research rankings
Supporting faculty with strong professional reputations
Paying competitive salaries
Organizational Performance
Department members publish in premier journals in the field
Department members receive research grants
Department members are represented on editorial boards of major journals in the field
Department members receive awards for research
Department members teach at the cutting edge
Department members receive awards for teaching
Commitment
Department members are willing to put in a great deal of effort to successfully recruit new faculty with research skills
Department members are willing to promote recruiting decisions to coworkers as being good for the department
Department members really care about seeing other department members publish successfully
Source: Walter, J., Kellermanns, F., Floyd, S., Veiga, J., & Matherne, C. (2013). Strategic alignment: A missing link in the relationship between strategic consensus and organizational performance. Strategic Organization. 11(3), 304–328.
271
APPENDIX 4: Lateral Coordination and Governance Control Form Matrix
Low Lateral Coordination High Lateral Coordination
Diagnostic Control Form
Governance Structure
Interactive Control Form
Governance Structure
272
APPENDIX 5: Vertical Coordination and Governance Control Form Matrix
Low Vertical Coordination High Vertical Coordination
Diagnostic Control Form
Governance Structure
Interactive Control Form
Governance Structure
273
APPENDIX 6: Method-Process Graphic
Research Questions
Creation of Conceptual Framework
Identification of Sample Institutions for Case Study
Identification of Individuals to Interview
‘Start List’ Coding Scheme Creation
Data Collection
Sorting and Coding of Data (Includes the addition, deletion and modification of codes and code
definitions)
Keyword/phrase Identification
Keyword/phrase Searches in MS Word
Creation of Summaries of Main Conceptual Categories
Keyword/phrase Identification
Keyword/phrase Searches in MS Word
Creation of Matrices to Triangulate Data/Findings from Multiple Sources
274
APPENDIX 7: Steps and Phases of Study
Step Activity Reason This Research Study's Activities
Getting Started
Definition of research question Focus effort Defined research question (RCB/M and governance, and the three-factor internal structure model) and gap in the literature.
A priori constructs Provides grounding of construct measures
Constructs developed through an extensive literature review of RCB/M, governance, organizational design, and management control systems.
Selecting Cases Theoretical, non-random sampling
Focuses efforts on the theoretically useful cases - those that will extend theory by filling conceptual categories
Initial environmental scanning and institutional document analysis provided eight institutions of interest that could be separated into two general categories. Four institutions chosen.
Crafting Instruments and Protocols Qualitative and quantitative data combined
Synergistic view of evidence from divergent perspectives
Qualitative data collection and analysis through two phases that included document analysis, and in-person interviews.
Entering the Field Flexible and opportunistic data collection methods
Allows ability to take advantage of emergent themes and unique case features
Phased data collection and analysis to inform each subsequent stage.
275
Analyzing Data
Within-case analysis Gains familiarity with data and preliminary theory generation
Within-case analysis.
Cross-case analysis Forces investigator to see evidence through multiple lenses
Cross-case analysis.
Shaping Hypothesis
Iterative tabulation of evidence Sharpens construct definition, validity, and measurability
Phased data collection and analysis promoted an iterative process of theme identification and testing.
Search for evidence for 'why' behind relationships
Builds internal validity Exploratory nature of investigation provided depth of understanding behind observed relationships.
Enfolding Literature
Comparison with conflicting literature
Builds internal validity, raises theoretical level, and sharpens construct definitions
Identification of conflicting and competing findings.
Comparison with similar literature Sharpens generalizability, improves construct definition, and raises theoretical level
Uniqueness of this study intended to extend understanding using extant literature as a foundation.
Reaching Closure Theoretical saturation when possible
Ends process when marginal improvement becomes small
Creation of deliverables.
276
APPENDIX 8: Interview Protocol
Interview Questions for Participants
1. For the purposes of this study, I am interested in researching decentralized budget and management systems at University of X. By decentralized budgeting and management systems I mean those institutional systems and processes of decision making, resource allocation, and responsibility for budget shortfalls and surpluses that have been decentralized. One often used term for these processes is Responsibility Centre Budgeting and Responsibility Centre Management (RCB/M). I am particularly interested in the relationship of RCB/M systems and management structures. Additionally, I am interested to investigate how the structure of the institution impacts decision making and management structures. I am also interested to hear your general thoughts and experiences on the use of RCB/M in your university and any specific interactions and/or outcomes you would like to highlight.
2. When did you first join University X? What changes in the university’s financial administration have you seen since then?
3. What level of autonomy in decision making do the units at your university have? What, if any, influence or impact does the central administration have over your decisions?
4. How familiar are you with RCB/M? What is it intended to do in higher education?
5. Why do you think your institution implemented RCB/M?
6. What role did you think RCB/M’s implementation at other universities play in your university’s decision to implement it?
7. How would you describe the financial administration of your department or the university since the introduction of RCB/M?
8. Can you describe your institution’s management structures? How did they change when RCB/M was implemented?
9. Again, thinking about your management structures, would you characterize them as being top down and authoritarian or a structure that encourages communication and interaction? Can you describe the processes in place that lead you to this conclusion?
10. Can you describe the various levels that the governance and oversight structures acts on? For instance at the central level of the institution you have the governing board
277
overseeing institutional priorities. What other levels do you see active governance and oversight by the central administration?
11. How different, in terms of cost structure of educating students, are the various units of your institution? Which unit would be the most similar? Which do you think would be the most different?
12. From your experience what is the level of coordination between units and the central administration? Are there formal mechanisms in place to facilitate this?
13. How much coordination do you observe between units? Have you observed competition between units?
14. If you had a free hand to change your university’s financial administration: is there anything you would change to improve it? If so, what would it be? Why?
15. Describe any external pressure you think the university is experiencing or experienced to implement RCB/M?
16. What else would you like to tell us about budgeting, management and resource allocation decision making at your university?
278
APPENDIX 9: Contact Letter to Potential Participants
Invitation Email to Interview Participants
Dear_____
My name is Darren Deering and I am a Ph.D. Candidate in the Leadership, Higher and Adult
Education program at the Ontario Institute for Studies in Education (OISE) at the University of
Toronto (UofT). I am writing to invite you to participate in a research study currently being
conducted on budgeting, management, and governance systems in higher education
institutions that is being conducted as part of the requirements for my Ph.D. at OISE/UofT.
I intend to interview senior administrative staff, Deans, Program Chairs, and senior faculty
members from a variety of higher education institutions in Canada and the United States.
Specifically, I am interested in the levels of autonomy in decision-making, management
structures, and level of alignment between faculties and their institution.
I expect that the interview should require no more than 60 minutes of your time. Follow up
questions via email, made within 30 days of the original interview, may be needed to clarify
items discussed.
I hope that the findings from this study will help inform the discussion on budgeting,
management and the resulting resource allocation decision-making in higher education.
Additionally, I expect that this study will add to the higher education management literature
providing a better understanding of practices and their application.
Your responses and participation in this study will be kept strictly confidential as will the name
of your institution. You will also be presented with a transcript of the interview allowing you the
opportunity to verify or clarify any statements.
I would like to note that all participation is completely voluntary. You will be under no
obligation to participate, and there will be no negative consequences for withdrawing from the
process. Please see the Consent Letter for more information about this study. If you are
interested in participating in this study you can email or call me at which time I would be happy
to answer any additional questions you may have and arrange a time for an interview.
For your records, our contact information is as follows:
279
Darren Deering: [email protected]
Creso Sà (faculty supervisor): [email protected]
The phone number for the University Research Ethics Office is 416-946-3273 if you have any
questions about your rights as a research participant. Feel free to contact University Research
Ethics Office if you have any questions regarding your rights as a participant in this study.
I hope that you are willing to set some time aside to be interviewed for this research study.
Best Regards,
Darren Deering Ph.D. Candidate
280
APPENDIX 10: Ethics Approval Letter
281
APPENDIX 11: Interviewee Consent Form
Consent for Participation in Interview Research
I ______________________________________ volunteer to participate in a research project conducted by Darren Deering, Ph.D. Candidate, from the University of Toronto. I understand that the project is designed to gather information about budgeting and management processes in higher education institutions. I will be one of approximately 48 people being interviewed for this research from four different institutions.
1. My participation in this project is voluntary. I understand that I will not be paid for my participation. I may withdraw and discontinue participation at any time without penalty. If I decline to participate or withdraw from the study, no one on my campus will be told.
2. I understand that most interviewees in will find the discussion interesting and thought-provoking. If, however, I feel uncomfortable in any way during the interview session, I have the right to decline to answer any question or to end the interview.
3. Participation involves being interviewed by researchers from the University of Toronto. The interview will last approximately 60 minutes. Notes will be written during the interview. An audio tape of the interview and subsequent dialogue will be made. If I don't want to be taped, and audio tape of the interview will not be made.
4. I understand that the researchers will not identify me or my institution by name in any reports using information obtained from this interview, and that my confidentiality as a participant in this study will remain secure. Subsequent uses of records and data will be subject to standard data use policies which protect the anonymity of individuals and institutions.
5. Faculty and administrators from my campus will neither be present at the interview nor have access to raw notes or transcripts. This precaution will prevent my individual comments from having any negative repercussions.
6. I understand that this research study has been reviewed and approved by the Office of Research Ethics at the University of Toronto for studies involving human subjects. For research problems or questions regarding subjects, the Office of Research Ethics at the University of Toronto may be contacted via phone at 416-946-3273.
7. I have read and understand the explanation provided to me. I have had all my questions answered to my satisfaction, and I voluntarily agree to participate in this study.
8. I have been given a copy of this consent form. ____________________________ ________________________ My Signature Date ____________________________ ________________________ My Printed Name Signature of the Investigator For further information, please contact: Darren Deering at [email protected]
282
APPENDIX 12: Informed Consent Letter
Informed Consent Letter
Month 2014,
To the participants in this study,
The purpose of the present study is to investigate the use of decentralized budgeting and management systems such as Responsibility Centre Budgeting and Responsibility Centre Management (RCB/M). Specifically, I am interested in the relationship of such decentralized budgeting and management structures with governance systems and the effects on institutional structure.
The 48 senior administrators, Deans, chairs, and senior faculty participating in this study will be selected based on their knowledge of their institution’s decentralized budgeting and management system and its interaction with institutional governance structures and is strictly voluntary. In addition, a balance between participants from the four institutions being considered will be sought. The four institutions have been chosen due to their implementation of a decentralized budgeting and management system. It should be noted that at no time will the institutions be named.
This study will be carried out in two Canadian provinces and two U.S. states, under the supervision of Professor Creso Sà, Department of Leadership, Higher and Adult Education, The Ontario Institute for Studies in Education/University of Toronto. The data is being collected for the purposes of a dissertation. In addition to the use of this data in the dissertation my intent is to publish and make public presentations based on the research, and all participants’ identity will remain confidential.
A face-to-face interview of approximately 60 minutes will be conducted with you. During the interview you will be asked questions about your understanding of the budget and management systems of the university, your perspective on the outcomes of this systems use, and the relationship between this system and your institution’s governance structure. As the interview proceeds, I may ask questions for clarification or further understanding, but my part will be mainly to listen to you speak about your views, experiences, and the reasons you believe the things you do. After the interview, I will write brief notes that will be used to assist me in remembering the surroundings of the interview (i.e., characteristics of the site). It should be noted that you may withdraw at any time, without consequence.
It is the intention that each interview will be digitally recorded, with your permission, and later transcribed to paper; you have the choice of declining to have the interview recorded. You will be assigned a number that will correspond to your interviews and transcriptions. Your transcript will be sent to you to read in order for you to add any further information or to correct any misinterpretations that could result. The information obtained in the interview will be kept in strict confidence and will be stored securely in my locked private office. Only the researcher and the supervisor of the study will have access to the recordings and the transcriptions. All information will be reported in such a way that individual persons and institutions cannot be identified. All raw data (i.e. transcripts, field notes) will be destroyed five years after the completion of the study.
You may at any time refuse to answer a question or withdraw from the interview process. You may request that any information, whether in written form or digital recording, be eliminated from the
283
project. At no time will value judgments will be placed on your responses nor will any evaluation be made of your effectiveness in your role at the university and at no time will you be at risk of harm.
The benefit of participation to the interview participant is to help build a better understanding of issues surrounding decentralized budgeting and management processes in higher education in general and at your individual institution. Furthermore, you will be provided with a final draft of the research, if so desired. The benefits to the scholarly community include the development of a four factor model of internal structure and its application to decentralized budgeting and management of higher education institutions.
Finally, you are free to ask any questions about the research and your involvement with it and you will receive a final copy of the research article once is has been written.
If you have any questions, please feel free to contact Darren Deering at [email protected]. You may also contact the faculty supervisor, Dr. Creso Sà at (416) 926-4741 or at [email protected]. Finally, you may also contact the U of T Office of Research Ethics for questions about your rights as a research participant at [email protected] or 416-946-3273.
Thank you in advance for your participation.
Darren Deering, Ph.D. Candidate
Leadership, Higher and Adult Education OISE/University of Toronto 252 Bloor Street West Toronto, Ontario M5S 1V6 Telephone: 647-801-9879 Email: [email protected]
Dr. Creso Sà
Faculty Advisor Professor, Leadership, Higher and Adult Education OISE/University of Toronto 252 Bloor Street West Toronto, Ontario M5S 1V6 Telephone: 416-926-4741 Email: [email protected]
284
By signing below, you are indicating that you are willing to participate in the study, you have received a copy of this letter, and you are fully aware of the conditions above.
Name: _____________________________________School: _____________________________
Signed: ____________________________________Date: ______________________________
Please initial if you would like a summary of the findings of the study upon completion: _____
Please initial if you agree to have your interview audio recorded: _____
Please keep a copy of this form for your records.
285
APPENDIX 13: Matrix for Case Comparisons
Conceptual Categories
Themes Literature Document Analysis
Interview Data Conflicts Between Data
Alignment of Data
(Source of Data)
Lateral Coordination
Oversight of unit decision-making
Influence/power of central admin
Structures to encourage cooperation and coordination
Multidisciplinary programs/research
Policies for service teaching
Level of decentralization
Dean centric model
Power of Provost
Trend of centralization
Cost reduction vs. revenue seeking
Indirect vs. direct costs
Vertical Coordination
Use of soft power
Power/influence to encourage alignment to institutional mission/goals
Oversight over unit budgets and strategy
Application of diagnostic, interactive or combination
Level of decentralization
Trend of centralization
Ability to set strategic goals
286
and act strategically
Unit Autonomy
Fund authority
Task accountability
Trend of centralization
Clear formulas
Communication and/or negotiation of changes to operations, formulas, and tax rates
Surplus vs. deficit
Unit Differentiation
Perceived differentiation
Similar Units (e.g. costs, students, capital investments)
Linkages between units
Central Leadership
Communication
Transparency
Soft power
Resources
Trust and fairness
Provost’s focus
Institutional Environment
Austerity
State/provincial appropriations
Endowments
Class of institution (world, national, regional, local)
Culture
Reputation
Financial crisis
Institutional costs
287
APPENDIX 14: Coding Scheme Start List
Conceptual Categories
Themes Literature Document Analysis
Interview Data
Vertical Coordination
Influence of central administration over decision-making
Central administration’s discretionary budget
Interactive vs. diagnostic control forms
Lateral Coordination
Competition
Service teaching
Multi-disciplinary programs
Have vs. have not
Central administration’s role in encouraging coordination
Unit Autonomy
Diagnostic vs. interactive control forms
Surplus vs. deficit
Revenue opportunities
Linkages between units
Unit Differentiation
Organizational
Cost of faculty
Capital needs, investment and infrastructure
Sources of funding
288
APPENDIX 15: Triangulation Matrix for Research Questions
Research Question Data Source
Institutional Documents External Reports Interviews Do those HEIs that apply an interactive governance control form, which allows for oversight and influence on unit-level decision-making, experience increased alignment between unit-level goals, resource-allocation decisions, and behaviour regarding institutional mission and strategic goals?
Do those HEIs that report high levels of lateral and vertical coordination have governance structures that allow for oversight and influence of unit-level decision making?
Is there a relationship between the type/degree of alignment (high vs. low lateral and vertical coordination) and the achievement of organizational goals?
Is increasing revenue a stronger, more manageable incentive compared to cost reduction? If so, does this fact encourage the internal competition (decreasing lateral coordination) and fragmentation of the institution by reducing vertical coordination?
How does the ratio of indirect to direct costs impact the degree of lateral and vertical coordination?
What is the relationship between levels of unit autonomy (funding authority and task accountability), and the type of governance structure (interactive versus diagnostic control systems of governance)?
Will the degree of unit differentiation determine the degree of lateral coordination?
Will HEIs that use RCB/M and apply an interactive control system of governance experience higher levels of institutional goal and mission achievement?
Will HEIs that use RCB/M and employ an interactive control system of governance experience lower levels of decision-making autonomy at the unit level?
289
APPENDIX 16: Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness for Midwestern U.S.
University
Factor Measurement Variables Midwestern U.S. University
Stra
tegi
c C
on
sen
sus
Promoting university to potential students Processes identified in document analysis, support form data collected during interviews.
Improving faculty morale and satisfaction Processes identified in document analysis, support form data collected during interviews.
Placing graduate students (e.g. doctoral student placement)
Data not available from document analysis, inconclusive evidence from interview data.
Encouraging faculty to take leadership roles in scholarly associations (e.g. officers, journal editors)
Processes identified in document analysis, support form data collected during interviews.
Improving national research rankings Processes identified in document analysis, support form data collected during interviews.
Supporting faculty with strong professional reputations
Processes identified in document analysis, support form data collected during interviews.
Paying competitive salaries Processes identified in document analysis, support form data collected during interviews.
Org
aniz
atio
nal
Per
form
ance
Faculty members publish in premier journals in the field
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members receive research grants Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members are represented on editorial boards of major journals in the field
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members receive awards for research
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members teach at the cutting edge Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members receive awards for teaching
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Co
mm
itm
ent
Willing to put in a great deal of effort to successfully recruit new faculty with research skills
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews
Support for department members to encourage publication
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
290
APPENDIX 17: Three Factor Model of Organizational Effectiveness for Central Canadian
University
Factor Measurement Variables Central Canadian University
Stra
tegi
c C
on
sen
sus
Promoting university to potential students
Processes identified in document analysis, data not collected during interviews.
Improving faculty morale and satisfaction
Processes identified in document analysis, support form data collected during interviews.
Placing graduate students (e.g. doctoral student placement)
Data not available from document analysis, inconclusive evidence from interview data.
Encouraging faculty to take leadership roles in scholarly associations (e.g. officers, journal editors)
Processes identified in document analysis, inconclusive evidence provided by interview data.
Improving national research rankings Processes identified in document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Supporting faculty with strong professional reputations
Processes identified in document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Paying competitive salaries
Processes identified in document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Org
aniz
atio
nal
Per
form
ance
Faculty members publish in premier journals in the field
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members receive research grants
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members are represented on editorial boards of major journals in the field
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members receive awards for research
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members teach at the cutting edge
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Faculty members receive awards for teaching
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Co
mm
itm
ent
Willing to put in a great deal of effort to successfully recruit new faculty with research skills
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.
Support for department members to encourage publication
Statement supported by document analysis, support from data collected during interviews.